* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
Download Study Guide to accompany Physics Including Human Applications
Classical mechanics wikipedia , lookup
Potential energy wikipedia , lookup
Electrical resistance and conductance wikipedia , lookup
Thomas Young (scientist) wikipedia , lookup
Woodward effect wikipedia , lookup
Photon polarization wikipedia , lookup
Lorentz force wikipedia , lookup
Internal energy wikipedia , lookup
Old quantum theory wikipedia , lookup
Nuclear physics wikipedia , lookup
Gibbs free energy wikipedia , lookup
History of physics wikipedia , lookup
Electromagnetism wikipedia , lookup
Anti-gravity wikipedia , lookup
Conservation of energy wikipedia , lookup
Equations of motion wikipedia , lookup
Newton's laws of motion wikipedia , lookup
Work (physics) wikipedia , lookup
Classical central-force problem wikipedia , lookup
Theoretical and experimental justification for the Schrödinger equation wikipedia , lookup
Study Guide to accompany Physics Including Human Applications Fuller/ Fuller/ Fuller by Thomas C. Campbell Illinois Central College and Robert G. Fuller University of Nebraska Harper & Row, Publishers New York Hagerstown San Francisco London All rights reserved. Printed in the United States of America. No part of this book may be used or reproduced in any manner whatsoever without written permission except in the case of brief quotations embodied in critical articles and reviews. For information address Harper & Row, Publishers, Inc., 10 East 53rd Street, New York, N.Y. 10022. Standard Book Number: 06-042213-0 TABLE OF CONTENTS: Introduction and Table of Contents Preface Dear Student Mathematical Skills Review (0) Human Senses (1) Unifying Approaches (2) Kinematics (3) Forces and Newton's Law (4) Energy (5) Momentum and Impulse (6) Rotational Motion (7) Fluid Flow (8) Transport Phenomena (9) Temperature and Heat (10) Thermal Transport (11) Thermodynamics (12) Elastic Properties of Materials (13) Molecular Model of Matter (14) Simple Harmonic Motion (15) Traveling Waves (16) Sound and the Human Ear (17) Optical Elements (18) Wave Properties of Light (19) Human Vision (20) Electrical Properties of Matter (21) Basic Electrical Measurements (22) Magnetism (23) Electromagnetic Induction (24) Alternating Currents (25) Bioelectronics and Instrumentation (26) Quantum and Relativistic Physics (27) Atomic Physics (28) Molecular and Solid-State Physics (29) X-Rays (30) Nuclear Physics (31) Applied Nucleonics (32) PREFACE We have written this to accompany the general physics textbook, PHYSICS Including Human Applications, by Fuller, Fuller, and Fuller. This , we think, serves several purposes. It can be used along with a lecture-recitation course to provide additional study materials for the students. On the other hand, for several years we have been using the Fuller 3 manuscript as the textual material for our Keller Plan physics courses. This can be used as the student modules for a self-paced physics course. Additional Keller Plan materials to assist instructors of Keller Plan courses, using this , are available from Harper and Row Publishers. In addition, the Fuller3 textual materials were developed for flexible use for a wide variety of physics courses, including correspondence or independent study courses. This can be used to assist students in self-study programs for personal improvement. One result of the flexibility of the Fuller3 materials is the variety of sequences available for the study of these materials. It is not necessary to go through the textual material in a linear progression by chapter number. You need only to l follow the prerequisite statements for each textbook chapter. On the following two pages we have presented the prerequisite chart for the Fuller3 text. Please note that we have constructed a Chapter Zero for this from the Mathematical Background materials in the Appendix of the textbook. We believe it is essential for students to have sound mathematical skills before beginning a quantitative physics course. We have made Chapter Zero the prerequisite for the rest of the chapters. The charts on these two pages illustrate the prerequisite requirements for each chapter in Part I of Fuller, Fuller, and Fuller. To find the chapter which must be completed BEFORE you begin to study a later chapter, do the following: a) Locate the chapter title, b) Trace up the chart following the solid lines noting all the chapter titles encountered until you arrive at Chapter One, Human Senses. For example, to find the prerequisite chapters for Temperature and Heat (10), you would encounter chapter titles along two directions; Energy (5), Forces and Newton's Laws (4), Kinematics (3), Unifying Approaches (2), and Human Senses along one route plus Transport Phenomena (9) along the other. Each of these chapters should be completed before you begin Chapter 10, Temperature and Heat. PREREQUISITE CHART FOR PHYSICS INCLUDING HUMAN APPLICATIONS BY FULLER/FULLER/FULLER PART II Prerequisite Chart (1) Prerequisite Chart (2) There are two other aspects of learning physics we would like to mention. While it is obvious that we learn by doing, it is not so apparent that we learn by interacting with other persons studying the same material. Nevertheless, our experiences as students and teachers of physics has convinced us of the importance of peer interactions in learning new subject material. Some provision which encourages people studying these materials to work together and talk to each other about these ideas seems to be essential. All the ideas and/or principles of physics cannot be presented with equal clarity in any one book. Students who want to know physics are to be encouraged to study the subject and not only a textbook. While the Fuller3 text can serve as an introduction to the concepts of physics, it need not be the only source of physics information consulted. Students are to be encouraged to use the various references recommended in the bibliography of the Fuller3 text. Thomas C. Campbell Robert G. Fuller June, 1978 -------------------------*Please note that in several of the tables which outline the Suggested Study Procedure a dotted line appears. This line separates two levels of competency for that chapter. First, the basic level appears above the dotted line. Below the line are the more advanced Chapter Goals and the recommended study outline which accompany them. Dear Student, This has been especially written for you to assist in your mastery of physics concepts. As you study each chapter, we hope you may rely on the material presented here to resolve some of the questions you may have from the many topics you encounter in the textbook. To help you use this , we have attempted to use the same format for each of the thirtytwo chapters (plus APPENDIX). In this way, you will be able to find the same "kinds" of assistance in each of the chapters. After a chapter or two, you may even anticipate the sections of the which are most helpful to you and utilize them more extensively than other sections. Generally, the make-up of each chapter is as follows: Section One - Chapter Introduction In the double page opening to each chapter we provide you with a restatement of the GOALS for each textbook chapter. This is accompanied by a chapter OVERVIEW and a SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE. This information suggests a realistic study procedure for you to follow in preparing yourself on the contents of the chapter. The study procedure does not suggest that you must study everything in the chapter (although this maybe your style), but outlines an economical and straight-forward method for mastery of the chapter contents. The correspondence between the chapter GOALS and the various sections and problems in the textbook are also summarized in tabular form. Section Two - Definitions In most chapters, one of the chapter GOALS deals with Definitions of terms introduced in the chapter. Although you will find a short definition of each of these terms in the text GLOSSARY, in this section we provide an extended discussion of them. This addition should not encourage you to "memorize" our definition but to use the additional information to formulate additional examples or situations which illustrate the function of the terms introduced. Section Three - Answers to Questions Asked in the Text As you read each text chapter you will encounter numerous questions. Some of these questions will be at the end of a chapter section, other will be within the narratives themselves. In this section of the , we provide you with a discussion of these questions. We hope that you will think seriously about the answers to these questions for yourself before you look at the answers we have provided. Section Four - Examples Many examples are provided in each chapter of the Text. Physics principles are general in nature and can be applied to a multitude of circumstances and applications. In this section of the , we present additional examples which illustrate the more quantitative concepts of each chapter. These problems will help you broaden your knowledge of the major concepts. Section Five - Practice Test The final part of the chapter is a Practice Test. These tests have been included with the answers to provide you a way to test yourself on your understanding of the information included in each text chapter. All of these tests have originated from exams we have given our students while using Fuller3. We hope that you will use the tests in a real testing situation-time yourself, complete all the test in one sitting, and do not look at the answers until all the parts are finished. When you are done, check your answers against those given at the end of the test. If you have difficulties, refer back to a portion of the text, the , or seek help from your instructor. Well, now it is up to you. Studying Physics is not an easy chore, but one which requires good study habits. Don't procrastinate and put off studying on a regular day-to-day basis. In writing this we hope to give you the basis for developing a regular study routine (suggested Study Procedure), assistance for potentially difficult areas (Definitions, Examples), and a self-check assessment of your understanding (Practice Test). But like any other well-planned lesson guide, it is only as good as the conscientious effort you make. Sincerely, Thomas C. Campbell Robert G. Fuller Appendix MATHEMATICAL SKILLS REVIEW GOALS 0 Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Mathematics; Arithmetic; Exponents; Exponentials; Exponential Functions; Logarithms; Trigonometry; Graphs; Dimensional Analysis; Cartesian Coordinates; Significant Digits; Powers Of Ten Notation When you have mastered the contents of the Appendix you will be able to successfully demonstrate your mathematical skills in each of the following eight areas: 1. Powers of Ten Notation 2. Significant Figures 3. Cartesian Graphs 4. Dimensional Analysis 5. Right Triangles 6. Exponents 7. Logarithms 8. Exponential Function OVERVIEW This review of basic mathematics is a good place to begin your study of introductory physics. In the Appendix you will find a helpful review of the eight basic mathematical skills which you will need during your study of this text. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Please note that the math review is broken into eight parts: Powers of Ten Notation, Significant Figures Cartesian Graphs, Dimensional Analysis, Right Triangles, Exponents, Logarithms, and The Exponential Function. As you begin your study of this mathematical review, attempt each of the self-check exercises which begin on the next page of this . Check your answers against the answers given. If you do not score 100% on any individual part, refer to the text Appendix for help. The outline below will provide a quick reference to each of the mathematical skills. Next, turn to the Practice Test in this . Complete the practice test and check your answers with those given at the end of the test. In any of the eight mathematical areas where you did not score 100%, again refer to that particular section in the text Appendix and work through additional Example Problems and/or Exercises. ------------------------------Chapter Goals Self- Suggested Text Practice Check Readings (Appendix) Problems -------------------------------Powers of Ten Notation 1 A.2 (p. 733) Significant Figures 2 A.3 (p. 734) Cartesian Graphs 3 A.4 (pp. 735-738) Dimensional Analysis 4 A.5 (pp. 740, 741) Right Triangles 5 A.6 (pp. 742-745) Exponents 6 A.7 (p. 745) Logarithms 7 A.8 (p. 748) Exponential Function 8 A.9 (p. 749) SELF-CHECK EXERCISES Keywords: Mathematics; Problems; Answers: Powers Of Ten Notation Powers of Ten Self-Check Solve each of the following problems, and give the answer in powers of ten notation. 1. 0.252 x 0.000000700/0.0360 = _______. 2. 6.380 x 103 x 5.00 x 104/2.50 x 10 5 = _____. 3. 3.20 x 107 + 6.83 x 106 - 9.90 x 105 = _____. Powers of Ten Self-Check Answers If you had difficulty in correctly solving these problems, please study the Section A.2 on the powers of ten notation, page 731. 1. 4.90 x 106 2. 1.28 x 1013 3. 3.78 x 107 SIGNIFICANT FIGURES SELF-CHECK Keywords: Significant Digits Solve each of the following problems, and give the correct answer in the appropriate number of significant figures. 1. 0.101 x 1.03/.025 = _____. 2. 4.5 x 103 x 2.5 x 10-2/2.15 x 10-4 = ____. 3. Solve for A; 3x 10-4 A/4.5 x 103 = 1. A = _____. ANSWERS TO SIGNIFICANT FIGURES SELF-CHECK If you had difficulty in correctly solving these problems, please study Appendix Section A.3 on Significant Figures, page 734. 1. 4.13 (3 significant figures) 2. 5.2 x 105 (2 significant figures) 3. 2 x 107 (1 significant figure) Graphing and Dimensional Analysis Self- Check Keywords: Graphs; Slope; Units; Conversion Of Units 1. The following table is taken from a drivers manual and shows data for stopping an automobile on dry pavement. ------------------------Velocity Thinking Total Stopping (m/sec) Distance (m) Distance (m) 8.8 6.7 14 13 10 27 18 13 43 23 17 61 27 20 86 --------------------------a. Draw a graph of thinking distance (y-axis) versus velocity (x-axis), and find the slope of the curve at the point on the curve where x = 15 m/sec. b. Draw a graph of the total stopping distance (y axis) versus the velocity (x axis), and find the slope of the curve at the point where x = 20 m/sec. 2. We can define length, mass, and time as fundamental dimensions in a system of measurement. What are the SI (System International) units for a. Length b. Mass c. Time The SI units are related to each other by multiples of ten, and the units are represented by the fundamental unit with the proper prefix. What are the relationships between the fundamental unit and the following common prefixes? d. The prefix centi-means _______, so one tesla = ______centiteslas. [10-2; 10 2] e. The prefix milli- means _____, so one liter = _____milliliters. [10-3;10 3] f. The prefix kilo- means _______, so one watt = ______kilowatts. [103;10 - 3] Graphing and Dimensional Analysis Self- Check Answers If you had difficulty in correctly solving these problems, please study Section A.4, Cartesian Graphs, and A.5, Dimensional Analysis, on pages 734-741. 1. a. 0.60 sec; b. 4.8 sec 2. a. meter; b. kilogram; c. second; d. 10-2, 102; e. 10- 3, 103; f. 103, 10 -3 RIGHT TRIANGLES SELF-CHECK Keywords: Trigonometry; Trigonometric Functions A surveyor wishes to determine the distance between two points A and B, but he cannot make a direct measurement because a river intervenes. He steps off a line AC at a 90º angle to AB and 264 meters long. With his transit, at point C he measures the angle between line AB and the line formed by C and B. Angle BCA is measured to be 62º. What is the distance from A to B? RIGHT TRIANGLES SELF-CHECK ANSWERS Distance AB = 497 meters. If you had difficulty getting this answer, you will find additional information in Section A.6, Right Triangles, of the appendix. TRIGONOMETRIC RELATIONSHIPS While nearly all of the problems in the book can be worked using the definitions of the sine, cosine, and tangent you have seen derived for right triangles, there are some relationships between these functions that it will be useful for you to know. We will derive them below. See Fig. (0-1) From the Pythagorean theorem you learned in high school, you know the relationship between the three sides of a right triangle; i.e., the sum of the squares of the two sides is equal to the square of the hypotenuse x2 + y2 = r2 (1) Look again at Figure (0-1). Note y/r = sin q = cos a (4) x/r = cos q = sin a (5) Since q + a + 90º = 180º i.e., the sum of the angles of any triangle equals 180º, then a = 90º - q The angle a is called the complement of the angle q. From equations (4) and (5) above notice that the sine of an angle is equal to the cosine of its complementary angle and the cosine of the angle is equal to the sine of its complementary angle. Example: An arrow shot into the air comes vertically down and sticks in the grass on the side of a hill inclined 68º from vertical. What portions of the arrow point down the hill and perpendicular to the hill? See Figure Now we divide both sides of equation (1) by the square of the hypotenuse, r2, x2/r2 + y2/r2 = 1 Then recall the definitions of sine and cosine, sin q = y/r; cosine q = x/r so x2/r2 cos2q; y2/r2 sin2q thus x2/r2 + y2/r2 = cos2 q + sin2 q = 1 (2) The sum of the squares of the cosine and the sine of any angle is equal to one. In a similar way we can derive a relationship between the tangent, sine and cosine of any angle. tan q = y/x. Divide both numerator and denominator by the hypotenuse, r tan q = (y/r) / (x/r) = sin q/cos q (3) The tangent of any angle is equal to the ratio of the sine of the angle to the cosine of the angle. EXPONENTS SELF-CHECK Keywords: Exponentials; Powers 1. 86 x 83 = ____. 2. 25 ÷ 2-2 = ____. 3. 103 x 10-3 = ____. 4. 101.5 ÷ 10-5 = ____. EXPONENTS SELF-CHECK ANSWERS Keywords: Exponentials; Powers 1. 89 2. 27 3. 1 4. 102 If you had difficulty with any of the above answers, you can find additional assistance in the Appendix, Section A.7, page 745. LOGARITHMS SELF-CHECK Keywords: Powers; Logarithms Use the properties of Logarithms to solve each of the following problems: 1. 3 x 5 = ____. 2. 3/5 = ____. 3. 84 = ____. 4. Solve the following equation for X: 16 = 4(102X) LOGARITHMS SELF-CHECK ANSWERS 1. 15 2. .6 3. 4096 If you had difficulty with any of these problems, please study Appendix Section A.8, page 746. EXPONENTIAL FUNCTION SELF-CHECK Use the properties of exponential functions to solve each of the following problems. 1. If the population of a growing country is governed by the relation, N = 100,000.124t, where t is in years, how long will it take for the population to double? 2. Predict the total population of the country in 10 years. EXPONENTIAL FUNCTION SELF-CHECK ANSWERS 1. 5.0 years 2. 350 thousand If you had difficulty with either of the problems posed above, please turn to Appendix Section A.9, page 748. PRACTICE TEST 1. (Powers of Ten Notation and Significant Figures) Solve the following problems using the powers of ten notation. In each case write your answer with the appropriate number of significant figures. a) 731 x 1.009 x 431/0.005 = ____. b) 4.7 x 10-7 x 2.51 x 105/2.10-3 = ____. c) Solve for A: 795 x 73.45 x 103 A = 1.0007 x 104 = ____. 2. (Cartesian Graphs and Dimensional Analysis) The following data were taken from a physics laboratory experiment. --------------------------Velocity of a Rolling Coin Time (m/s) (S) ---------------------------50 0 +15 4 +45 7 +95 11 a) Plot a graph showing velocity and time for this rolling object. b) Calculate the slope of the curve at (4, 15). c) Give the proper dimensions to the slope. 3. (Right Triangles) To find the height of a tall building, a physics student steps 75 paces (each 1 meter) from the base of the building. Using a ruler at arm's length (1 meter), the student finds that at this distance, the building appears to be 50 centimeters when compared to the ruler. Determine the approximate height of the building. 4. (Exponents) Calculate the following using the laws of exponents. a) 54 ÷ 5-3 = ____. b) 108 x 10-3 = _____. c) 123.6 x 12- 4.2 = ____. 5. (Logarithms) Use the properties of logarithms to solve each of the following problems. a) 7 x 4 = ____. b) 20 ÷ 4 = ____. c) 93 = ____. d) Solve the following equation for X: 2700 = 300(103X) 6. (Exponential Function) Use the properties of the exponential function to solve the following problem: a) A biologist determines that during the month of June, the number of live frogs in a small pond is governed by the relationship N = 189e. 075t (t is the number of days). How long will it be until the number of frogs is three times its initial population? b) Predict the total population of frogs by the end of the month (30 days). ANSWERS: 1. a) 6.36 x 107 b) 6 x 101 c) 1.52 x 10-1 2. b) 10 c) m/sec2 3. 38 m 4. a) 57 b) 105 c) 12-.6 5. a) 28 b) 5 c) 728 d) .32 6. a) 14.6 days b) 1800 Chapter 1 Human Senses GOALS Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Humans; Sensory Systems; Transducers; Energy; Force; Interactions; Variables; States Of Systems; Systems; Intensity When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define the following terms, which can be used to describe a relationship between you and your environment: system energy state force variable field interaction intensity transducer Stimuli List the major external stimuli that are detectable by humans. Human Responses Describe an elementary threshold measurement experiment, and interpret the data obtained. Models Use a mental construct, or model, to explain a common human experience. PREREQUISITES You may find it necessary to review your knowledge of the powers of ten notation before you study this chapter. OVERVIEW Keywords: Sensory Systems; ; Instructions Without much difficulty you can probably name the five senses of the human body. As man has learned more about his surroundings, he has learned more about himself and about his ability to interact with his environment. In this chapter you will learn about the physical nature of your human senses. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE When you begin your study of this chapter, be familiar with each of the four Chapter Goals: Definitions, Stimuli, Human Responses, and Models. (Please note than an expanded discussion of each term listed under Definitions is given on the next page of this .) Next, read Chapter Sections 1.1-1.8. Be sure to attempt some of the more interesting Simple Experiments suggested and consider several of the probing questions posed at the end of most of the sections. (Answers to these questions are given in the second section of this .) At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-4. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1-6 and complete Exercises 1, 2, 3, 4, 7, and 8. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Human Senses found in this . This study procedure is outlined below. -------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises & Text Readings Exercises Problems Problems -------------Definitions 1.1-1.7 1 Stimuli 1.1-1.3 2 1,3 3,4,7,8 Human Responses 1.4-1.6 2,3 2,4,5,6 1,2 Models 1.8 4 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Transducers; Interactions; Energy; States Of Systems; Variables; Force; Systems; Fields; Intensity SYSTEM A whole entity. In marked contrast to the holistic thinking that characterizes much of human activity, physics uses an analytical technique that seeks to understand complex situations by dividing them into separate parts which we call systems. We try to imagine that a system is a separate part of the universe which we can study without the system being changed either by our study or by whatever is happening in the rest of the universe. For example, if we wish to study the physics of human hearing, we will define the system of study as the human hearing system and include within it all of the parts of the body that are necessary to hear sounds. Of course, such a system is quite unreal since you cannot hear anything if the other parts of your body cease to function. Nevertheless, this mental, somewhat artificial, technique of dividing up the universe into separate systems has allowed us to make great strides in the study of nature. VARIABLE Quantity that is subject to change. Once you have picked a system for study you can analyze the ways you can change or vary the characteristics of the system. For example, you can modify the human hearing system by the use of drugs or the use of ear plugs. The properties of a system that we can change or vary we call variables. One big idea of physics is to find all of the important variables of a system and see how changes in each of the variables affects the rest of the system. You will notice once again the analytical approach, chop a system into parts called variables, and see if we can understand the whole system by finding the ways the variables influence one another. STATE Particular form or condition of a system. It is usual for physicists to define the starting point of their study of a system by attempting to give all of the important variables of the system some initial value thereby specifying the initial state of the system. For example, if you wished to study the influence of various amount of cotton ear plugs on human hearing, you could define your starting condition, or initial state, as a well rested, typical human with no wax or obstructions in the ear canals. TRANSDUCER A sensor or detector that transforms a change in one physical variable to a change in another. In many cases we wish to observe the changes in the properties of a system. Often it is possible to infer a change in a system by measuring a related, but different, property. In such a situation we make use of a transducer, a part of the system that relates the change of one variable of the system to another. For example, the eardrum acts to transform the sounds that fall on your ear into vibrations of the eardrum which are subsequently transformed into the electrical messages that are sent to your brain. The eardrum serves as a transducer. INTERACTION Action or influence exerted between systems. If we wish to study the influence of one system on another we say we will study the interaction between two systems. Then we will proceed to change the values of variables of one system to see if that causes any changes in the values of the variables of the second system, e.g., if we change the noise level in the room where our human subject is located that will change the response of a typical person. ENERGY Property of a system which causes changes in its own state or state of its surroundings; measure of ability to do work (physical). One way to specify the state of a system is to compute the energy of the system. Energy is a kind of imaginary property of a system that physicists have invented to help define in a more holistic way the state of a system. We never actually measure energy directly but only calculate it from other variables that we can measure. In a sense, energy is to a system as meaning is to a poem. In general, a group of physicists think that they can objectively agree upon the energy of a system, while a group of poets are not likely to think that they can objectively agree upon the meaning of a poem. Does the fact that ten people can agree upon the same value of an imaginary quantity make it truly objective? FORCE A measure of the strength of an interaction; a push or pull; the effect of a force is to alter the state of motion of a body. A vector quantity with a magnitude measured in Newtons (N). From our earliest experiences as children we know of the interactions between systems by physical contact. From our beginnings as humans we have responded to the direct contact of another person. Throughout our early experiences of collisions with walls and falling down we know of the effects of direct contact interactions. We use the term force to designate the strength of interaction between two systems. We have the idea that a greater force applied to a system is most likely to cause a greater change in the system. FIELD A region of space characterized by a physical property which has a determinable value at every point in the region, e.g., gravitational field, magnetic field, etc. Our experiences with direct contact interactions are so convincing that physicists have invented a concept of a field that can be used to bring into contact systems that may be widely separated from one another. The physicist just imagines a field exists everywhere between the two systems and the field of one system may exert a force on the second system. INTENSITY Energy transported through a unit area in one second. Another idea that is readily associated in our minds with direct contact interactions is the transfer of energy from one system to another, such as the energy of food being transferred to the energy of your body via the life processes. In a similar way we can think of a field as having a source which emanates energy to all objects in its field. We characterize the intensity of a field by the amount of energy its source emanates per unit of area in one second. If we are in the field of a light bulb our eyes interpret the intensity of the bulb in terms of brightness, the more intense the source, the greater is the brightness of the light. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Systems; States of Systems; Humans; Anatomy And Physiology; Biology; Variables SECTION 1.2 The Human System 1. A human being is a complex set of interacting systems. To properly describe in a holistic way your present state would require you to define the different states of your basic body systems such as the skeletal-muscular system, digestive system, urinary system, respiratory system, circulatory system, nervous system, and reproductive system. You are usually not very aware of the present state of any of these systems even though your brain must continually monitor the activities that occur in all parts of your body. To determine the present state of your circulatory system you could find your pulse rate, blood pressure, and results of various tests on your blood. Even so, many details of your circulatory system would be left undefined. 2. Your present state is determined by the values of many variables of the body systems listed above. Such variables as pulse rate, blood pressure, etc., can be specified. However, there is evidence that personality features such as self-worth or faith can have an important influence on many of your physiological variables. Historically such variables as faith and self-worth are classified as not being physical observables. SECTION 1.3 The Human Detector Keywords: ; Answers; Sensory Systems; Interactions; Energy; Electric Fields; Gravitational Fields; Sound; Light And Optics; Auditory Systems; Optical Systems; Human Body 3. At this moment you are interacting with your environment through a wide variety of systems. The force of the chair on your bottom is a mechanical energy interaction. Your eyes are responding to electromagnetic, or light, energy. Your ears are picking up sound energy. Your nose and taste buds sense odors and tastes by chemical energy. Your body is said to be immersed in the gravitational and electromagnetic fields of the earth and sun. The influence of these fields upon you is not well understood. 4. In general, we can think of the odor, sound, gravitational, and light or electromagnetic interactions as being interactions-at-a-distance, while taste of food and the force of the chair may be envisioned as direct contact interactions. SECTION 1.4 Direct-Contact Interactions Keywords: Answers; ; Interactions; Sensory Systems; Tactile Systems; Thermal Regulatory Systems; Human Body 5. There are areas of your back, legs, and feet that seem relatively insensitive to touch. Your finger tips, tongue, and forehead is quite touch sensitive. 6. By tasting a variety of known salt concentrations it is believed you could train yourself to be a salt water taster. Just as, after years of practice, persons are able to perfect their taste sense to become professional wine tasters. 7. Both the inside of your arm and your lips are particularly thermal sensitive while your hands and face have fewer nerves to detect heat and cold than other parts of your body. SECTION 1.5 Interaction-at-a-Distance Keywords: ; Answers; Interactions; Action At A Distance; Human Body; Electromagnetic Waves; Sound; Gravitational Forces; Sensory Systems 8. You have surely experienced sunshine, music, noise, voices, smells and food today. Have you climbed some stairs, ridden a bicycle up a hill, or hiked to the top of a mountain? 9. Sunshine (electromagnetic); music, noise, voices (sound); smells and food (odor); stairs, hill, mountain (gravitational). 10. Your ears are never shut, so the interaction-at-a-distance most common for non-deaf humans is probably sound. SECTION 1.7 Threshold for the Sense of Touch Keywords: Answers; ; Human Body; Tactile Systems; Thresholds 11. Various whole body variables such as state of restfulness, lack of influence of drugs, normal blood pressure and blood sugar concentrations, etc. 12. One source of error is the inability of a subject to tell exactly when a touch is felt. Doing repeated measurements with each subject in a varying sequence of locations so that several threshold measurements are performed at each location should prove helpful in reducing this uncertainty. 13. Figure 1.3 shows a technique that can be used to determine the distance between distinct contact points. SECTION 1.8 Model Building Keywords: ; Answers; Models; Humans; Sensory Systems; Philosophical Implications 14. In each of these cases a powerful group of persons developed an explanation of the behaviors of other groups of humans that defined them as less than human, e.g., savages, enemies of progress, threats to national security. These mental constructs, or models, were used to justify a wide variety of inhumane and unjust treatments. 15. For most scientists, the subject areas of extrasensory perception, of mind-brain research, and of how the human beings develop logical thought are still not scientifically ordered. Two areas of science, molecular biology and astrophysics, have contributed new concepts to our daily language by popularizing the double helix and black holes. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Problems; Answers; Transducers; Evaluation; Interactions; Thresholds; Humans; Sensory Systems; Questions; Heat; Action At A Distance; Tactile Systems; Auditory Systems; Models; Sound; Contact; Forces; Scientific Method 1. You are in a swimming pool several meters away from another person also in the pool. Name below three methods you might use to gain the person's attention. For each case, identify or describe transducer you use and mark the interaction as either a contact (C) or action-at-a-distance (A-D). Method Transducer Interaction (C or A-D) 1. _____________________________________________________ 2. _____________________________________________________ 3. _____________________________________________________ 2. Imagine that you are taking a shower in a bath with "inadequate plumbing" and find the shower temperature difficult to control. As the water temperature changes drastically, please describe the response your body makes to this variable in terms of a. Threshold b. Sensitivity c. Discrimination 3. The different parts of your body respond with different sensitivity to outside physiological stimuli. Consider the bottom of the feet and their response to four major stimuli as outlined below. Please rank each stimuli from 1- body part most sensitive to stimulus to 4-body part least sensitive to stimulus. Body Part or Area Tested - Bottom of Feet Ranking Stimuli Interaction ______ Heat Contact ______ Visible light Action at a distance ______ Ultraviolet light Action at a distance ______ Low frequency sound Action at a distance 4. What is a "model" in physics? ANSWERS: 1. Shouting, Vocal Chords, A-D Making Waves, Hands & Arms, A-D Splashing Water, Hands & Arms, C 2. Threshold - Minimum temperature difference detected by the body Sensitivity Body's receptors reaction to various incoming energy (heat) levels Discrimination - Detection of temperature differences across the shower spray or ability to tell if the temperature of the water is changing with time. 3. 1, 4, 2, 3 (other answers accepted under other physical conditions). 4. A model is a specification of a unification of ideas which help to visualize a variety of experiences. In physics, these experiences deal primarily with aspects of the physical nature of the world. Chapter 2 Unifying Approaches GOALS When you have mastered the content of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use each term in an operational definition: equilibrium restoring force conservation laws inertia oscillatory motion feedback gradient linear system natural frequency current superposition resonance Inertia Give an example of a physical system that has mechanical, thermal, and electrical inertia. Energy Transfer Explain how you would maximize the transfer of energy at the interface between two systems. Superposition Solve problems making use of the superposition principle-given the proper physical variables of the systems. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 1, Human Senses. If you have not recently been working with cartesian coordinate graphs and dimensional relations, you may wish to review the material on graphs and dimensional analysis in the mathematical background supplement in the appendix. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Inertia; Superposition Principle; Flow Of Energy As men have attempted to make sense of physical phenomena, a series of approaches have emerged. Some of these approaches are descriptive, some are mathematical, some may be both. In this chapter you will study some of the basic approaches used again and again to understand and/or explain the actions of a variety of physical phenomena. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE In this chapter, you should direct your study toward all four Chapter Goals: Definitions, Inertia, Energy Transfer, and Superposition. An expanded treatment of each of the terms listed under Definitions is given on the next page of this Study Guide. Next, read all the chapter sections, 2.1-2.10. Please note the questions asked throughout your reading. Answers to these questions are given in the following pages of this . At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-11. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1, 2, 3, 4, 7, and 8. Finally, complete Exercises and Problems 2, 3, 4, and 5. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Unifying Approaches given in this . This study procedure is outlined below. ------------------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ------------------------------Definitions 2.1, 2.2, 2.4, 1-6 2 2.9, 2.10 Inertia 2.3 7-9 1, 2 3, 4 Energy Transfer 2.5 10 3, 4 5 Superposition 2.6, 2.7, 2.8 11 7, 8 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Equilibrium; Inertia; Kinds Of Force; Oscillations; Oscillatory Motion; Waves And Sound; Superposition Principle; Gradient; Conservative Laws; Feedback; Resonance; Frequency EQUILIBRIUM All the influences acting on the system are canceled by others, resulting in a balanced unchanging system. Nature is comfortable. Everything else being equal, the systems in nature tend to their lowest possible energy states and to equilibrium, a state in which all the external disturbances acting on a system are balanced or canceled out. Perhaps you are presently seated, relaxed, reading this . You are in a state of equilibrium. INERTIA Property of system that is a measure of the system's resistance to change. If you wish to stand up, the bulk of your body tends to remain seated. The tendency to stay put is called inertia and is given a numerical value of mass for systems in which motion is studied. Whereas this resistance to motion is called mechanical inertia, the resistance an object offers to the flow of electrical change is called electrical inertia and the resistance to heat flow is called thermal inertia. RESTORING FORCE Force acting to return a displaced body to equilibrium position. You may have had the task of trying to move an automobile, or motorcycle, stuck in the mud or snow. In its stuck condition, it was in equilibrium: when you pushed it you moved it from its equilibrium position. When you stopped pushing it may have rocked back and forth about its starting position. Most systems in equilibrium experience a force that tends to move them back to their original position if you only move them a small amount from equilibrium. This force is called a restoring force. OSCILLATORY MOTION Characteristic motion of systems having a linear restoring force. The action of a restoring force on a system causes the system to rock back and forth about the original position. This back and forth motion is called Oscillatory Motion. LINEAR SYSTEM A system in which the restoring force is directly proportional to the displacement. Suppose you attempt to push a stuck vehicle out of the snow or mud. If you find that you must push twice as hard to move it twice as far from its original equilibrium position, this system is called a Linear System. Once this fact is established, simple addition can be used to estimate the number of pushers (each pushing the same amount) needed to get your vehicle out of trouble. If you can push it one-fourth of the way out, then four persons (all pushing the same direction) should be able to push it all the way out. SUPERPOSITION The resultant effect is equal to the sum of the individual independent effects. A principle that holds true for linear systems. When linear and independent systems interact, the total effect of their action can be found by simply adding the contribution of each. Please note that an application of this superposition principle in the definition of linear system was used in the case of a vehicle stuck in the snow or mud. When one person can push the vehicle onefourth of the way out of its position, four persons should be able to push it all the way out. Note that if five persons were to push, three one way and two the other, the vehicle would move one-fourth of the way from equilibrium. GRADIENT Rate of change of a physical quantity relative to position. What is the present temperature of your surroundings? The thermal conditions of your surroundings is one of the most important aspects of maintaining a comfortable environment. We readily notice a temperature difference when we go from inside to outside a building in winter or in summer. If a variable, such as temperature, has different values at two different locations, then we can talk about gradient, in this case a temperature gradient, existing between the two locations. We compute the size of a temperature gradient by calculating the ratio of the difference between the temperatures at the two locations to the distance between the locations. CURRENT A steady and onward movement of a physical quantity. The ratio of the change in a quantity to the change in time. Consider the wall of a home where the inside temperature is much higher than the outside temperature. Because of the difference of temperature, we can detect a flow of heat or current from the inside to the outside which occurs in response to the temperature gradient. For simple systems the current is a linear function of the gradient. CONSERVATION LAWS There is no change in a physical property with a change in time. In many life situations we get our bearings from fixed objects, whether they are the North star, the city hall, or the university bell tower. Similarly, in physics we look for fixed, or constant, properties of a system to help us understand it. A property of a system which does not change is called a conserved property, or quantity. We can then formulate a conservation law for the system we are studying. A conservation law, simply put, states that even though time marches on, a particular property of the system does not change. It would be difficult to overemphasize the importance of conservation laws in the growth of physics. In systems where conservation laws seem to be violated, physicists have invented new variables to preserve conservation. Now physicists have a whole list of properties of systems that can be conserved under certain conditions, such properties as energy, mass, electrical charge, momentum, atomic number, strangeness, charm, baryon number, etc. The list seems to get longer every year, as new conservation laws are invented. FEEDBACK A portion of the output from a system is returned as input into the same system. A common result of positive feedback is the squeal that occurs when an amplifying system is not correctly used at a musical event. The result often occurs when the amplifier system speakers are placed close enough to the microphone to have the amplified sound picked up by the microphone and circulated through the system again. NATURAL FREQUENCY The frequency of a freely vibrating system, i.e., the number of vibrations per second that are characteristic of the system. If you strike the middle C key on a piano you excite the natural frequency of vibration of the stretched wire in the back of the piano. It oscillates at a frequency of 256 vibrations per second. RESONANCE Occurs when the frequency of the external force equals a natural frequency of the system. Resonance occurs when the frequency of an external interaction equals the natural frequency of the system. On a playground swing, to pump up the amplitude of the swing you must pull on the swing support chains at the proper time using a frequency of pulling equal to the frequency with which the swing goes to and fro. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Answers; ; Superposition; Principle; Feedback; Systems; Equilibrium; Oscillatory Motion; Oscillations; Waves And Sound SECTION 2.3 Inertia 1. Some systems in equilibrium are your (Fuller)3 physics text resting on your study table and your head resting on your hand with your elbow on the chair arm in your physics lecture. 2. Both of the above systems may tend to move back to their original position if lifted slightly. Gravitational interaction and your muscles will provide the restoring forces. 3. Suppose you can define a lack of knowledge parameter, a misconception parameter, and a concrete reasoning parameter. In each type of property, knowledge, concept, and reasoning, your class will have a characteristic average inertial parameter. The class may be slow to respond to rapid changes in knowledge, concepts, and reasoning. SECTION 2.7 Feedback 4. The input for you is the information you are taking in from your environment. If you process that information and use it to modify the information you are taking in by asking a question or writing an explanation of a comment in your notebook, then you are using feedback. For your instructor, the input is information that is gathered from the students by means of questions, smiles, nods, or snores. The instructor uses feedback from the information to change the approach being used in the classroom to respond to student input. SECTION 2.8 Superposition Principle 5. There are a number of old myths that indicate marriage is not a linear transformation. "Two can live as cheaply as one," for example is no doubt false, but it does indicate a common understanding that superposition does not apply to marriage, i.e., the total of the married couple is not the sum of the individual persons. 6. A collection of marbles is a linear system with respect to number, weight, and volume occupied. A school of fish is linear with respect to volume occupied and oxygen used. A school of children is not linear with respect to economic factors. See Fig. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Superposition Principle; Speed; Galilean-Newtonian Relativity; Arithmetic; Scalar Arithmetic SUPERPOSITION 1. An Amtrak train is roaring East through Lincoln, Nebraska, at a speed of 100 km/hr. The conductor on board is collecting tickets from the back to the front of the train while walking at a speed of 2 km/hour. Meanwhile, a dining car waiter is serving hot dishes by rushing back and forth from the kitchen at a speed of 8 km/hour. What are the speeds of the various moving objects with respect to Lincoln? What Data Are Given? The speed of the train with respect to Lincoln = 100 km/hr. East The speed of the conductor with respect to the train = 2 km/hr. to the front The speeds of the waiter with respect to the train = 8 km/hr. to the front = 8 km/hr. toward the back What Data Are Implied? The speeds of all three are assumed to be along the same East- West line, so that linear superposition holds true. What Physics Principles Are Involved? Superposition - in this case, the algebraic sum of the various numbers. What Equations Are to be Used? We can write algebraic expressions for this problem by assigning symbols; let st = speed of the train, sf = speed of object moving forward on the train and sb = speed of object moving backward on the train. Algebraic Solutions The speed of an object with respect to Lincoln sL is given by sL = st + sf for forward moving objects. sL = st - sb for backward moving objects. Numerical Solutions sL (train) = 100 km/hr. East sL (conductor) = 100 km/hr. + 2 km/hr. = 102 km/hr. East sL (waiter) = 100 km/hr. + 8 km/hr. = 108 km/hr. East when he is moving toward the front sL (waiter) = 100 km/hr. - 8 km/hr. = 92 km/hr. East when he is moving toward the back of the train. Thinking About the Answers Keywords: Einstein, Albert A.; Humor; Notice that the speed of the train is so much larger than the speeds of the conductor and the waiter that their motion relative to the train does little to change their motion relative to Lincoln. Their motion does seem important to them and the other people on the train. Notice also the analytic style of problem-solving. The final question is answered by cutting it into small pieces and using superposition. See Fig. PRACTICE TEST 1. Suppose after you have accurately weighed a small sample on an equal arm balance, you accidentally touch the balance pan, what happens? Describe the initial state of the balance, and its subsequent behavior. 2. List the three kinds of inertia of an electric frying pan. Give a specific action you can perform to verify the existence of each kind of inertia. 3. On a cold day in January, the inside wall of a home has a temperature of 29ø C. Twelve centimeters away, the outside wall has a temperature of - 7ø C. What is the temperature gradient? Which way does heat flow? 4. Eight college students are deadlocked in tug of war. A ninth student joins the contest. What physical principle can you use to predict the outcome? What do you predict will happen? If your prediction does not come true, how can you explain that? ANSWERS: Keywords: Questions; ; Equilibrium; Inertia; Superposition Principle; Harmonic Oscillations; Oscillations; Oscillatory Motion; Properties Of Oscillations; Evaluations; Gradients 1. Initial state - equilibrium (no motion); subsequent behavior - restoring force causes harmonic motion about the balance position (the equilibrium position). 2. A Mass inertia - Attempt to give the pan a velocity by pulling on it with a spring balance or to stop once placed in motion. B. Electrical inertia - Apply a voltage and determine the resistance to the flow of current. C. Thermal inertia - Turn on current and place a thermometer in contact with the pan. Note the time necessary to "warm-up" or one hot, to "cool- down". 3. GRAD = DT/DX = 29-(-7)/12 = 3ø C/cm. Heat flows from inside to the outside. 4. At the start, the forces exerted by each team place the rope in equilibrium. If another person is added, the principle of superposition would predict that either A) his team will win (he exerts a force to help his team) or B) his team will lose (he pulled the wrong way, helping the opponents). Chapter 3 Kinematics GOALS When you have mastered the content of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Use the following terms to describe the physical state of a system: displacement velocity uniform circular acceleration motion uniformly accelerated motion radial acceleration projectile motion tangential acceleration Equations of Motion Write the equations of motion for objects with constant velocity and for objects with constant acceleration. Motion Problems Solve problems involving freely falling and other uniformly accelerated bodies, projectile motion, and uniform circular motion. Acceleration Effects List the effects of acceleration on the human body. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 1, Human Senses, and Chapter 2, Unifying Approaches. You must also be able to use the properties of right triangles to solve problems. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Mechanics; Kinematics As you look over this chapter you will find a large number of algebraic equations. These expressions are used in describing the basic motion of objects. In this chapter, the four basic kinds of motion which are described are 1) Linear Motion (Section 3.6), 2) Uniformly Accelerated Motion (Section 3.7), 3) Projectile Motion (Section 3.8), and 4) Uniform Circular Motion (Section 3.9). SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE As you begin to study this chapter, be familiar with the Chapter Goals: Definitions, Equations of Motion, Motion Problems, andAcceleration Effects. (A brief explanation of each of the terms listed under Definitions is given on the next page of this .) The initial sections of this chapter require a knowledge of trigonometry. If necessary, you may want to review the properties of Right Triangles found in the Appendix, Section A.6. Next, read Chapter Sections 3.1-3.10. Be sure to work through the detailed examples given in most of the sections. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-14. Check your answers against those that are given. If you don't understand a specific answer, try reviewing that section of the text. Finally, complete Algorithmic Problems 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, and 12, Exercises 3, 4, 8, 9, 10, and 11, and Problems 14, 18, and 20. Now you should be prepared to attempt a Practice Test for Kinematics. This study procedure is outlined below. ----------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ----------------------Definitions 3.1,3.2,3.3,3.4 1-7 1,2 3.5, 3.6 Equations of Motion 3.2,3.5,3.6 8-10 3,4,5,9 3, 4 Motion Problems 3.7,3.8,3.9 11-13 6,10,11,12 8,9,10,11 14,18,20 Acceleration Effects 3.10 14 6 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Mechanics; Kinematics; Velocity; Displacement; Acceleration; Angular Acceleration; Projectile Motion; Uniform Circular Motion; Circular Motion; Kinds Of Motion DISPLACEMENT Change in location of an object specified by both magnitude and direction from a given origin. When you raise your coffee cup to your lips you are displacing the cup. If you raise it 30 cm and bring it toward 30 cm then the total displacement is 30 cm up and 30 cm over, a resultant displacement of about 52 cm at an angle of 45º above the horizontal from the table to your lips. You will notice that the resultant displacement is a vector that does not necessarily point in direction of actual motion but only from the starting position to the final position. VELOCITY Ratio of change in displacement to the change in time. If you lift your coffee cup (above) straight up in 1/10 second and then pull it horizontal to your lips, the average velocity is 300 cm/sec up, followed by a horizontal average velocity of 300 cm/sec toward you. Notice again that the resultant velocity does not point in the direction of any actual motion, rather the velocity points in the direction of the change in displacement. In this case it is 520 cm/sec in a direction 45º above horizontal from the table to your lips. ACCELERATION Ratio of the change in velocity to the change in time. Any object that you start from rest undergoes a period of acceleration while you are bringing it up to its final velocity. Notice that acceleration is a vector that points in the direction of the change in velocity and may not point in the direction of the displacement. The acceleration of an object following a curved path always has a component of the acceleration in the direction of curvature. UNIFORMLY ACCELERATED MOTION Motion of an object whose acceleration is constant, i.e., both the magnitude and direction of the acceleration remain the same for all times. Notice the restrictions that are placed upon motion for it to be of this kind. The change in velocity must always be in the same direction and constant. Therefore, the velocity must always be in the same direction. Hence the change in displacement is always in the same direction so the displacement occurs along a straight line. There are no systems you meet in everyday life that exactly satisfy these conditions. Nevertheless, there are systems, such as freely falling objects, that are nearly described by this motion. PROJECTILE MOTION An object has constant velocity in one direction and uniform acceleration in a direction at right angles to the constant velocity. This motion represents the idealized motion of objects near the surface of the earth when spin and wind are neglected. UNIFORM CIRCULAR MOTION Objects moving in a circle with constant speed. Think of riding on a merry-go-round. Your speed may be constant but the direction you are going keeps changing. Perhaps you start out going East, then North, then West, then South and back toward the East again. So you go around and around. Your acceleration is a vector pointing toward the center of the circle. RADIAL ACCELERATION Acceleration directed toward center of curvature of motion, i.e., perpendicular to the curve of the movement of the object in space. For uniformly accelerated motion the radial acceleration is zero since the motion is in a straight line. For uniform circular motion, all of the acceleration is radial acceleration. TANGENTIAL ACCELERATION Acceleration directed along the direction of motion, tangent to the curve of the path of movement of the object in space. For uniformly accelerated motion all of the acceleration is tangential acceleration. For uniform circular motion, none of the acceleration is tangential acceleration. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Answers; ; Vectors; Distance; Displacement; Mechanics; Kinematics; Kinds Of Motion; Graphs; Acceleration; Time; Uniform Motion; Linear Motion; Area; Slope; Velocity SECTION 3.1 Introduction Your present state of motion is probably a state of rest as you move your eyes to read this page. In contrast, during a race an Olympic sprinter starts from rest, tries to increase her speed as fast as possible and then run at top speed to the finish line. On the other hand, an astronaut moving about in a spacecraft in orbit around the earth seldom uses his legs to propel himself around the craft. He seems to hover just about the floor of the space lab and move around in straight paths between objects. SECTION 3.2 Characteristics of Distance and Displacement In order to add a 3 km vector displacement to a 3 km vector displacement you must know the angle between the vectors. What angle between these vectors must you use to obtain a resultant of 3 km? The numerical answer is given at the end of Section 3.3 of the textbook. SECTION 3.5 Characteristics of Motion In many motion problems the vector nature of displacement and velocity are important aspects of the problem. To overlook the "vectorness" of certain properties of physical system is a common mistake among beginning students of physics. When reading a problem for the first time, remember that some quantities may be vectors and must be treated by the special rules of vector algebra. SECTION 3.6 Linear Motion The answers to questions 1-7 are given in the textbook. Notice that for a velocity versus time graph the area under the curve represents the displacement and the slope of the curve represents the acceleration. SECTION 3.7 Uniformly Accelerated Motion Notice that in the data shown in tables 3.2 and 3.3 the distance down the incline increases more rapidly than the time; i.e., when the time doubles the distance is more than doubled, it is about four times as large. During the time intervals from 0-1 sec to 0-2 seconds, or from 0-2 seconds to 0-4 seconds, the distance ratios are 12.4/49.2 or 49.2/198.8 for the unweighted car and 12.0/48.3 or 48.3/198.2 for the weighted car. In both cases, if the time is doubled, the distance is quadrupled. Likewise, if the time is tripled, the distance is nine times as much. These data, then, indicate a quadratic relationship between distance and time as shown in Equations 3.10. We can conclude that the car is undergoing uniformly accelerated motion down the incline. In fact, the weighted and unweighted cars appear to have almost the same acceleration. An explanation of the seeming puzzling behavior of more massive objects is discussed in Chapter 4. If you plot the data given in the Example on page 51 you will obtain a straight line graph for the velocity versus time with a positive slop of 2m/s2 and starting at (0, 0). The equation of the line is v = 2t. SECTION 3.10 Effects of Acceleration Within the body it seems likely that food is accelerated down the throat and esophagus to the stomach. It decelerates in the stomach. The blood is accelerated as it leaves the heart and decelerates on its return trip to the heart. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Acceleration; Distance; Time; Projectile Motion; Acceleration Due To Gravity; Free Fall; Centripetal Acceleration; Arithmetic; Scalar Arithmetic; Linear Motion; Angular Acceleration; Circular Motion; Circular Orbits; Mechanics MOTION PROBLEMS 1. A physics student accidentally rolled out of bed while dreaming about uniform circular motion. What was his speed just before he hit the floor? What Data Are Given? An object (a student) of unknown mass falls from rest an unknown distance and hits a floor. What Data Are Implied? If we assume the student falls under idealized conditions, then we can treat his motion as uniformly accelerated motion down with an acceleration of 9.8 m/s2. A typical bed is about 50 cm above the floor. What Physics Principles Are Involved? If we assumed idealized falling motion, then we can use the principles of uniformly accelerated motion. The Equations 3.10 are for the special condition of starting from rest with an initial displacement of zero. Both special conditions can be met by this example. What Equations Are to be Used? In this case we know the acceleration, a = 9.8 m/s2, and the distance of fall, s = 50 cm or 0.50 meters, and we are seeking the velocity, so we can use the following equation from 3.10: 2 a • s = vf2 (3.10) where the acceleration a is given by the usual free fall value of 9.8 m/s2, or g. Algebraic Solution 2gs = vf2 so: vf = (SQR RT) (2gs) Numerical Solution vf = (SQR ROOT) [2(9.8 m/s2)(0.50 m)] = (SQR RT) (9.8 m2/s2) vf = 2.2 m/s Thinking About the Answer Notice that the units obtained for the answer, namely meters divided by seconds, are the proper units for a velocity. 2. A student is skiing down a hill and wishes to take twice as long to reach the bottom, so she starts up higher on the side of the hill. How much farther up must she start? What Data Are Given? A person of unknown mass is skiing down a slope of unknown incline. What Data Are Implied? This problem implies idealized uniformly accelerated motion of unknown acceleration a. What Physics Principles Are Involved? This problem requires the use of the concepts of uniformly accelerated motion for the special case of starting from rest, doubling the time of motion, and finding the distance travelled. Equations 3.10 may be used. What Equations Are to be Used? In this case, we infer a starting rest position at a location on the side of the hill. After a time the skier reaches the bottom. The problem is to find the distance if the time is to be doubled. The following equation combines all the known quantities s = 1/2 at2 (3.10) Algebraic Solution Let t1 be the first time, s1 is the first distance, and "a" is the acceleration; then s1 = 1/2 at12 Let t2 be the second time, twice the first time, so t2 = 2t1, then the second distance s2 is given by s2 = 1/2 at22 = 1/2 a(2t1)2 s2 = (1/2 at12)4 = 4s1. So the skier must start up the hill a distance 4s1, four times the first starting distance. 3. A member of the university girls' basketball team dribbled the length of the court and at a distance of 15 meters from the basket, she reached up to a height of 2.5 m and launched a shot with an initial speed of 10 m/s for maximum range. Is it possible she made a basket? What Data Are Given? The distance of the origin of the launch is 15 m from the basket. The height of the origin of the shot is 2.5 m from the floor and the initial speed is 12 m/s. What Data Are Implied? The height of the basket is 3.0 m (10 ft.) from the floor. The angle of launch for maximum range is 45º (see page 56). Idealized projectile motion of a point particle is assumed so we can draw the following sketch of the problem: What Physics Principles Are Involved? The basic equations of projectile motion must be used. The problem is to determine if the ball can be 3.0 m above the floor when it is 15 m in a horizontal direction from the launch location that is 2.5 m above the floor. A combination of the equations (3.12) and (3.13) are required to solve this problem. What Equations Are to be Used? The proper horizontal and vertical displacements must be obtained by the ball to go through the loop, so we need to use the horizontal and vertical displacement equations: horizontal motion: sh = vht (3.12) vertical motion: sv = vvt + 1/2 gt2 (3.13) Algebraic Solution Let us proceed by assuming we know the horizontal displacement sh (which we will set equal to 15 m) and we can calculate the initial values for the vertical and horizontal components of the velocity. In the above equations the two unknown quantities are the time and the vertical distance. We can proceed by substituting a known expression, namely sh/vh for the time t and solving for the vertical displacement; sv = vv (sh/vh) + 1/2 g (sh/vh)2 where vv = v sin q; vn = v cos q where q is the angle of launch from horizontal, 45º for this problem, sv = (v sin q) (sh/(v cos q)) + 1/2g (sh2/v2cos2q) but sin q /cos q = tan q; so s v = sh tan q + 1/2 g (sh2/v2cos2q) Numerical Solution sh = 15 m tan q = tan 45º = 1.0, cos q = cos 45º = 1 / ((SQR RT) 2) g = -9.8 m/s2; v = 12 m/s sv = (15 m) (1.0) - 1/2 (9.8)m/s2 [(15)2m2/((12)2m2/sec2 (1/2))] sv = 15 m - (9.8)(225/144)m = -0.3 m So the shot drops below the basket by 0.8 m, since it should have been at +0.5 meters instead of -0.3 m. Thinking About the Answer This is a fairly complex problem which involves the use of several equations. It is a good idea on a problem like this one to check your procedures out carefully. 4. A skylab in orbit 435 km above the surface of the earth completes a trip around the earth in 93.0 minutes. It is 7.0 minutes after lift off when the lab finally achieves this orbit. (a) What is the average tangential acceleration necessary to obtain its orbital position? (b) What is the radial acceleration when it is in orbit? What Data Are Given? The skylab is in an orbit 435 km above the earth, since the earth's radius is 6.38 x 103 km; the radius of the orbit is (6.38 + 0.44) x 103 km or 6.82 x 103 km. The time for one orbit is 93.0 minutes or 5580 seconds. The time required to accelerate the skylab into its orbit is 7.0 minutes or 420 seconds. What Data Are Implied? The problem implies that the skylab is in a circular orbit. The average tangential acceleration is the value obtained by dividing the final tangential velocity by the time required for acceleration. What Physics Principles Are Involved? This problem requires you to use the equations for the radial and tangential acceleration for objects moving in a circular path. The magnitude of the average tangential acceleration is given by the following equation: at = (vt final - vt initial) / time and the direction is toward the larger value of the tangential velocity. The radial acceleration has a magnitude v2/r as derived on page 58 and points towards the center of the path. What Equations Are to be Used? The two equations given above will be needed plus a knowledge of the basic properties of circles and velocity. radial acceleration = (velocity)2/(radius) (3.21) tangential acceleration = (vf - vi) / time tangential velocity = circumference / time for one cycle = 2p(radius) / time Algebraic Solution (a) at = (vf - vi) / time of acceleration; but vi = 0 since the skylab starts from rest. Let t = time of acceleration. vt = (2p(r)) / time for one cycle; let T = time for one cycle for this problem, tangential acceleration = at = (2pr) / (T/t) = (2pr) / tT (b) radial acceleration = av = vf2/r = (2pr/T)2/r = (4p2r2) / rT2 = (4p2r) / T2 Numerical Solution t = 420 seconds; T = 5580 seconds r = 6.82 x 103 km = 6.82 x 106 m (a) tangential acceleration = at = (2p (6.82 x 106 m)) / (4.2 x 102 x 5.58 x 103s) at = 1.8 x 101 m/s2 = 18 m/s 2 towards increasing velocity. (b) radial acceleration ar = ar = [(4p2)(6.82 x 106 m)] / (5.58 x 103 s)2 ar = 8.6 m/s2, towards the center of the earth. Thinking About the Answer Notice how this problem combines many different concepts, your knowledge of the properties of circles from geometry, as well as the derived quantities from Section 3.9 in the book. This is typical of problems in physics. Any knowledge you gained from your previous experiences with mathematics or nature can be useful in solving physics problems. Notice that both answers came out with the correct units for acceleration, meters per second squared, m/s2. 4. Below we have given a step-by-step problem which we think will help you compare and contrast two different types of motion near the surface of the earth. Work the problem out in the spaces provided and then compare your answers with ours. (Show your work in this space) At the same instant in time, two slingshots are shot from the same location on the ground. The first slingshot shoots its projective vertically up into the air at a velocity of 98 m/s. The second slingshot shoots its projectile at an angle of 30º above the horizontal with a velocity of 196 m/s. (a) How long does it take the first projectile to reach the top of its trajectory? (b) How long does it take the second projectile to reach the top if its trajectory? (c) Give the position of the first projectile when it reaches the top of its path. (Hint: Assume the start position to be 0, 0 of a coordinate system and give the location in terms of its x, y position.) (d) Give the position of the second projectile at the top of its path. (Hint: Same as in the previous problem.) (e) What is the velocity of the first projectile at the top of its path? (f) What is the velocity of the second projectile at the top of its path? (g) How long does it take the first projectile to return to the ground? (h) How long does it take the second projectile to return to the ground? (i) Give the location of the point of impact when the first projectile hits the ground. (See hint in part c.) (j) Give the location of the second projectile when it strikes the ground. (See hint in part c.) (k) Tabulate the results of your calculations below and sketch the actual path of each projectile. Discuss the similarity and differences between the motion of the two projectiles. See Table. See Fig. (l) What is the acceleration of the first projectile at its maximum point? (m) What is the acceleration of the second projectile at its maximum point? ANSWERS: (a) 10 seconds; (b) 10 seconds; (c) 0,490 m; (d) (1670 m, 490 m); (e) 0 m/s; (f) 167 m/s horizontal; (g) 20 seconds; (h) 20 seconds; (i) 0, 0; (j) 3340 m, 0 m; (k) See fig. See Fig. (l) 9.8 m/s2, downward; (m) 9.8 m/s2, downward. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Problems; Questions; Answers; ; Mechanics; Kinematics; Evaluations; Time ; Graphs; Projectile Motion; Velocity ; Acceleration Due To Gravity ; Acceleration 1. A car traveling 54 meters/sec skids uniformly to rest in 6.0 seconds after the brakes are applied. a. What is the car's acceleration in meters/sec2? b. How many meters did the car skid in coming to rest? 2. An American space team in their command module is attempting to dock with the orbiting Skylab Spacecraft. They approach the craft along a straight course. The graph below gives the separation distance as a function of time. See Fig. a. Find the initial relative velocity of the two spacecrafts at zero seconds. b. What occurs at 200 seconds? c. What is the average velocity of relative motion during the first 400 sec. of the interval shown? 3. A golfer finds himself confronted with the golf shot diagrammed below. He has calculated that he is 90.0 meters from the green and knows that he must clear a 12 meter tree which stands half-way (and on a line) between the ball and the green. Hitting the ball with a nine iron gives the ball a velocity of 32 meters/sec at an angle q = 45º. a. What will be the ball's time of flight assuming that it does not strike the tree? b. Assuming that the ball is driven directly toward the green, will the ball clear the tree? Prove your answer. See Fig 4. Early test with the Rocket Sled illustrated that man was capable of withstanding large units of acceleration and deceleration. The test pilot was strapped to a padded chair and the sled was accelerated rapidly from rest and then decelerated rapidly from a high velocity to rest. If the accelerations were of the order of 5 g's, compare the physiological effects of the acceleration with those of deceleration. ANSWERS: 1. -9 m/sec2, 162 meters 2. - 25 m/sec, collision, -10 m/sec 3. 4.6 sec, yes! by 13.14 meters 4. For horizontal accelerations, both acceleration and decelerations have approximately the same effect: progressive tightness in chest, loss of peripheral vision, blurred vision, difficulty in speaking. Deceleration has all these with reduced chest pressure. Chapter 4 Forces and Newton's Law GOALS When you have mastered the concepts of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals. Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use each term in an operational definition: force coefficient of friction weight centripetal force frictional force weightlessness Newton's Laws State Newton's laws of motion and gravitation. Resolution of Forces Given the force acting on a system, draw a force diagram and/or resolve forces into their components and/or solve for an unknown force. Newton's Second Law Problems Given any two of the three variables in Newton's second law, solve for the third. Centripetal Force Problems Given any three of the four variables in the centripetal force equation, calculate the value of the fourth variable. PREREQUISITES Before you begin this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 3, Kinematics, including uniformly accelerated motion and uniform circular motion. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Mechanics; Dynamics; Newton's Laws; Force The statements which we call Newton's Laws of Motion are considered to be a central feature of the study of the motion of objects. These laws generalize much of our common experiences with forces and their influence on the state of motion of objects. As you read and consider the Laws of Motion presented in this chapter, make a point to relate the meaning of the laws to real experiences you have had with bicycles, automobiles, electric trains, etc. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE As you begin your study of this module, begin by carefully reading each of the Chapter Goals: Definitions, Newton's Laws, Resolution of Forces, Newton's Second Law Problems, and Centripetal Force Problems. Remember that on the next page of this you will find a paragraph concerning each of the terms listed under Definitions. Next, read text sections 4.1-4.7. Remember that answers to questions asked in the text are given in the second section of this . As you read, be sure to consider the examples given. If you have difficulties with the mathematical treatment of forces and their components, refer to the initial chapter of this (Chapter 0). At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-17. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, and 11. Check your answers to each problem carefully. Now complete Problems and Exercises 1, 2, 5, 8, 10, 12, 14, 26, 27, and 28. Now turn to the Examples portion of this and consider the additional problems and questions presented. After you have completed this task, you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Forces and Newton's Laws. This study procedure is outlined below. ------------------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ------------------------------Definitions 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 1-6 4.4,4.5,4.7 Newton's Laws 4.2, 4.3 7-11 2, 9, 10 8 Resolution of Forces 4.2, 4.4 12, 13 2, 10, 11 1, 2, 5, 10, 12, 26 Newton's Second Law Problems 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 14-17 1,5,6,7 8,28 4.6 Centripetal Force Problems 4.6 8 14,27 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Mechanics; Dynamics; Force; Weight; Friction; Centripetal Force; Kinds Of Force FORCE A measure of the strength of an interaction; a push or pull; the effect of a force is to alter the state of motion of a body. A vector quantity with a magnitude measured in newtons (N). The strength of the earth's gravitational field is measured by the weight of an object. Weight is a force acting vertically downward. WEIGHT The product of the mass and the acceleration due to gravity. Another way to think of g is to treat it as the strength of the force of gravity near the surface of the earth. Then the weight is a downward, vertical force. FRICTIONAL FORCE Force that opposes the motion of an object. In all of the cases of motion you commonly encounter there is a force acting to oppose the motion. When you are coasting down a slope on your bicycle, what are the forces that tend to slow you down? All of them can be classified as frictional forces. COEFFICIENT OF FRICTION Ratio of the maximum frictional force to the net force pressing the surface together. Try rubbing two sheets of paper together, then try rubbing two sheets of sandpaper together. Which requires the greater force to slide them along? This illustrates the larger coefficient of friction of sandpaper. If you wet the sandpaper, what happens to the force required to slide the paper along? CENTRIPETAL FORCE The unbalanced force acting on the body towards the center of rotation in circular motion. The radial acceleration of an object going around in a circle is proportional to centripetal force. WEIGHTLESSNESS The gravitational attraction of the earth for an object in motion around the earth is precisely equal to the centrifugal force of the body in its orbit. When you are in such an orbiting spacecraft floating objects and persons are the rule rather than the exception. Ask your physics instructor to show you some of the interesting films made from NASA photographs. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Answers; ; Mechanics; Dynamics; Newton's Laws; Newton's First Law; Newton's Second Law; Newton's Third Law; Force; Inertia; Acceleration; Mass SECTION 4.4 Force of Friction Suppose you think of oil as composed of many smooth planes loosely packed together. Then the oil could slide easily along the planes and would greatly reduce friction in those directions. This is not a very good model for oil. Can you think of a better one? At least this smooth planes model for oil offers an explanation for the reduction of friction in certain directions. Many frictional forces are essential. They enable us to place ourselves in a fixed position and remain there even when subjected to small external forces. If your chair were resting on a frictionless floor, the slightest breeze would blow you away from the table where you are studying physics. That would be too bad, wouldn't it? Indeed, it would be difficult to live as you presently do in a frictionless world. If we got started moving, how would we stop? GENERAL COMMENTS Keywords: Newton's First Law; Newton's Second Law; Newton's Third Law; Inertia; Acceleration; Mass; Exposition (valuable insights included in the , free of charge) NEWTON'S LAWS OF MOTION as given in Latin in his famous book PRINCIPIA. Lex. I - Corpus omneperseverare in statu suo quiesendi vel movendi uniformiter in directum, nisi quatenus illuda viriblus impressis cogitur. Lex. II - Mutationem motus, proportionalem esse vi motrici impressae, et fieri secujdum lina lineam rectam qua vis illa imprimitur. Lex. III - Actioni contrarium semper et aequalem esse reactionem; sive corporum duorum actiones in se mutuo semper esse aequales et in partes contrarias dirigi. COMMENTS ON NEWTON'S FIRST LAW The inertia of a body may be defined as that property of a body that tends to resist a change in its state of rest or motion. Mass is defined as a quantitative measure of inertia. COMMENTS ON NEWTON'S SECOND LAW Another way of stating the classical version of Newton's second law is: when a body is acted upon by a constant force, its resulting acceleration is proportional to the force and inversely proportional to its mass; a = F/m COMMENTS ON NEWTON'S THIRD LAW It is important to note that the action force and the reaction force in Newton's third law of motion act on different bodies. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Mechanics; Dynamics; Vectors; Arithmetic; Trigonometry; Newton's Laws; Newton's First Law; Newton's Second Law; Newton's Third Law; Centripetal Force; Free Body Diagrams RESOLUTION OF FORCES 1. A beanbag chair is at rest on a driveway inclined at 22ø. The chair has a weight of 68.0 newtons. (a) Draw the diagram of the chair and label all of the forces acting on the chair. (b) Calculate the values for all forces, etc., for this situation. What Data Are Given? The weight of the chair (68.0 N) and the angle of incline of the plane (22ø) are given. The velocity of the chair is zero throughout. What Data Are Implied? The weight is a force acting vertically down in a region where the strength of the earth's gravitational force produces an acceleration of 9.80 m/s2. The chair is not moving because of the presence of friction, so a frictional force is implied in this problem. Likewise, the plane is supporting the chair so a normal force is acting on the chair because the plane is implicit in this problem. What Physics Principles Are Involved? Both the second and third laws of Newton are necessary to understand this problem as well as knowledge of the vector nature of force. Before we go on to the algebraic solution of this problem we are ready to use a force diagram to answer part (a) and get us ready to solve part (b). (a) Force Diagram See Fig. A free body diagram can be drawn by omitting all real objects and only showing the forces, See Fig. What Equations Are to be Used? We can make use of Newton's Second Law. We know the velocity remains constant (at zero) so the acceleration is zero; thus, the net force on the chair must be zero. That means the vector sum of the forces on the chair must be zero; W+N+f=0 Algebraic Solution The vector equation can be written as two separate scalar equations, a vertical component equation and a horizontal component equation. Vertical forces = 0 = W = N cos q - f sin q where positive is downward. (1) Horizontal forces = 0 = N sin q - f cos q where positive is to the right. (2) These equations can be combined to solve for the magnitudes of the two unknown forces f and N. Rearrange Equation (2) and divide by cos q: f = N sin q / cos q) = N tan q (3) Rearrange equation (1), divide by cos q and substitute the friction for f, N = (W/cos q) - (f sin q/cos q) = (W/cos q) - N tan2 q (4) Now combine the terms containing the normal force N, so N (1 + tan2 q) = W/cos q or N = W / [cos q (1 + tan2 q)] (5) Substitute this expression into Equation (3) to obtain f = W tan q / [cos q (1 + tan2q] (6) Numerical Solution W = 68.0 N; q = 22ø, so cos q = 0.927; tan q = 0.404. N = 68.0 N / [0.927(1 + (.404)2)] = 63.1 N perpendicular to the driveway. f = N tan q = (63.1 N) (.404) = 25.5 N, parallel and up the driveway. Thinking About the Answer Notice that both answers come out in the correct units, newtons. The normal force is much larger than the friction force. This seems reasonable for a low angle driveway. Notice as the angle decreases in Equations 5 and 6 the normal force approaches a value of W and the friction force goes to zero. Is that what you expect? NEWTON'S SECOND LAW PROBLEMS 2. Assume the beanbag chair given in the previous problem is lying at rest on an icy (friction ÷ zero) driveway. What happens? Give quantitative results. What Data Are Given Same as in the previous problem except now the friction force f is equal to zero. What Data Are Implied? Same as in the previous problem, except the frictional force is zero. Motion along the driveway can be deduced. What Physics Principles Are Involved? As before, Newton's 2nd and 3rd laws. Now Newton's 2nd law shows that the beanbag chair will undergo some acceleration down the driveway since the net force cannot be zero. This is clearly seen by removing the frictional force from the previous force diagram. Then you are left with See Fig. It is not possible for the weight and the normal force to add to zero. Hence, the chair must experience some net force and some acceleration. What Equations Are to be Used? The vector equation for the 2nd law in this case is given by ma = W + N (7) However, we know the chair can only move along the driveway since there is no force acting to lift the chair. Hence we can transform Equation (7) into a scalar equation by considering only motion and forces that act parallel to the driveway. The normal force has no components parallel to the driveway. The weight has only one component, W sin q, acting down the driveway, so we can write ma = W sin q {motion down the driveway} (8) Algebraic Solution Remember, only the weight W, g, and q are given, so we need to replace the mass on the left side of Equation (8) by W/g, thus (W/g)a = W sin q or a = g sin q (9) Numerical Solution g = 9.80 m/s2, sin 22ø = 0.375 a = (9.80)(0.375) = 3.68 m/s2, down the driveway. Thinking About the Answer Note the units are correct, and that if the slope of the driveway is decreased to zero degrees the acceleration goes to zero; i.e., the chair remains at rest, does that seem reasonable to you? CENTRIPETAL FORCE PROBLEMS 3. An 80.0 kg earth satellite circles the earth once every 94.2 minutes at a mean altitude of 522 km. Use 6.38 x 106 m as the radius of the earth. (a) What is the gravitational force acting on the satellite while in orbit? (b) What fraction of its force at the surface of the earth is it? (c) If you were riding inside the satellite what forces would you experience? What Data Are Given? The mass of the satellite is 80.0 kg. Data which can be used to calculate its velocity and the radius of its circular path are given. What Data Are Implied? The problem intends for you to assume the path is a circle with the center of the earth as the center of the path, hence the radius of the path is 6.38 x 106 m + 522 km = 6.38 x 106 + 0.52 x 106 = 6.90 x 106 m. What Physics Principles Are Involved? You need to recognize that the gravitational force must have the same magnitude as the centripetal force. Furthermore, for an observer inside the satellite the gravitational force will appear to be canceled by the centrifugal force and the condition of weightlessness will be experienced. What Equations Are to be Used? The equation for centripetal force is needed. F = mv2/r (4.6) In order to calculate the velocity v we need to divide the circumference of the orbit by the time required for one pass around it. v = 2p(radius)/time for one orbit (10) Algebraic Solutions (a) In orbit Fo = mv2/r but v = 2pr/t Fo = m4p2r2) / rt2 = 4p2mr / t2 (11) (b) On the surface Fe = mg Ratio of orbit force to surface force is given by F0/Fe = 4p2r / gt2 (12) Numerical Solution r = 6.90 x 106 m t = 94.2 minutes = 5.65 x 103 seconds m = 80.0 kg; g = 9.80 m/s2 (a) Putting these values in Equation (11) Fo = (80.0 kg)4p2(6.90 x106) / (5.65 x 103)2 = Fo = 6.82 x 102 kg/s2 Fo = 6.82 x 102 N (b) Then Fo/mg = 0.87 which is 87%. In summary, the force on the satellite in orbit is 682 N. Since its weight on earth is 784 N, the orbital force is 87% of its weight on the earth. As an observer inside the satellite you would observe the effects of the gravitational force being balanced by a centrifugal force and you would experience weightlessness. Thinking About the Answers Notice again that the units come out correctly, 1 newton is a kilogram meter per second squared. According to Equation (12) the ratio of the orbit force to the surface of the earth force is independent of the mass of the object since the symbol (m) does not appear in Equation (12). Does that seem reasonable to you? PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Problems; Answers; Questions; Evaluations; Gravity; Law Of Universal Gravitation; Mechanics; Dynamics; Weight; Free Body Diagrams; Anatomy And Physiology; Applications; Newton's Laws; Newton's First Law; Newton's Second Law; Newton's Third Law; Centripetal Force; Circular Motion 1. Newton's Universal Law of Gravitation applies to all massive objects, including planets, automobiles, and people. However, many people misrepresent the gravitational law. Use your knowledge of Newton's Law and write a short correction for the following statements. a. Because of its larger mass, the sun attracts the earth with a greater force than the earth attracts the sun. b. The earth's rotation produces our gravitation. If the rotation were to stop, we would drift into space. c. A body taken to an altitude of about 100 miles has no weight because the gravitational force does not extend out into space beyond the atmosphere. 2. The Fig. shown below shows a modified Russell traction apparatus for femoral fixation. See Fig. a. Construct a force diagram isolating point B showing all the forces which are at that point. b. Find the total horizontal force applied to the leg at B by the apparatus when a 4 kilogram mass is suspended at A. 3. A 500 kilogram subcompact car is parked on top of a long straight incline whose inclination is 30ø from the horizontal. a. Draw a free body diagram isolating the car and showing all the forces holding the car in equilibrium. b. Assume that the brakes are released and the car rolls (without friction) down the plane. Using Newton's second law, predict the car's acceleration. 4. Astronaut Owen Garriott (mass = 65 kilograms) is placed aboard a spinning device used to determine his ability to withstand high "g" forces. See Fig. a. If the apparatus is revolving at 1 revolution per second, what force does Garriott experience due to this rotation motion? b. How many times his weight is this force? (how many "g" 's does he experience?) ANSWERS: 1. a) Newton's Universal Law states that these forces must be exactly equal in magnitude, opposite in direction. b) Rotation of the earth has little effect on our weight. Actually, if rotation were to cease, our apparent weight (as measured by a spring balance on the surface of the earth) would increase slightly. c) The gravitational force extends indefinitely into space. In a space ship which is circling the earth, we say an astronaut is weightless because in the condition of "falling" around the earth, he exerts no force on a spring balance in his ship. Actually, his actual weight (attraction to the earth) is 95% of the force at the earth's surface. 2. 69.6 N 3. 5 m/s2 4. 25,600 N, 39 g's Chapter 5 Energy GOALS Keywords: Learning Objectives; ; Mechanics; Energy; Simple Machines; Levers; Work; Kinetic Energy; Potential Energy; Power; Efficiency; Conservation Of Energy When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions work lever systems energy theoretical mechanical advantage potential energy actual mechanical advantage kinetic energy efficiency power Conservative and Nonconservative Systems Establish the difference between a conservative and a nonconservative system. Conservation of Energy Explain the principle of conservation of energy. Energy Problems Apply the principle of conservation of energy to solve mechanics problems. Lever Systems Determine the theoretical mechanical advantage of human body lever systems. Efficiency Calculate the efficiency of a machine or human in action. Power Determine the power required for a given process or activity. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 3, Kinematics, and Chapter 4, Forces and Newton's Laws. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Mechanics; Energy; Simple Machines Newton's three Laws of Motion provide a useful model for viewing the motion of objects we encounter in our daily experience. However, the model becomes difficult to apply in situations where the forces involved vary significant with time and displacement. To provide a parallel assessment procedure, the concept of work and energy was introduced. This alternate model for viewing our environment allows for a simple solution to many problems. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE To begin your study of this chapter, become familiar with the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Conservation of Energy, Energy Problems, Lever Systems, Efficiency and Power. A discussion of each of the terms listed under Definitions can be found in the first section of this chapter. Next, read text sections 5.1-5.13 and study the examples provided at the end of each section. Please remember that the answer to questions asked in the text are given in this chapter, section two. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-7 and 11-15. Check your answers against those provided. Now, complete Algorithmic Problems 1-6 and check each answer. Then do Exercises and Problems 1, 2, 3, 5, 7, 12, 15, 18, 19, and 22. For additional work on the goals of this chapter, see the third section of this chapter. Finally, attempt the Practice Test. If you have difficulty with any of the concepts, refer to the appropriate chapter section for additional work. This study procedure is outlined below. -----------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -----------------Definition 5.1, 5.2, 5.3 1-7 1,2 Conservation of 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 11-14 15 Energy 5.7, 5.8, 5.11 Energy Problems 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 1, 3, 6 3, 5, 12, 5.8, 5.9, 5.13 18, 19 Lever Systems 5.12 5, 6, 13 4 7 Efficiency 5.10 7, 14 22 Power 5.9 15 2, 5 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Potential Energy; Kinetic Energy; Mechanics; Energy; Power; Simple Machines; Levers; Efficiency WORK Applied force produces a displacement; magnitude of work done is given by product of force component parallel to the displacement and the magnitude of the displacement. Note that work as used in physics requires a force component acting in the direction of motion as well as motion. So, for example, the force that a string exerts on a whirling object connected to it is always perpendicular to the direction of motion so the work done by the force is zero. ENERGY Property of a system which causes changes in its own state or state of its surroundings; measure of ability to do work (physical). Energy is an intrinsic property of a system. We always compute energy from other measured properties of a system. Energy is a scalar quantity. There are many forms of energy; mechanical, electrical, chemical, thermal, etc. There are two kinds of mechanical energy; potential and kinetic. POTENTIAL ENERGY Ability to do work as a result of position or configuration. A most common form of potential energy is the energy which results from changing the height of objects above the earth. Have you ever wondered why it is more tiring to climb up stairs than to come down them? The changes in potential energy that occur may be an answer. KINETIC ENERGY Energy of motion of a body. The idea that the kinetic energy of a moving object is proportional to the square of the speed is well-illustrated by data about automobiles. The distance required to stop a moving automobile increases with the square of the speed, as does the fatality rate in accidents. POWER Time rate of doing work or using energy. The increased power of large automobile engines is most manifest in the ability of an automobile to have its speed rapidly increased. LEVER A simple machine. Essentially a rigid body with a fixed pivot. A lever is only one kind of simple machine. Others, such as the wheel and axle, the inclined plane, and the screw, are only briefly mentioned in the textbook. THEORETICAL MECHANICAL ADVANTAGE Ratio of distance through which the applied force acts to the distance through which the load moves. ACTUAL MECHANICAL ADVANTAGE Ratio of the load to the applied force. EFFICIENCY Ratio of work accomplished to work supplied. The efficiency of a simple machine is also equal to the ratio of the actual mechanical advantage to the theoretical mechanical advantage. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Work; Energy; Mechanics; Gravitational Potential Energy; Conservative Forces; Nonconservative Forces; Potential Energy; Dynamics SECTION 5.2 Work Any force you apply to an object which has a component which is not in the direction of motion is not doing work. When you lift an object you do work, but as you carry the object to a new location, the vertical force you exert to hold up the box does not do any work as long as the motion is in a horizontal direction. SECTION 5.3 Energy The chemical energy stored in a battery is converted to electrical energy to operate a portable radio and then the electrical energy is converted to the sound energy which you hear coming from the radio. SECTION5.5 Potential Energy Whenever you lift or lower an object near the surface of the earth you change its gravitational potential energy. The potential energy of water that can flow down from high elevations is converted into electrical energy through the use of hydroelectric stations. SECTION 5.7 Conservative and Nonconservative Forces 1. Each time the boy slides up a hill he will rise a smaller amount. Each trip he loses some of his energy to frictional, non-conservative forces working on his sled. Finally he will come to rest in the valley between the hills. 2. The total energy of a non-conservative system will always decrease as the nonconservative forces dissipate the energy of the system. 3. All real systems are non-conservative. It is only in our imaginations that we have a system which never suffers a loss of energy to dissipative forces. 4. The final equilibrium state of a system will be its state of lowest energy. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Mechanics; Energy; Work; Potential Energy; Kinetic Energy; Work-Energy Theorem; Trigonometry; Friction; Conservation Of Energy; Simple Machines; Levers; Efficiency; Free Body Diagrams; Dynamics; Anatomy And Physiology; Arithmetic; Pulleys; Screws; Inclined Planes; Respiratory System; Applications; Time; Power ENERGY PROBLEMS 1. A professional skier of 60 kg mass is on a ski jump ramp like the one shown See Fig. 5-1. (not recommended for beginners!). At point C the ramp is pointed up at an angle of 45ø. Point A is 40 meters above the lowest point of the ramp and point C is 10 meters above the lowest point. The distance along the ramp from point A to point C is 81 meters. Assume the potential energy of the skier at point B is zero. (a) What is the potential energy of the skier at point A? (b) Assuming no friction, what is his speed when he gets to point B if he starts from rest at A? (c) Suppose for artificial snow the force of friction is a constant equal to 5 newtons. How much energy does the skier lose in going from A to C? (d) What is the maximum height to which the skier can rise above B if he starts from rest at A on artificial snow, and jumps off the ramp at point C? What Data Are Given The mass of the skier = 60 kg; distance travelled on the ramp = 81 m; starting elevation = 40 m; friction force = 0 for part (b) and 5 N for parts (c) and (d). The angle of incline of the ramp is 45ø. What Data Are Implied? It is assumed that the skier does no work on himself through the use of his muscles. In addition, the only dissipative force considered is that artificial snow frictional force. The gravitational acceleration constant is assumed to be 9.80 m/s2. What Physics Principles Are Involved? This problem involves the use of the work-energy theorem, the conservation of energy, and the expressions for gravitational potential energy, and kinetic energy. What Equations Are to be Used? Kinetic energy = KE = 1/2 mv2 (5.2) Potential energy = PE = mgh (5.4) Work done = F ¥ d (5.1) Work-energy theorem; net work on a system = change in energy W = DKE + DPE (5.9) Projectile motion concepts from Chapter 4. Algebraic Solutions Let m = mass of skier; h = starting height of point A. (a) Potential energy at A = mghA (b) Speed at B; conservation of energy gives PEB + KEB = PEA + KEA (5.11) since friction is neglected for this part of the problem. Both the kinetic energy at A and the potential energy at B are zero. Can you explain why? KEB = PEA 1/2 mvB2 = mgh The Speed at B = vB = SQR RT[2gh] (1) (c) Energy loss = work done by friction = friction force times the distance (d) Maximum height is found by applying the conservation of energy concepts to his motion through the air. At point C he has a kinetic energy, KEc = mghA - mghC - work done by friction where hA and hC are the heights of points A and C respectively. His speed at C is given by SQR RT[2KEC]/m, so his horizontal velocity, vhorz = SQR RT[2KEC)/m] cos q (2) where q is the angle of the ramp. At the peak of the jump path his vertical component of velocity will equal zero so his total energy will be equal to his potential energy plus his kinetic energy because of his constant velocity in the horizontal direction. This total energy must be equal to the energy he head when he left the ramp at point C. Energy at peak of jump = kinetic energy at point C = KEC mghpeak + 1/2 mv2 horizontal = KEC = mghA - mghC - friction work (3) Since everything in this equation is known expect the peak height, hpeak it can be found by combining Equations (2) and (3) hpeak = (KEC / mg) - (v2horz / 2g) = (KEC / mg) - (2KECcos2 q / 2mg) hpeak = (KEC / mg)(1 - cos2 q) (4) Numerical Solutions (a) Potential energy at A = (60 kg)(9.8 m/s2)(40 m) = 2.4 x 104 m2kg/s2 PEA = 2.4 x 104 joules (b) vB = SQR RT[2(9.8)(40) m2/s2] = 1.2 x 102 m/s (c) Energy loss = (5 N)(81 m) = 405 joules (d) Kinetic energy at C = (60)(9.8)(40 - 10) J - 405 joules KEC = 1.72 x 104 J hpeak = [1.72 x 104 / (60)(9.8)] (1 - cos2 45ø) hpeak = 1.46 x 101 m ÷ 15 meters above point C Thinking About the Answers You should check to see that all of the units came out correctly. You can see in this problem that the friction force made little difference in the energy at point C and the height of the skier peak. In equation (4) we can see that if the angle q is zero, the height of the peak is zero and if the angle q is 90ø the peak height will be a maximum. In this particular case, since the angle is 45ø the launch velocity is equally divided between its horizontal and vertical components and the kinetic energy at the peak is one-half the total kinetic energy at point C. Did you notice that the zero point for potential energy was shifted to point C for answering part (d)? Can you rework the problem without making that shift? LEVER SYSTEMS Keywords: Simple Machines; Screws; Pulleys; Worked Examples 2. Lever systems are only one of several kinds of simple machines. Shown below, in addition to the lever, are the crank and axle, inclined plane, pulley system, and screw jack. Using the symbols shown on each machine, calculate the actual mechanical advantage, the theoretical mechanical advantage, and the efficiency of each machine. See Fig. What Data Are Given? In each case a load of W newtons is moved by the application of a force of F newtons. The distances for both the load W and the applied force F are given. What Data Are Implied? Any explicit calculation of frictional forces is not done. Instead all of the frictional forces are included in the value of W that can be moved by the force F. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The definitions of theoretical mechanical advantage, actual mechanical advantages, and efficiency are needed. What Equations Are to be Used? Theoretical mechanical advantage (TMA) = distance applied force moves/distance move load (5.15) Actual mechanical advantage (AMA) = load W/force F (5.16) Efficiency (e) = work done by the machine/energy supplied to the machine (5.14) Algebraic Solutions (i) AMA = W/F; TMA = 2pl/2pr = l/r; e =Wr/Fl (ii) AMA = W/F; TMA = d/h; e = W ¥ h/F ¥ d (iii) AMA = W/F; TMA = l/d; e = Wd/Fl; same for all three types of lever (iv) AMA = W/F; TMA = l/d; e = Wd/Fl Note for the case shown for every 1 m the force moves, the W goes up only 1/4 m; so TMA = 4. This is determined by the geometry of the pulley system. The system shown has 4 ropes supporting the bottom pulleys so the TMA is 4. Can you use the geometry of a pulley system to derive this algorithm for computing the TMA of a pulley system? (v) AMA = W/F; TMA = 2pl/p; e = Wp/2pFl EFFICIENCY Keywords: Efficiency; Work; Respiratory System; Worked Examples 3. A mile runner felt that he needed to eat 1.3 ounces (37 gm) of a candy bar every time he ran a mile in 4 1/2 minutes. Estimate his energy efficiency. Use Table 5.1 and Table 5.2 for the constants you need. What Data Are Given? The time of running and the amount of candy eaten, 4.5 minutes and 37 gm respectively. What Data Are Implied? To calculate efficiency of energy use you need to calculate the energy input and the energy used in a useful way. You can use Table 5.1 and your knowledge that sugar is a carbohydrate to convert 37 gm of sugar to its approximate energy value since its energy conversion value is 4 kcal/gam. Likewise, you can use Table 5.2 to estimate the rate at which the runner uses energy, 11.4 kcal/minute. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The definition of energy efficiency must be used in conjunction with some concepts implied by the data in Table 5.1 and Table 5.2 . You can take the product of the amount of food eaten in grams times the energy conversion factor ( Table 5.1) to compute the total energy input. You can take the product of the running times the energy use rate ( Table 5.2 ) to calculate the use of energy. What Equations Are to be Used? Efficiency = Useful work done/energy input Energy Input = (mass of food) (energy conversion factor) Energy Consumption = useful work = (time of activity) (energy use rate) Algebraic Solution E = U.W.D. / E.I. = (time)(kcal/min) / (mass)(kcal/gm) Numerical Solution E = (4.5 min)(11.4 kcal/min) / (37 gm)(4 kcal/gm) = 51.3 kcal/148 kcal = 35% Thinking About the Answer This runner seems to be 35% efficient. That means that 65% of the energy input is not used in running. Where does it go? POWER Keywords: Power; Work; Time; Respiratory System; Human Anatomy And Physiology; Biology; Worked Examples 4. What are the power ratings in watts of a person engaged in various activities? You may use the values in Table 5.2 for this problem. What Data Are Given? One person engaged in various human activities. What Data Are Implied? The energy use rate for human sitting, resting, etc., are given in Table 5.2 The watt is an energy use rate of 1 joule per second. What Physics Principles Are Involved? You need to use the definition of power as given in Equation 5.12. Power = Work Done/Time to Do it (5.12) What Equations Are to be Used? Power = Work/Time = Energy Used/Time (5.12) The data in Table 5.2 are already given in units of energy (kcal) per unit time (minutes) and only need to be converted to joules and seconds respectively. Algebraic Solution Power (Watts) = Energy Used (joules) / Time (seconds) joules = (4187 J/kcal)(no. of kcal) seconds = 60 sec./min. (time in minutes) Power (watts) = (4187/60) (kcal/min.) = 69.8 (kcal/min.) Numerical Solutions - Data from Table 5.2 Power (watts) sitting = 69.8 (2.0 kcal/min.) = 140 W Power (watts) resting = 69.8 (1.2 kcal/min.) = 84 W Power (watts) sleeping = 69.8 (1.1 kcal/min.) = 77 W Power (watts) walking = 69.8 (3.8 kcal/min.) = 270 W Power (watts) bicycling = 69.8 (6.9 kcal/min.) = 470 W Power (watts) swimming = 69.8 (8.0 kcal/min.) = 560 W Power (watts) skiing = 69.8 (9.0 kcal/min.) = 630 W Power (watts) running = 69.8 (11.4 kcal/min.) = 796 W Power (watts) climbing up stairs = 69.8 (12.0 kcal/min.) = 838 W Keywords: Power; Mechanics; ; Energy; Humor See Fig. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Problems; Answers; Mechanics; Potential Energy; Kinetic Energy; Friction; Simple Machines; Pulleys; Efficiency; Levers; Anatomy And Physiology; Power; Muscular Systems 1. A professional skier of 100 kg mass is on a ski ramp See Fig. (not recommended for beginners). At point C the ramp is pointed straight up. Point A is 40 meters above the ground. Point C is 10 meters above the ground. The distance from point A to point C along the ramp is 150 meters. The potential energy at B is zero. ________a. What is the potential energy of the skier at point A? ________b. If the friction force along the path is a constant 50 N, what is the work done by friction in going from point A to point C? ________c. What is the kinetic energy of the skier at point C? ________d. What is the maximum height h, above the end of the ramp (point C) to which the skier can rise in his trajectory? 2. A force of 6 N is required to raise a weight of 30 N by means of a pulley system. If the weight is raised 1 meter in one second while the applied force moves through a distance of 8 m _______a. What is the actual mechanical advantage of the pulley system? _______b. What is the theoretical mechanical advantage of the pulley system? _______c. What is the efficiency of this system? _______d. What is the power dissipated in the system? 3. The human arm See Fig. is being tested for mechanical advantage. In this test, the biceps arm action is utilized with a weight of 10 Newtons. In the configuration shown, the force of the muscle is found to be 85 Newtons. _______a. Find the TMA of the arm. _______b. Find the AMA of the arm. _______c. Calculate the arm's efficiency. ANSWERS: 1. 40,000 J, 7500 J, 22,500 J, 22.5 meters above C. 2. 5, 8, 62.5%, 18 watts 3. .125, .12, .94 Chapter 6 Momentum and Impulse GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: impulse elastic collision impulsive force inelastic collision momentum rocket propulsion Impulse Problems Use the relationship between impulse and change in momentum to solve problems. Conservation of Momentum Explain the principle of conservation of momentum. Collision Problems State the difference in conditions between an elastic impact and an inelastic impact, and use both kinds of conditions to solve problems. Momentum and Energy Problems Apply the principles of conservation of momentum and conservation of energy to solve problems. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 3, Kinematics, Chapter 4, Forces and Newton's Laws, and Chapter 5, Energy. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Mechanics; Momentum; Impulse; Collisions After studying and using the conservation of energy principle in solving mechanical problems, you can appreciate the advantages of finding conservation principles. Like the conservation of energy, the quantity called momentum is also conserved in active systems. The application of the conservation of momentum principle is helpful in considering a host of mechanical problems; e.g., impact and collisions between large and/or small physical objects. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE When you begin to study this chapter, carefully read the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Impulse Problems, Conservation of Momentum, Collision Problems, and Momentum and Energy Problems. A more complete discussion of each of the Definitions terms is found in the next section of the . Next, read text sections 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, and 6.6. As you read, take careful note of the fact that momentum is a Vector quantity. This is illustrated by the vector nature of equation (6.2) and in example 4. Also, notice that in considering simple collisions between two objects, that although the momentum is always conserved, energymay not be conserved. This fact is illustrated in section 6.4 and by the example at the end of the section. Also remember that the answers to questions asked in the text reading are answered in section 3 of this Study Guide. Next, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-14. Then complete Algorithmic Problems 1-6. Then complete Problems and Exercises 1, 2, 4, 6, 9, and 10. For additional practice, more example problems follow in this Study Guide chapter. Finally, attempt the Practice Test included in the . If you have difficulties, please refer to the particular section of the text for additional practice. This study procedure is outlined below. ----------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ----------------Definitions 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 1-5 6.4, 6.6 Impulse Problems 6.2 6, 7 1, 2, 4 1, 2 Conservation 6.3 8, 9 3, 5 of Momentum Collision 6.4 10, 11 3,5 4,6 Problems Momentum and 6.4 12-14 6 9,10 Energy Problems DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Mechanics; Momentum; Collisions; Inelastic; Collisions; Elastic Collisions; Rockets; Propulsion; Impulse IMPULSE Product of the net force and the time interval over which it acts is called the impulse of the force. Note that the impulse of a force is a vector quantity that can be calculated from two measured variables, the force and the time. IMPULSIVE FORCE is usually thought of as a force which lasts a short time but reaches a large value (N). MOMENTUM Product of the mass of a body and its velocity, a vector property whose direction is the same as the direction of the velocity. Note that momentum, like energy and impulse, is a derived quantity that can be calculated from the measured quantities of mass and velocity. ELASTIC COLLISION Both momentum and kinetic energy of bodies involved in a collision are the same before and after impact. In most collisions we see in everyday life there is some loss of energy, but if the energy loss is small, then we see a good approximation of an elastic collision. Perhaps the best example is a collision between two steel ball bearings. INELASTIC COLLISION Bodies stick together during impact; momentum is conserved, but kinetic energy is not conserved. Most collisions we see such as between participants in sporting events, or between automobiles, fall into this category. Part of the energy is used to change the shape of the participant or the automobile. ROCKET PROPULSION Practical example of conservation of momentum. A small amount of fuel is ejected at very high velocity, so the large rocket moves forward in a manner that the total momentum of the system of rocket and fuel remains constant. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Answers; ; Mechanics; Dynamics; Momentum; Impulse SECTION 6.1 Introduction The word momentum is found in many different contexts in daily living. Please listen for the use of this word outside of physics and compare its meanings and connotations with those you learn in physics. SECTION 6.2 Momentum and Impulse Most examples of the forces we exert on objects in our surroundings are impulsive forces: we push open a door, we slide a box, we pedal a bicycle with a series of impulsive forces. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Mechanics; Dynamics; Momentum; Conservation Of Momentum; Impulse; Force; Vectors; Trigonometry; Collisions; Elastic Collisions; Friction; Kinetic Energy; Worked Examples; Arithmetic IMPULSE PROBLEMS 1. A 2000 kg automobile was moving with a constant velocity to the East at 12 m/s. It was struck by a tornado and 7.0 seconds later was headed northeast at 40 m/s.(a) What was the impulse that acted on the automobile? (b) What was the net force exerted by the tornado? What Data Are Given? Mass of automobile = 2000 kg Initial velocity = 12 m/s east Final velocity = 40 m/s northeast Time elapsed = 7.0 seconds What Data Are Implied? In order to calculate the net force you can assume the force exerted by the tornado was a constant lasting for 7 seconds. What Physics Principles Are Involved? You must use two concepts, the definition of impulse and the relationship between impulse and change in momentum. What Equations Are to be Used? Impulse = (Force) (time) (1) Impulse = change in momentum = Dp (6.2) Algebraic Solutions See Fig. Let x be the east direction, then y stands for north Initial momentum = pi = mvi in the x direction Final momentum = Pf = mvi in the northeast direction Change in momentum = mvf - mvi This is a vector equation. Now let us convert this to equations for the x and y components of the momenta using q as the angle between the final and initial momenta. change in x component of momentum = DPx = mvf cos q - mvi change in y component of momentum = DPy = mvf sin q - 0 We can now use Equation 6.2 to find the impulse. x - component of the impulse = DPx = mvf cos q - mvi (2) y - component of the impulse = DPy = mvf sin q (3) The angle f the impulse makes with the x - direction (east) is given by tan = Py/Px = mvf sinq / (mvf cos q - mvi) (4) The force exerted by the tornado = impulse/time Numerical Solutions x - component of impulse = (1.0 x 103 kg)(40 m/s)sin 45ø = 5.7 x 104 kgm/s y - component of impulse = (2.0 x 103 kg)(40 m/s)cos 45ø - (2.0 x 103)(12 m/s) = 3.3 x 104 kgm/s f = arctan 3.3 x 104/5.7 x 104 = 30ø north of east Magnitude of the total impulse = SQR RT[(5.7 x 104)2 + (3.3 x 104)2] = 6.6 x 104 kgm/s Net force = impulse/time = 6.6 x 104/7.0 = 9.4 x 103 N at 30ø north of east Thinking About the Answers You may notice that the algebraic form of the answers is simplified because the xdirection was chosen to be in the direction of the initial momentum, so the y component of momentum was initially zero. This is a good strategy to follow in solving problems that involve vectors. If you are free to choose an arbitrary coordinate system choose one that makes the algebraic manipulations in the problem easier. Note also that the impulse is not in the direction of the final momentum. Rather the impulse is in the direction of the CHANGE IN MOMENTUM. Beware of the vector properties of both impulse and momentum! Many physics students have missed exam equations because they have added or subtracted momenta as if they were scalars. COLLISION PROBLEMS 2. A 104 kg tight end has caught a short pass from the quarterback and heads for the end zone at a speed of 8.9 m/s at an angle of 75ø with the yard lines. A small defensive back (77 kg) running parallel to the yard line at a speed of 9.6 m/s dives through the air, collides with the tight end, and holds on to him for dear life. What is the final momentum of the two entangled football players? What Data Are Given? Let us take the tight end to be subscript 1; ml = 104 kg initial vl = 8.9 m/s 275ø defensive back, subscript 2; m2 = 77 kg; v2 = 9.6 m/s 20ø What Data Are Implied? The problem does not give the exact direction of the motion of the two players with respect to each other. Let us assume the tight end is trying to avoid the defensive player so they are both running toward the same sideline. Then a top view of the problem may be drawn as follows: See Fig. What Physics Principles Are Involved? We can solve this problem using the conservation of momentum. What Equations Are to be Used? We can use the equation that applies to the special case of when the two colliding objects stick together. m1v1 + m2v2 = (m1 + m2)vf (6.15) Algebraic Solutions In component form, picking the v2 direction as the x - direction; and q as the angle between v1 and v2, m1v1 cos q + m2v2 = (m1 + m2) vfx = Pfx (5) m1v1 sin q = (m1 + m2)vfy (6) The magnitude and direction of the final momentum are given by Pf = SQR RT[P2fx + P2fy] = SQR RT[(m1v1 cos q + m2v2)2 + (m1v1 sin q)2] Numerical Solution Pfx = (104 kg)(8.9 m/s) cos 75ø + (77 kg)(9.6 m/s) = 9.8 x 102 kgm/s Pfy = (104 kg)(8.9 m/s) sin 75ø = 8.9 x 102 kgm/s Pf = 1.3 x 103 kgm/sec; f = 42ø Thinking About the Answer The final magnitude is greater than the initial momentum of either player. The final direction is more towards the sidelines than the original direction of the tight end but more towards the end zone than the original direction of the defensive back. All of these features of the answer fit our observations of such collisions on a football field. MOMENTUM AND ENERGY PROBLEMS 3. In the preceding problem, what fraction of the initial energy was lost in the collision? What happened to that energy? What Data Are Given? The initial masses and velocities and the final mass. What Data Are Implied? The fact that the two players stick together after the collision makes it a completely inelastic collision. What Physics Principles Are Involved? We know the total momentum is conserved so the final kinetic energy can be calculated and then the fractional energy lost can be computed. fractional energy loss = initial energy - final energy/initial energy What Equations Are to be Used? We can combine the equations from the previous problem with an equation to calculate the loss in kinetic energy. 1/2 m1v12 + 1/2 m2v22 - 1/2 (m1 + m2)v2f = loss in KE (6.16) Algebraic Solution Fraction loss of kinetic energy = [1/2 m1v12 + 1/2 m2v2 - 1/2 (m1 + m2)vf2]/(1/2 m1v12 + 1/2 m2v22) m1v1 cos q + m2v2 = (m1 + m2)vfx (5) m1v1 sin q = (m1 + m2)vfy (6) Final kinetic energy = Pf2 / 2(m1 + m2) = [(m1v1 cos q + m2v2)2 + (m1v1 sinq)2] / 2(m1 + m2) (7) This equation (7) is derived from the relationships that the final momentum Pf is given by (m1 + m2)vf and the final kinetic energy is given by 1/2(m1 + m2)vf2, so 1/2 (m1 + m2)vf2 = KEf = Pf2 / 2(m1 + m2) = (m1 + m2)2 vf2 / 2(m1 + m2) Numerical Solution Initial kinetic energy of the tight end = 1/2(104 kg)(8.9 m/s)2 = 4.1 x 103 J. Initial kinetic energy of the defensive back = 1/2(77 kg)(9.6 m/s)2= 3.5 x 103 J Total initial kinetic energy = 7.6 x 103 J. Final kinetic energy = Pf2 / 2(m1 + m2) = (1.3 x 103 kg)2 / 2(104 + 77)kg = 4.7 x 103 J Fractional kinetic energy loss = (7.6 x 103 - 4.7 x 103) / 7.6 x 103 = 0.38 Thinking About the Answer So 38% of the initial kinetic energy is lost in this collision. This energy is used to change the shape of the players' bodies, uniforms and padding. It may even produce changes in the bodies of the players to cause bruises and muscular aches and pains. 4. What are the impulses that act on the two players in the collision discussed in problem 2? What Data Are Given? Same as 2 above. What Data Are Implied? Changes in momentum result from the impulse of the collision. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The change in momentum is equal to the impulse acting on the system. Newton's Third Law of Action - reaction pairs - can also be used to determine the impulse on the tight end after we have calculated the impulse on the defensive player, or vice versa. The principle of superposition can also be used. What Equations Are to be Used? Impulse = change in momentum (6.2) Final momentum of two players = sum of individual player's final momentum (superposition) Algebraic Solution Let us pick the defensive player and calculate his change in momentum because of the collision. His final momentum is a fraction m2/m1 + m2 of the total final momentum, P2f = m2Pf / (m1 + m2) (8) His initial momentum was P2i = m2v2 and was chosen to be the x-direction. Impulse = final momentum - initial momentum = P2f - P2i = [m2 / (m1 + m2)]Pf - m2v2 Numerical Solutions From the numerical answer to problem (2) above: P2f = [77kg (1.3 x 103) / (104 kg + 77 kg)] kgm/s 242ø P2f = 5.5 x 102 kgm/s 242ø = { 4.1 x 102 kgm/s in the x-direction = { 3.7 x 102 kgm/s in the y-direction P2i = (77 kg)(9.6 m/s) = 7.4 x 102 kgm/s in the x -direction change in momentum = { 4.1 x 102 - 7.4 x 102 kgm/s in the x -direction { 3.7 x 102 - 0 in the y-direction = { -3.3 x 102 kgm/s in the x-direction { 3.7 x 102 kgm/s in the y-direction So DP = SQR RT[(-3.3 x 102)2 + 3.7 x 102)2] = 5.0 x 102 kgm/s The angle of DP is arctan(3.7 x 102/-3.3 x 102) = 132ø The impulse on the defensive back is 5.0 x 102 kgm/s 2132ø The impulse on the tight end is 5.0 x 102 kgm/s 2 -48ø Relative Directions See Fig. Thinking About the Answer Keywords: Conservation Of Momentum; Humor Notice that this impulse is five times that needed for a fatality from a head injury as given in example 2 in section 6.2. See Fig. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Problems; Answers; Evaluations; Mechanics; Dynamics; Momentum; Collisions; Elastic Collisions; Inelastic Collisions; Force; Time Inelastic Collisions; Energy; Kinetic Energy; Conservation Of Momentum; Velocity 1. A small foreign car (mass = 500 kilograms) is traveling at 5.0 m/sec East when it makes a head-on collision with a brick wall. Following the initial impact, the car bounces straight back away from the wall with a velocity of 2.0 m/sec. See Fig. ________(a) Find the initial momentum of the foreign car. ________(b) Calculate the final momentum of the car. ________(c) If the impact with the wall lasted .02 seconds, what was the average force applied to the car during the impact? ________(d) Calculate the percentage of initial kinetic energy lost during the collision. 2. Consider the problem above for the case when the collision is perfectly elastic. ________(a) What would be the final velocity of the car? ________(b) Calculate the average force exerted on the car by the wall if the impact time remained .02 seconds. ________(c) What percentage of the initial kinetic energy is lost during the elastic collision? ANSWERS: 1. 2500 kgm/s, 1000 kgm/sec, 1.8 x 105N, west, 84% lost 2. 5 m/s, 2.5 x 105 N, 0% Chapter Rotational Motion (7): STUDY GUIDE Citation: H. Q. Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications. (Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors. 7 Rotational Motion Keywords: ; Mechanics; Learning Objectives; Rotational Kinematics; Rotational Motion; Rotational Dynamics; Torque; Center Of Mass; Moment Of Inertia; Rotational Kinetic Energy; Angular Momentum; Angular Acceleration; Angular Displacement; Angular Velocity; Angular Acceleration; Statics GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: angular displacement center of mass angular velocity moment of inertia angular acceleration rotational kinetic uniformly accelerated angular energy motion angular momentum torque Equilibrium State the conditions for static equilibrium. Rotational Motion Write the equations for rotational motion with constant angular acceleration. Rotational Kinematics Solve problems for systems with a fixed axis of rotation using the principles of rotational kinematics. Rotational Dynamics Solve problems using the principles of rotational dynamics, for systems with fixed axes of rotation, including conservation of energy and conservation of angular momentum. Equilibrium Problems Solve problems involving conditions of static equilibrium. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should be familiar with Chapter 4, Forces and Newton's Laws, and Chapter 5, Energy. The quantitative aspects of rotational motion are very similar to those of kinematics (Chapter 3). OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Mechanics; Rotational Kinematics; Rotational Dynamics; Statics This chapter may seem long because it contains both Rotational Kinematics and Rotational Dynamics. The essential features of each of these concepts are summarized and compared to the linear case in the table on page 153 (Rotational Kinematics) and table 7.1, page 167 (Rotational Dynamics). The chapter will be easier to handle if you keep these subdivisions in mind. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE When you begin to study this chapter, read the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Equilibrium, Rotational Dynamics, and Equilibrium. An expanded discussion of each of the terms listed asDefinitions can be found in the next section of this Study Guide chapter. Next, read Chapter Sections 7.1-7.9. As you read, be sure to note the parallels between rotational motion and linear motion. The table on page 153 summarizes the expressions for rotational kinematics, table 7.1 on page 167 summarizes rotation dynamics. As you read, remember that the answers to all questions posed in the text sections are answered in the second section of this chapter. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and completeSummary Exercises 3, 9, 10, 11, 12, and 15. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1, 3, 4, 5, and 6 and complete Problems and Exercises 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 15, 16, 17, and 23. For additional practice on rotational motion problems, see section three of this for more Examples. Finally, attempt the Practice Test. If you have difficulties with any part of the test, seek extra work from the appropriate text section. This study procedure is outlined below. ----------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ----------------Definitions 7.1,7.2,7.3 3,10,11,12 1,3,4 Equilibrium 7.4 9 6,7,8 Rotational 7.5,7.6,7.7, 5,6 9,23 Dynamics 7.8,7.9 Equilibrium 7.4 15 5,6,7,8, Problems 15,16,17 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Mechanics; Angular Displacement; Angular Velocity; Angular Acceleration; Torque; Moment Of Inertia; Rotational Kinetic Energy; Rotational Dynamics; Rotational Kinematics; Rotational Motion; Angular Momentum ANGULAR DISPLACEMENT Angle between two positions of a rigid body rotating about a fixed axis. Usually given in radians. You are probably most likely to give angular displacements in degrees, such as "Make a 45ø turn," rather than "Turn p/4 radians." So you need to practice the conversion from radians to degrees and vice versa so that both ways of measuring angles are familiar to you. ANGULAR VELOCITY Time rate of change of angular displacement. Usually given in radians per second. The most common way of talking about angular velocity in daily life is probably in turns of revolutions per second or per minute. Do you know what the 33 1/3 for a phonograph record means? It stands for 33 1/3 r.p.m. (revolutions per minute). Do you know how to convert that to an angular speed measured in radians per second? ANGULAR ACCELERATION Time rate of change of angular velocity. Usually given in radians per second per second. When the rate of rotation of an object is changing then it has an angular acceleration. If the rate of rotation is increasing, then the angular acceleration is positive. UNIFORMLY ACCELERATED ANGULAR MOTION Rotational motion with a constant angular acceleration. Common examples of this kind of motion seem scarce except for systems that roll under the action of gravity, such as a yo-yo rolling down its string. TORQUE (moment of force) A vector product of a force and its perpendicular distance to the point of rotation. A right-hand rule can be used to determine its direction. You can note that the direction of the torque vector is exactly the direction wherenothing is happening since the acting force and the distance to the rotation point form a plane perpendicular to the torque. CENTER OF MASS The balance point of an object; the force of gravity (weight) produces zero torque about the center of mass. You have noticed since your early childhood that even large objects can be supported at one point. There are several kinds of children's toys that make use of an unusual shape to stably balance on a point. What can you deduce about the location of the center of mass of such toys? MOMENT OF INERTIA Measure of the ability of a body to resist a change in rotation. It depends upon the distribution of its mass relative to an axis of rotation. If most of the mass of an object is far from the axis of rotation, then the moment of inertia is large. Hence, a large baseball bat is easier to swing if you choke up on the handle. You are moving more of the mass of the bat closer to the center of rotation, your hands, so that you reduce its moment of inertia for the swing. ROTATIONAL KINETIC ENERGY Energy of rotation equal to one-half the product of moment of inertia and angular velocity squared. Objects that rotate about an axis fixed in space have this kind of kinetic energy. ANGULAR MOMENTUM The product of moment of inertia and angular velocity gives the magnitude of the angular momentum. A right-hand rule can be used to determine its direction. It is a straight forward matter to show that a system may have a constant linear momentum while its angular momentum changes, but the reverse case is not possible. Consider the case of motion of a system of two equal forces acting in opposite directions but separated by some distance. What properties of such a system are constant? What properties change? ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Rotational Kinematics; Mechanics; Rotational Dynamics; Rotational Kinetic Energy; Torque; Angular Momentum SECTION 7.1 Introduction The most common way of talking about rotation is in terms of the number of complete rotations or revolutions an object or system makes. This is often done in terms of revolutions per minutes or rotations per second. You can start an object rotating by applying some forces to the object that are some distance away from the point of rotation, or axis, and do not point exactly toward the axis. We can specify the angular motion of a system in terms of its angular displacement, angular velocity, angular acceleration, moment of inertia, rotational kinetic energy, and angular momentum. Photographs, page 154 Notice the line of action of the applied torque with respect to the point of rotation; i.e., the point of contact between the spool and the table. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Dynamic Equilibrium; Worked Examples; Angular Acceleration; Rotational Kinematics; Uniform Circular Motion; Angular Velocity; Angular Displacement; Rotational Kinetic Energy; Moment Of Inertia; Conservation Of Angular Momentum; Rotational Dynamics; Arithmetic; Statics; Muscular System; Human Anatomy And Physiology; Muscular Systems; Free Body Diagrams; Torque ROTATIONAL KINEMATICS 1. A physics student is earning some extra money for his college expenses by serving as a teacher's aide at a nursery school. One day on the playground he notices a child (24 kg) playing on the merry-goround which has an off-center set of hand and foot bars so that it can be started from rest by a person sitting on the merrygo-round. He makes the following observations: the child starts the merry-go-round from rest and pumps it up to a constant rotation rate in 12 seconds, after which time the child passes the observer each 1.4 seconds. The diameter of the merrygo-round is 5 meters. Quantitatively describe the child's rotation. What Data Are Given? The mass of the child is 24 kg. The period of angular acceleration is 12 sec and the time required for one complete rotation of the child is 1.4 sec. If the child is assumed to be sitting on the rim of the merry-goround, then the child is 2.5 meters from the axis of rotation. What Data Are Implied? In order to calculate the child's angular acceleration, let us assume that the motion is uniformly accelerated angular motion (u.a.a.m.) until the merry- go-round reaches a constant speed of rotation. It then is a special case of u.a.a.m.; i.e., the angular acceleration is zero. What Physics Principles Are Involved? You can begin the problem by using the concepts of u.a.a.m. as given on page 150, or summarized in the right-hand column of the table on page 153. You can also calculate the work done by the child and the kinetic energy of the child using concepts from Section 7.7. What Equations Are to be Used? Angular velocity; w = 2p / T where T is the period of rotation. For u.a.a.m.; a = w / t where t is the time of acceleration (7.3) the angle turned during acceleration = 1/2 a t2 (7.8) Kinetic Energy = (Iw2) / 2 = (mr2w2) / 2 for a point mass m located at a distance r from the axis of rotation (7.26) Work = change in kinetic energy (7.25) Algebraic Solutions The equations above are all written with terms we may wish to calculate on the lefthand side of each equation. Numerical Solutions Final angular velocity = (2p rad.) / (1.4 sec.) = 45 rad/sec Angular acceleration = (4.5 rad/sec.) / (12 sec.) = 0.37 rad/s2 Angle of rotation during acceleration = 1/2 (0.37)(12)2 q = 27 radians Angular displacement of the child at any time at 12 seconds where t is the time from rest, q = 27 rad. + (4.5 rad/s)(t - 12) where t > 12 s. Distance travelled in meters = gq = (2.5 m)q Kinetic energy of the child = 1/2 (24 kg)(2.5 m)2(4.5 rad/s)2 = 1.5 x 103 J Work done to rotate the child = 1.5 x 103 J, this neglects the rotational kinetic energy of the merry-go-round. ROTATIONAL DYNAMICS 2. Consider a playground merry-go-round at rest and a child (24 kg) runs at a speed of 6.2 m/s tangential to the rim of the merry-go-round on 3.0 meter radius and jumps on it. If the moment of inertia of the merry-go-round is 1.44 x 102 kgm2, what is the final angular speed of the system? What is the final kinetic energy of the system? Is any energy lost? If so, what happens to it? What Data Are Given? The mass, speed, and distance of the child from the axis of rotation are given. The moment of inertia of the merry-go-round is given. What Data Are Implied? The visual arrangement of the problem is implied by the setting of this problem. Can you picture it in your mind? See Fig. 7.1 This problem also implies that friction be neglected. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The concept of the conservation of angular momentum can be used to analyze the motion of the combined system of child and merry-go-round. From the instant the child jumps from the ground to land on the merry-go-round, the total angular momentum is constant since there are then no external torques acting on the combined child - merry-go-round system if the frictional forces on the system are neglected. It seems as if conservation of energy can also be assumed from the instant the child jumps up to the merry-go-round. There are no external forces acting on the system. What Equations Are to be Used? The angular momentum is a constant Iiwi = Ifwf (7.30) Total energy is a constant, perhaps 1/2 mvi2 = 1/2 Ifwf2 To use these equations you need to know that the magnitude linear velocity v can be related to the magnitude angular velocity w about a fixed axis is the perpendicular distance from the velocity to the axis is v by the following equation. v = rw (7.12) Algebraic Solutions The initial angular momentum of the child - merry-go-round system is equal to the angular momentum of the child just as she jumps on the merry-go-round because the merry-go-round is initially at rest and so has an angular momentum of zero. Initial angular momentum = Li = mcvcv c (1) where the subscript c stands for the child of mass, speed, and distance from axis of rotation of m, v, and r respectively. Final angular momentum = Lf = ImWm + IcWc (2) where the subscript m applies to the merry-go-round. Since the child and the merry-goround are rotating together in the final state the angular speed of the child and the merry-go-round are the same. Wm = WC (3) The child can be treated as a rotating point mass, so Ic = mcrc2. Then, from conservation of angular momentum, Lf = Li Wm(Im + mcrc2) = mcvcrc (4) so Wm = (mcvcrc) / (Im + mcrc2) Is energy conserved? The initial energy = KEi = 1/2 mcvc2 (5) The final energy = KEf = 1/2 ImWm2 + 1/2 IcWc2 = 1/2 Wm2 (Im + Ic) (6) We can substitute the above expression for Wm, then KEf = 1/2 [(mcvcrc) / (Im + mcrc2)]2 ¥ [Im + mcrc2] = 1/2 [(mc2vc2rc2) / (Im + mcrc2)] Let us set the initial and final kinetic energies equal 1/2 mcvc2 = 1/2 [(mc2vc2rc2) / (Im + mcrc2)] (5) Divide by 1/2 mcvc2 1 = (mcrc2) / (Im + mcrc2) which will be true if Im = 0. The energy will be conserved only if the moment of inertia of the merry- go-round is neglected. What happens to the energy when Im is not treated as zero? What explanation can you give of the failure of the law of conservation of energy to be true for this system? Numerical Solutions Initial angular momentum = (24 kg)(6.2 m/s)(3.0 m) = 4.5 x 102 kgm2/s Final angular speed = Wm = (4.5 x 102 kgm2/s) / (1.44 x 102 kgm2 + 24 kg (3.0 m)2) = (4.5 x 102) / (3.6 x 102) ¥ rad/sec = (5.0 rad/s) / 4.0 = 1.3 rad/s. Initial kinetic energy = 1/2 (24 kg)(6.2 m/s)2 = 4.6 x 102 J Final kinetic energy = 1/2 (1.44 x 102)(5/4)2 + 1/2 (24)(3.0)2(5/4)2 = 2.8 x 102 J Fraction of kinetic energy lost = (4.6 x 102 J - 2.8 x 102J) / (4.6 x 102 J) = 0.39 EQUILIBRIUM PROBLEMS 3. What is the force applied by the quadriceps tendon to the lower portion of the human leg to hold it up at a 45ø angle from horizontal? Assume the values of the variables as shown in the following mechanical analog to the human leg. What Data Are Given? See Figure 7.2 What Data Are Implied? Use the strength of the earth's gravitational field to be g = 9.8 m/s2. Then a generalized force diagram can be drawn as follows See Fig. 7.3 Thinking About the Answer Notice how just the simple statement that the child jumps on the merry-go-round, with its implication of a completely inelastic collision means that 39% of the initial kinetic energy is lost. What happens to it? You are invited to postulate a different final situation. Assume the child makes a completely elastic collision with the merry-go-round. What then is the final state of the child and of the merry-go-round? This means that the condition that the final angular velocity of the child and the merry-go-round must no longer be equal, so Equation (3) is no longer true. Can you solve the completely elastic collision case? Hint: Equations (1), (2), (5), and (6) are still valid, but they must be solved simultaneously for Wm and Wc. [Answers: rotation speed of the merry-go-round = 2.5 rad/s. speed of the child = 1.1 m/s still along the tangent line] If you wish you can extend the elastic collision calculations and compute the impulsive torque on the merry-go-round and the impulse on the child. Would he be hurt by an elastic collision with the merry-go-round? What Physics Principles Are Involved? The system must satisfy the conditions for equilibrium, p. 157. Sum of forces = zero Sum of torques = zero What Equations Are to be Used? There is an unknown force L exerted by the upper leg bone of the hinge at the knee. If we sum the torques about point A, then we can eliminate the force L and solve for F. Sum of torques = 0 = -Fd sin a + W2 (1/2)cos q + WF (1 cos q + F/2) (6) where a negative sign indicates a counter-clockwise rotation about the point A. Algebraic Solution Solve for F in Equation 6 F = [W1 1/2 cos q + WF (1 cos q + f/2)] / (d sin a) (7) Numerical Solution F = [((4 kg)(9.8 m/s2)(0.22 m) cos 45ø + (2 kg)(9.8 m/s2) (0.44 cos 45ø + 0.09)) / ((0.10 m) sin (arctan 0.5))] F = (6.1 + 7.9) / (4.5 x 10-2) = 31 N Thinking About the Answer You can see from Equation (7) that the smaller you make the angle q; i.e., the more nearly you hold your lower leg out horizontally, the greater is the force applied by the quadriceps tendon. Try lifting your leg and feeling of this tendon as you do. What can you infer from what you feel? Does our mechanical analog seem to be a good approximation for the way your leg really works? PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Problems; ; Answers; Simple Mechanics; Statics; Force; Angular Velocity; Torque; Moment Of Inertia; Rotational Equilibrium; Mechanics; Tension; Angular Acceleration; Evaluations; Rotational Dynamics 1. The six meter uniform bar has a weight of 20 Newtons. It is placed so that one end rests on the side of a table, and a 15 Newton weight is placed 1 meter from its center. See Fig. a. What force if applied to point D will keep the bar in equilibrium? b. With the bar in equilibrium, what force acts on the bar at point A? 2. The bicycle wheel shown below has a mass of 5 kilograms and a moment of inertia of .5 kg m2 about its center. The wheel is supported above the ground so that it can rotate freely and be driven by the chain C. The driving sprocket has a radius of 10 cm. a. If the chain is producing an angular acceleration a = 5 rad/sec2, what is the tension in the driving chain? b. If the wheel starts at rest, what will be its angular velocity after 3 sec? See Fig. ANSWERS: 1. 20 N, 15 N 2. 2.5 N, 15 rad/sec Chapter Fluid Flow (8): Citation: H. Q. Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications. (Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors. 8 Fluid Flow Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Fluids; Fluid Statics; Density; Pressure; Buoyant Force; Buoyancy; Specific Gravity; Viscosity; Fluid Dynamics; Streamline Flow; Archimedes' Principle; Bernoulli's Principle; Pascal's Principle; Poiseuille's Law; Fluid Motion GOALS When When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: fluid buoyant force density streamline flow specific gravity viscosity pressure (absolute and gauge) Fluid Laws State Pascal's law of hydrostatic pressure, Archimedes' principle of buoyancy, Bernoulli's equation for the conservation of energy in a fluid, and the law of conservation of fluid flow. Fluid Problems Solve problems making use of the principles of fluids and conservation laws. Viscous Flow Use Poiseuille's law of viscous flow to solve numerical problems. PREREQUISITES Before you begin this chapter, you should be able to solve problems that use energy concepts (see Chapter 5). OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Fluids; Fluid Statics; Fluid Dynamics; Fluid Motion The movement of liquid or gaseous substances is an important consideration for medical doctors and air conditioning mechanics, as well as children using a soda straw. There seems to be endless examples of how we are dependent on the flow of fluids for making the work we do easier and more complete. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE To begin your study of this chapter, read the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Fluid Laws, Fluid Problems, and Viscous Flow. Expanded discussion of each term under Definitions is found in the next section of this chapter. Next, read text sections 8.1-8.13. Remember that answers to the questions asked in these sections are given in this Study Guide chapter. Now read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-12. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1, 2, 3, and 4, and complete Exercises and Problems 2, 3, 4, 5, 7, 8, 9, 15, 17, and 21. For additional experience, select from the other Exercises and Problems and/or consider the Examples given in the third section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Fluid Flow at the end of this chapter. Remember to wait until you have worked the problem before looking at the answer. Seek assistance in areas where you do not score 100%. This study procedure is outlined below. -----------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -----------------------Definitions 8.1,8.2,8.3, 1,2,3,4, 8.4 5,6,7 Fluid Problems 8.5,8.6,8.7, 8,9,10,11 2 2,3,4,5, 8.8 7,8,9,15 Viscous Flow 8.10,8.11,8.12 12 1,3,4 17,21 8.13 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Fluids; Density; Specific Gravity; Pressure; Buoyancy; Buoyant Force; Streamline Flow; Viscosity; Fluid Statics; Fluid Dynamics; Fluid Motion FLUID A substance which takes the shape of its container and flows from one location to another. The class of all materials that are fluids includes both liquids, such as water, and gases, such as air. The class of incompressible fluids is called liquids. DENSITY The ratio of the amount of matter contained in an object to the amount of space occupied by the object is called its density. In the SI system the density of water at a temperature of 4ºC is defined as exactly 1000 kilograms of mass for each cubic meter of water, or 1 gm per cubic centimeter of water. SPECIFIC GRAVITY The ratio of the density of a substance to the density of water. The specific gravity of an object that sinks in water is a number larger than 1.0. Note that specific gravity is a number with no units. PRESSURE The normal force acting on a unit area is the pressure. Since all of the objects near the surface of the earth are usually acted upon by the pressure of the earth's atmosphere of air, we often measure only the excess pressure of a system. We then call it a gauge pressure. We must add the atmospheric pressure to the gauge pressure to obtain the value of the absolute pressure. BUOYANT FORCE The resultant of all the pressure forces acting on an object submerged in a fluid. In general, the buoyant force pushes up on an object making its weight in a fluid less than it would be in a vacuum. The greater the density of the fluid in which you weigh the object the larger is the buoyant force. STREAMLINE FLOW Every particle in a flow which passes a given point will flow through all the points in the line of flow. Such flow has no swirls or turbulence. In general it is only approximated in real fluids by low speed flow in smooth-walled containers. VISCOSITY The tendency of a real fluid to resist flow is known as viscosity. It is the internal friction of the fluid. The liquid coefficient of viscosity is a relative measure of liquid friction and is equivalent to the ratio of the force per unit area to the change in velocity per unit length perpendicular to the direction of flow. The most common example of the importance of viscosity is probably in the motor oils used to lubricate automobile and motorcycle engines. The greater the viscosity of a fluid the greater is its resistance to flow. Cold syrup has a greater resistance to pouring than warm syrup. Viscosity of many liquids is strongly temperature dependent. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Fluids; Density; Viscosity; Dimensional Analysis; Units; Viscous Flow; Friction; Pressure; Pressure In Fluids; Measurement Of Pressure; Answers; Fluids; Viscosity; Archimedes' Principle; Force; Fluid Statics; Fluid Dynamics; Poiseuille's Law; Medicine And Law SECTION 8.1 Introduction The circulation of air in a building to provide proper temperature of the habitation of human beings is an example of using fluid flow to transfer energy from one location to another. The flow inertia of a fluid is measured by its density. The loss of energy in the flow of a liquid is called viscosity. SECTION 8.3 Density The dimensions of density are M/L3. To covert kg/m 3 to gm/cm3 divide by 1000 or 103. SECTION 8.4 Force on Fluids If you try to push your hand along the surface of a fluid, parallel to its surface, you force the fluid to travel along with your hand with very little resisting force. As you slid your hand along a solid surface you feel a frictional force opposing the motion of your hand. SECTION 8.5 Pressure Keywords: Pressure in Fluids; Pressure Measurement; Answers Because of the persistent use of the English system of units, a common pressure unit is pounds per square inch. The pressure for inflation of bicycle tires is given in lb. per square inch. Tire pressures are intended to be gauge pressures. Pressure is also given in atmospheres, 1 atmosphere of pressure being equal to the pressure caused by the usually atmospheric pressure on the surface of the earth. The weather bureau gives the pressure in inches of mercury; i.e., the height of a column of mercury that is supported by the pressure of the atmosphere. SECTION 8.6 Pressure of a Liquid in a Column We can use Equation 8.4 in conjunction with our knowledge of the density of mercury 13.6 x 103kg/m3 and the gravitational constant 9.8 m/s2 to calculate the standard atmospheric pressure in newtons per square meter, P = (13.6 x 10 3 kg/m3) (9.80 m/s2) (0.760 m) = 1.01 x 105 N/m2. SECTION 8.9 Archimedes Principle Keywords: Archimedes' Principle; Density; Answers; History; Worked Examples Two ways to measure the density of a liquid are (1) direct measurement of the mass of a known volume of the liquid using a container whose volume has been calibrated, or (2) float an object of known mass and volume in the liquid and measure the portion of the object that remains above the surface of the liquid. In the second method Archimedes Principle is used to calculate the weight of displaced liquid. To perform some sample calculations from the traditional Archimedes story let us assume the crown was a hollow cylinder of 56 1/2 cm circumference, 0.50 cm in thickness and averaged 8.0 cm in height, then the volume of the crown is approximately V Ëœ 2prh(Dt) = 2p (9 cm)(8 cm)(0.5 cm) v Ëœ 226cm3 See Fig. If the crown were pure gold it would have a mass of 4.4 kg. If the crown were pure lead it would have a mass of 2.6 kg. One possibility is that Archimedes stepped into a completely full bath tub causing the water to overflow. He then realized he could use the same technique by catching the overflowing water to find the volume of the crown. He could then perform a straight-forward comparison of the density of the crown to the density of gold. However, mythology has it that Archimedes was extremely brilliant, so he no doubt worked out the Greek equivalent to Equation (8.7) on the way running to the palace; i.e. SG = A / (A-W) (1) SECTION 8.12 Poiseuille's Law of Viscous Flow Keywords: Poiseuille's Law; Medicine and Health; Answers Example 2. The flow of the I.V. liquid will be determined by its viscosity, the diameter of the injection needle and the pressure head, h. If the diameter is reduced by one-half, then by Equation 8.19 the flow is reduced to 1/16th its original value so the pressure head would have to be increased to 16 h! EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Fluids; Worked Examples; Fluid Statics; Fluid Dynamics; Fluid Motion; Arithmetic; Conservation Of Energy; Viscous Flow; Poiseuille's Law; Medicine And Health; Cardiovascular Systems; Friction; Anatomy And Physiology; Streamline Flow; Pressure; Bernoulli's Principle; Velocity FLUID PROBLEMS 1. The water flowing from a garden hose is passed through a nozzle and then sprayed into the air. Assume the hose is in a horizontal position and the pressure and velocity of the water in the hose are 3.0 x 105 N/m2 and 2.6 m/s respectively. If the nozzle reduces the effective area by 84%; i.e., area of nozzle = (0.16) area of hose, what happens to the water pressure and water velocity in the nozzle? What Data Are Given? Phose = 3.0 x 105 N/m2; vhose = 2.6 m/s; Anozzle = 0.16 Ahose What Data Are Implied? The height of the hose and the nozzle are the same. The water may be treated as an ideal, streamline flow fluid. What Physics Principles Are Involved? We can make use of the conservation of liquid volume (Equation 8.8) and the conservation of energy (Equation 8.14). What Equations Are to be Used? vhAh = vnAn (8.8) Ph + pghh + 1/2 pvh2 = P n + pghn + 1/2 pvn2 (8.14) where the subscripts h and n stand for hose and nozzle respectively. Algebraic Solution We are given that the elevation of the hose and the nozzle are the same, so we can proceed as follows. The velocity in the nozzle Vn = (Ahvh) / An (2) The velocity is increased by a factor equal to the ratio of the areas. We can substitute Equation (2) into equation (8.14) and solve for the pressure in the nozzle; noting that pghh = pghn Pn = Ph + 1/2 p(vh2 - vn2) Pn = Ph + 1/2 pvh2 ((1 - Ah2) /An2) (3) NOTE! The area of the hose Ah is larger than the area of the nozzle An so the second term on the right-hand side of equation (3) is negative. The pressure in the nozzle must be less than the pressure in the hose! Numerical Solution vn = (Ah/0.16 Ah)(2.6 m/s) = 16 m/s Pnozzle = (3.0 x 105) + 1/2 (103 kg/m3) (2.6 m/s)2 (1 - (Ah/0.16 Ah)2) = 3.0 x 105 + 1/2 (6.8 x 103) Pn = 3.0 x 10 5 - 1.3 x 105 = 1.7 x 105 N/m2 Thinking About the Answers The velocity in the nozzle is increased by more than six times while the nozzle pressure is 57% of the pressure in the hose. Notice that the high velocity region is also the region of low pressure. VISCOUS FLOW 2. When taken from a refrigerator (4ºC) cold human blood has a viscosity of 8 centipoise. At room temperature (20º) its viscosity is 4 centipoise. Assume the viscosity of blood changes linearly with temperature and that the blood flow was proper for cold blood for an IV arrangement as shown in Figure 8.15 with a bottle elevation of ho. Explain how the elevation of the bottle should be changed as the blood warms up to maintain a constant flow. What Data Are Given? The viscosity of blood at 4ºC is 8 centipoise. The initial elevation head for the flow of the blood is ho. What Data Are Implied? It is assumed that Poiseuille's Law is applicable. The viscosity of the blood can be related to the temperature by a linear function. Since the viscosity at two temperatures is known and the general form of the equation must be viscosity = (constant)1 temperature + (constant)2 the quantitative relationship between viscosity and temperature can be derived, h(centipoise) = -1/4 t(ºc) + 9 (4) for the temperature region 4 Û t Û 20. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The flow of human blood is viscous flow, so Poiseuille's Law may be applied, Equation 8.19. What Equations Are to be Used? rate of flow = p/8h (P1 - P2/L) R4 (8.19) and Equation (4) h = -t/4 + 9 (4) pressure difference = P1 - P2 = pgh (8.4) Algebraic Solution In order for the rate of flow to be a constant as the viscosity of the blood changes the pressure, or elevation head, must be changed. Since all the other variables except h and h are constant, then n and h must be changed so that they maintain a constant ratio; rate of flow = (p/8) (R4/L) (pgh/h) At the beginning for cold blood (h = 8 centipoise) the elevation is ho; so h/h = ho / (8 centipose) = h / (9 - t/4) Solving for h; h = (ho/8) (9 - t/4) = 9ho/8 - ho/32 t (5) Numerical Solutions We can draw a graph of the elevation of the bottle as a function of the temperature of the blood. See Fig. Thinking About the Answer As the blood becomes "thinner," its viscosity is diminished and the bottle is lowered to lower the elevation head in order to maintain a constant flow. 3. The flow of a viscous liquid through a tube is constricted by a narrow rubber hose connection. As the connection ages, the rubber expands and the diameter of the constriction increases by 8%. How much does the flow rate increase? What Data Are Given? For the normal constriction there is some standard rate of flow. The diameter of the constriction increases from d to 1.08 d. What Data Are Implied? It is assumed that the conditions are correct for Poiseuille's Law to apply. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The streamline flow of a viscous liquid as described by Poiseville's Law, Equation 8.19, are assumed to apply. What Equation is to be Used? rate of flow = (p/8h) (P1 - P2/L)R4 (8.19) Algebraic Solution All of the variables of the system are constant except for the diameter of the tubing; so (rate of flow)1 ∞ (radius)14 = ((diameter)14) / 16 so rate of flow ∞ (diameter)4 2nd flow rate / 1st flow rate = (second diameter)4 / (first diameter)4 (6) Numerical Solution 2nd flow rate / 1st flow rate = (1.08 d)4 / d4 = (1.08)4 = 1.36 Thinking About the Answer A relatively small increase in the size of the tube (8%) makes a large (36%) increase in the flow rate. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Problems; Answers; Fluids; Fluid Statics; Fluid Dynamics; Fluid Motion; Pascal's Principle; Static Equilibrium In Fluids; Force; Pressure; Bernoulli's Principle; Weight; Flight; Cardiovascular Systems; Anatomy And Physiology; Evaluations; Poiseuille's Law; Hydraulics 1. A schematic diagram representing a hydraulic jack pictured below is being used to lift the front of a car off the ground. A force of 10,000 Newtons is required. See Fig. a. What force at B is required on the small piston to produce the needed force of 10,000 N? b. Under ideal conditions, what force F is required at the end of the 34 cm lever arm to produce this force? 2. A jet airplane is flying at an elevation of 10 kilometers where the air has a density of 4.25 x 10-1 kg/m3 and a pressure of 2.7 x 104 N/m2. The velocity of the air along the bottom of the wing is 20 m/sec. Given the dimension of the wing as shown below: See Fig. a. What is the velocity of the air along the top of the wing? (Assume that the air flow along the top and the bottom of the wing requires the same time.) b. What is the magnitude of the unbalanced pressure acting up on the wing? c. If the airplane has a total wing area of 150 m2, what weight can the airplane support? 3. A person with hardening of the arteries can survive an effective diameter decrease of his arteries of 20%. Under these conditions, how much must the blood pressure increase to keep the rate of blood flow constant? Hint: (Assume that the viscosity of blood remains constant and that the blood flow is unchanged and use Poiseuille's Law in a modified form) See Fig. ANSWERS: 1. 2,000 N, 118 N 2. 25 m/s, 49 N/m2, 7,200 N 3. 2.4 times the initial pressure Chapter Transport Phenomena (9): GOALS Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Continuity Equations; Transport Theory; Thermal Physics After you have mastered the contents of this chapter you will be able to achieve the following goals: Transport Equation Write the quantitative equation for the transport process of a system whose variables are given. Continuity State the continuity equation for a system, and explain the flow properties of a system in terms of that equation. Transport Problems Use algebraic and graphical methods to solve transport problems for one dimensional systems. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter, you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 1, Human Senses, and Chapter 2, Unifying Approaches. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Thermal Physics; Transport Theory Scientists have long recognized the symmetry and simplicity of nature. As you consider the basic aspects of flow (called Transport Phenomena) please notice the basic uniformity of the expressions utilized for each case. Thus, explaining heat flow, electrical charge flow, water flow, and diffusion are related by a basic model for flow. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Before you begin to study this model, be familiar with two of the Chapter Goals: Transport Equation and Transport Process. These two chapter goals are summarized by the equations under AlgorithmicProblems in the Chapter Summary. Please note the form of the Transport Equations: flow (9.1 and 9.3) and current density (9.4, 9.15, and 9.16). For a brief explanation of each of these equations and an example of how each might be used, see the following section of this . Next, read text sections 9.1-9.7. Carefully consider the Examples and Questions given at the end of the sections. Remember to look in this for answers to the questions asked in the text. Now read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, and 8. Check your answers carefully. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1-4 and complete Exercises and Problems 4, 5, 9, and 11. For additional practice with the concepts presented in this chapter, turn to the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Transport Phenomena provided at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulties with any of the questions, refer to this study procedure for additional assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. -------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems --------------Transport 9.1, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 1, 2, 3, Equations 9.5, 9.6, 9.7 Transport 9.2, 9.5 6, 7, 8 1, 2, 3, 4 4, 5, 9, 11 Problems ----------Continuity 9.6 4, 5 3 ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Gradients; Temperature; Transport Theory; Fluid Motion; Rate Of Flow; Heat; Diffusion; Units; Thermal Conductivity; Thermal Transport; Current Density SECTION 9.1 Introduction The water flows down a slope. There is a difference in elevation from one place to another. The greater the difference in elevation the faster is the flow of water. The ladle is a different temperature at different locations. This temperature difference may be thought of as the cause of a flow of heat. The cup is less susceptible to the flow of heat than is the silver ladle. We can talk about an electric potential being of different value at different locations in an electric circuit, so we call it a flow of electricity, or electric current. SECTION 9.2 Temperature Differences and Gradients Example - The gradient of the height in the easterly direction is greatest; i.e., most positive, on the west side of the hill. It is least; i.e., most negative, on the east side of the hill. The gradient of the height in the easterly direction is the negative of the gradient of the height on the westerly direction. The gradient of height in the southerly direction is greatest on the north side, least on the south side, and zero on the top of the hill. The water flowing down the hill will go fastest in the steepest place; i.e., where the contour lines are the closest together, which occurs on the southeast portion of the hill. As time goes on the temperatures at various places on the ladle handle will increase until constant values are obtained and the heat flow becomes stable. 1. A negative value of the temperature gradient means that the gradient points from a high temperature region to a low temperature region. 2. The temperature gradient is a larger negative number at 4 cm than at 3 cm. It is a smaller negative number at 5 cm than at 3 cm. 3. The gradient is just the slope of the line tangent to the curve at the point of interest. The relative size of the gradient can be found by looking at the steepness of these tangent lines. 4. The gradx T has its largest, or least negative, value at the distance of 7 cm. Gradx T is smallest, or most negative at 4 cm. It is not zero any place between zero and seven. SECTION 9.4 Heat Flow 5. Heat can escape from the portion of the handle directly into the air. 6. Yes, your hand on the rod will be hotter than a hand in air the same distance from the fire. SECTION 9.5 Water Flow 7. The water flow between 150 and 200 seconds appears to be at a constant rate of about 5 liters/50 sec. or 0.1 liter/second. 8. The fact that the amount of water in the bucket stays the same after 300 seconds can be explained by a condition where the inflow and outflow of water become equal. It can be obtained by (1) turning off the water so both inflow and outflow are zero or (2) filling the bucket then the inflow equals the outflow as the bucket overflows. SECTION 9.7 How to Increase the Flow 9. The units of current density for heat flow are joules per square meter per second. 10. The temperature gradient in SI units is measured in degrees Celsius per meter. 11. The coefficient of thermal conductivity must have the units of heat current divided by temperature gradient, joules/ meter øC sec. 12. The various values for the temperature gradients as estimated from the graph See Fig. 9.2 are -3øC/cm, -9øC/cm, and -7øC/cm at the locations of 1 cm, 3 cm, and 5 cm respectively. The current densities can be found by multiplying the temperature gradients by the coefficient of thermal conductivity 420 J/møCs. The current densities are then 1 x 105 J/m2s, 4 x 10 5 J/m2s, and 3 x 105 J/m2s respectively. SECTION 9.8 Diffusion 13. From Equation 9.16 the diffusion coefficient D must have the same units as the ratio of the mass current density J (moles/m2 sec) to the concentration gradient Dc/Dx (moles/m4); so D has the units of m2/sec. 14. Equation 9.19 has consistent units since the gradient of the concentration is multiplied by the ratio of D2/D, it is the same as being multiplied by D as in Equation 9.16. WORD STATEMENT OF EQUATIONS The rate of heat flow (I) is equal to the change in the quantity of heat (DH) divided by the time required to produce such a change (Dt), I = DH/Dt (9.1) The rate of matter flow (I) is equal to the change in the quantity of matter (DQ) divided by the time required to produce such a change, I =DQ/Dt (9.3) The current density (J) is the amount of something that flows through a unit area in a unit of time. Hence, if the area is of size A, the time is of duration t, and the amount of something is Q; J = Q/At. (9.4) The change of the mass density of a substance per unit time is equal to the change in current density per unit length, Dp/Dt = D J/l (9.13) For incompressible fluids, the density does not change, soDp/Dt = 0, and the current density cannot change from one location in the liquid to another one. The thermal energy current through an object Jx is equal to the negative of the coefficient of thermal conductivity of the object times the temperature gradient across the object. Jx = -KH DT/Dx (9.15) The matter current of diffusive flow (J) is equal to the negative product of the diffusion constant D and the gradient of the mass concentration. J = -D Dc/Dx (9.16) EXAMPLES Keywords: Gradients; Worked Examples; ; Oxygen; Continuity; Equations; Anatomy And Physiology; Cardiovascular Systems; Transport Theory; Rate Of Flow; Cells; Current Density; Arithmetic TRANSPORT PROBLEMS 1. While studying the flow of oxygen in living systems a pathologist quick froze a human blood cell and then used a microprobe to analyze the concentration of oxygen at various locations in the cell at one instant in time. These data are shown below. See Fig. (a) Where are regions of maximum oxygen concentration gradients? Minimum oxygen concentration gradients? (b) As time goes on, if the cell were not frozen, explain in words what you expect to happen to the oxygen concentration in the blood cell. (c) By using a microprobe around the outside of the warmed cell the scientist measured a maximum oxygen diffusion current to be 2.3mmoles/mm2 sec. Where do you think that oxygen current is flowing? What is its direction of flow? Estimate a value of the diffusion coefficient for oxygen for this blood cell. What Data Are Given? The oxygen concentrations are given at various locations in a plane. What Data Are Implied? It is assumed that gradient and current calculations are appropriate for the scale of sizes of the various quantities given in this problem. This includes the assumption that superposition is valid for this system. What Physics Principles Are Involved? This problem involves the use of the definitions of gradient and current and their assumed linear relationship as expressed in Equation 9.16. What Equations Are to be Used? concentration gradient = change in concentration/change in location =Dc/Dx (1) matter current density through an area = change in concentration/ area ¥ time (2) matter current density = J = -D Dc/Dx (3) Algebraic Solutions This is a problem without a closed algebraic solution, you need to determine numerical results from the given data. Numerical Solutions (a) Regions of maximum gradient will occur with the maximum increase in oxygen concentration while the x and y value is increasing. The maximum gradient in the x direction occurs for y = 0.0, between x = 0.4 and 0.6, then gradx c = (0.9 - 0.1)/(0.6 - 0.4) = 0.8/0.2 = 4 micromoles/ cm3 ¥ mm = 40 mm/cm4 = 4 x 10-5 moles/cm4 = 4 x 103 moles/(meter)4 The maximum gradient in the y - direction occurs when x = 1.0 and between y = 0.2 and 0.4. grady c = (1.7 - 0.8)/(0.4 - 0.2) = 0.9/0.2 ÷ 5 micromoles/cm3 ¥ mm = 5 x 103 moles/m4 The minimum gradient will occur with the maximum decrease in oxygen concentration while the x or y value is increasing. The minimum gradient in the x - direction occurs for y = 0.4, and x is between 1.0 and 1.2 gradx c = (0.4 - 1.7)/(1.2 - 1.0) = -1.3/0.2 = -7 micromoles/cm3 ¥ mm = 7 x 103 moles/m4 The minimum gradient in the y - direction occurs for x = 0.8 and between y = 0.4 and 0.6, grady c = (1.1 - 2.3)/(0.6 - 0.4) = -1.2/0.2 = -6 micromoles/cm3 ¥ mm = -6 x 103 moles/m4 (b) If the walls of the cell are impervious to the flow of oxygen, then the total amount of oxygen in the cell must remain a constant. There would be flow of oxygen inside the cell from regions of high concentration; e.g., (0.8, 0.4), to the regions of low concentration around the cell boundary. The final average uniform concentration would be about 0.8mm/cm3. If the walls of the cell will allow oxygen to flow in and out, then the oxygen concentration in the cell will finally become equal to the concentration of oxygen in the environment. In both cases, the internal gradients of oxygen concentration will become zero. (c) The largest gradient is absolute magnitude is gradx c for y = 0.4 and 1.0 ó x ó 1.2, so it seems most likely that the maximum flow of oxygen occurs in response to that gradient, in the positive x direction. Jx = -D Dc/Dx = -D (-7 x 103 moles/m4) (9.16) Jx = (2.3 x 10-6 moles/mm2 ¥ sec) = (2.3 moles/m2 ¥ sec) = 7 x 103 moles D/m4 so D ÷ (3 x 10-3 m2)/sec. See Fig. In studying problems of flow You need to find where to go Students radiant Follow the gradient But end up not above but below! PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Thermal Transport; Transport Theory; Gradients; Problems; Answers; ; Evaluations; Gradients; Rate Of Flow; Thermal Conductivity A metal rod is placed in a flame and the temperature at various locations along the rod is measured at various times. See Fig. The following data were obtained. See Fig. 1. On graph paper plot these data as different curves so you can calculate the temperature gradient from your graph. Label your axes. 2. What is the temperature gradient at the 40 cm location at a time of 6 minutes? 3. If the Coefficient of thermal conductivity of the rod is 4W/øC cm, calculate the rate of flow of heat along the rod. (Cross-sectional area = 1.5 cm2) Chapter Temperature and Heat (10): GOALS Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Temperature; Thermometers; Heat; Thermal Expansion; Units; Heat; Heat Equivalent; Mechanical Equivalent; Specific Heats; Heat Capacity; Latent Heats; Calorimetry; Heat Of Combustion When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it an operational definition: temperature mechanical equivalent of heat thermometer heat capacity heat specific heat linear expansion latent heat of fusion volumetric expansion latent heat of vaporization calorie heat of combustion Calorimetry Solve problems in calorimetry. Gas Laws Solve problems using the gas laws involving the pressure, volume, and temperature of a confined gas. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 5, Energy, and Chapter 9, Transport Phenomena. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Heat; Thermal Physics; Instructions Heat is a form of energy. As this energy moves from one object to another, we may detect physical changes in both the object losing heat energy and the object gaining heat energy. This chapter deals with many of these basic changes and the rules used to describe them. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE This chapter places emphasis on three primary Chapter Goals: Definitions, Calorimetry, and Gas Laws. Please read these chapter goals carefully. For an expanded discussion of the terms listed under Definitions, please turn to the next page of this Chapter. Next, read text sections 10.1-10.9. Be sure to check the answer to each question in the text readings. You will find these answers in the second section of this chapter. Now read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-12. Then do Algorithmic Problems 1-9 and check your answers carefully against the answers given in the text. Now do Problems and Exercises 1, 2, 4, 9, 10, 14, and 18. For additional examples of problems from this text chapter, please see the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test over Temperature and Heat. Check your answers with those given. If you have difficulties with any of the problems, refer to the appropriate text section and the suggested study procedure. This study procedure is outlined below. ---------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ---------------Definitions 10.1, 10.2, 10.3, 1-10 1, 2, 3, 4, 1, 2, 4 10.4, 10.5, 10.7, 5, 6, 7, 8 10.8 Calorimetry 10.6 11 9, 10 Gas Laws 10.9 12 9 14, 18 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Thermal Physics; Temperature; Thermometers; Heat; Thermal Expansion; Units; Heat Equivalent; Mechanical Equivalent; Heat Capacity; Specific Heats; Latent Heats; Heat Of Combustion TEMPERATURE The relative hotness or coldness of an object. The human body contains many temperature sensors to inform you of the temperature of your body and its environment. THERMOMETER A device or transducer which can be used to measure the temperature of a system. The most common kinds of thermometer are mercury in glass and red-colored alcohol in glass. HEAT Thermal work, a process by which the internal energy of a system is changed. LINEAR EXPANSION Change in length accompanied by a change in temperature. Most materials increase in length when their temperatures are increased. VOLUMETRIC EXPANSION The change in volume accompanied by a change in temperature. Most substances expand when they are heated. Water at 4øC expands if it is heated and if it is cooled! CALORIE The mean amount of heat required to increase the temperature of one gram of water one degree Celsius. MECHANICAL EQUIVALENT OF HEAT The amount of mechanical energy which is equivalent to one unit of heat or thermal work. In the SI units 4.186 joules is equivalent to 1 calorie. Your (Fuller)3 textbook weighs about 13 Newtons. If you lift it about 32 cm you will have done about 4.19 joules of work. That amount of work would raise the temperature of 1 cubic centimeter of water one degree Celsius. HEAT CAPACITY Product of the mass of a body in grams and specific heat; i.e., amount of heat required to raise the temperature of the body one degree Celsius. SPECIFIC HEAT Heat energy required to raise the temperature of a mass of material one Celsius degree. Compared to many other substances, See Table 10.3, water has a large specific heat. Water is a good substance to use for the storage of thermal energy. LATENT HEAT OF FUSION Heat required to change unit mass of material from the solid state to the liquid at the melting point. Consider how high you would have to lift your copy of (Fuller)3 to do the amount of work equivalent to the latent heat of fusion of one cubic centimeter of ice at 0øC. More than 25 meters! LATENT HEAT OF VAPORIZATION Heat required to convert unit mass of material from liquid state to vapor state at the boiling point temperature. Guess how high you would have to lift your copy of (Fuller)3 to do an amount of work equivalent to the amount of energy required to convert one cubic centimeter of hot water at 100øC to steam at 100øC. About 173 meters! That's much higher than the state capitol building in Lincoln, Nebraska (which is about 130 meters tall)! HEAT OF COMBUSTION Energy produced per unit measure of quantity of material for complete oxidation. Which would you rather oxidize, spinach or beef steak? You will get about 20 times more energy from the steak as from an equal mass of spinach. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Temperature; Thermal Expansion; Heat Of Combustion; Absolute Zero; Temperature Scales; Thermal Physics SECTION 10.2 Temperature Absolute zero in Celsius is -273.16øC. In Fahrenheit, absolute zero is -459.69øF. SECTION 10.4 Volumetric Expansion Let us consider a cube of side L0, then its volume is V0 at a temperature T0. Now let us heat the cube to a new temperature DT degrees hotter than T0. Now we calculate the new volume V in terms of the volumetric coefficient of expansion b, V = V0 + DV = V0 +bV0DT = V0(1 +bDT) (1) But we can use the linear measurement to calculate this same volume. V = L3 = (L0 +aL0DT)3 = L03 (1 + aDT)3 = V0 (1 + aDT)3 = V0 (1 + 3aDT + 3a2DT2 +a3DT3) If a is much smaller than 1; then a2 << a; so neglect the a2 and a3 terms: V ÷ V0 (1 + 3aDT) (2) By comparing equations (1) and (2) we see b ÷ 3a SECTION 10.8 Heat of Combustion At this date the cost of butter is about $.80 per pound and gasoline costs about $.65 per gallon. Energy from butter = 716 kcal/100gm x 454 gm/1 lb. x 1 lb./$.80 = 4060 kcal per dollar Energy from gasoline = 1150 kcal/100 gm x 4546 cm3/gallon x 1 gallon/$0.65 x 0.68 gm/1 cm3 = 54700 kcal per dollar Butter costs 13 times as much as gasoline per unit of energy. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Heat; Calorimetry; Anatomy And Physiology; Cardiovascular System; Volume; Pressure In Gases; Latent Heats; Heat Of Combustion; Charles' Law; Boyle's Law; Heat Equivalent; Mechanical Equivalent; Thermal Physics CALORIMETRY 1. A nurse withdraws 50 cc's of blood from the arm of a patient. He wants to keep the sample for a while, so he puts it in a refrigerator and cools the sample to 2øC. How much heat in calories must be removed from the blood to do this? Assume for this problem that 50 cc's of blood has a mass of 52 gm; assume that the specific heat of blood is the same as the specific heat of water; assume that the body temperature of the patient is 98.6øF or 37øC. Be sure to give the correct units. What Data Are Given? Mass of blood = 52 gm; initial temperature of blood = 37øC; final temperature of blood = 2øC, specific heat of blood = 103 calories per kg. What Data Are Implied? None, it is all given. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The basic Calorimetry equation (10.9) is all that is needed. What Equations Are to be Used? DQ = mcDT (10.9) Algebraic Solution Heat Removed = DQ = mcDT Numerical Solution DQ = (52 gm)(1 cal/gm)(2øC - 37ø) = -1.8 x 103 calories Thinking About the Answer The change in heat, DQ, is negative because heat is lost from the system of blood. 2. Heat is required to change ice (solid) to water (liquid) without changing its temperature. In fact, it requires 80 calories of heat to change 1 gram of ice at 0øC to 1 gm of water at 0øC. Furthermore, heat is required to change water (liquid) to steam (gas) without changing its temperature. In fact, under standard conditions it requires 540 calories of heat to change 1 gm. of water at 100øC to 1 gm. of steam at 100øC. (a) How much total heat is required to warm and convert a 1 gm piece of ice at 0øC to steam at 100øC under standard conditions? (b) What percentage of the total heat is used to change the 100øC water to 100øC steam? What Data Are Given? 1 gram of ice exists at 0øC. What Data Are Implied? During the heating process, no heat will be lost from the ice - water - steam system to its surroundings. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The basic concepts of Calorimetry (Equation 10.9) and changes in state (Section 10.7) are needed. What Equations Are to be Used? Heating the water = DQ = mcDT (10.9) Melting the ice = DQf = Lfm (3) Vaporizing the water = DQv = Lvm (4) Algebraic Solution (a) total heat = DQf + DQ +DQv = mLf + mLDT + mLv (5) (b) percentage for vaporization = mLv/total heat (6) Numerical Solutions (a) Qtotal = (1)(80) + (1)(1)(100 - 0) + (1)(540) = 720 calories (b) Percentage = 540/720 = 75% Thinking About the Answer Notice how much energy is required to convert the liquid water to the gaseous water, 75% of all the energy! 3. About how many hamburgers would a 91 kg (200 lb) man have to eat to enable him to climb to the top of the Nebraska capitol building, about 131 meters high? An average hamburger has a fuel value of about 250 kilocalories. The human body has a 10% efficiency; i.e., 90% of the fuel value of food is used to maintain the body, only 10% is available for work. What Data Are Given? Mass = 91 kg; height to be lifted = 131 meters, efficiency = 10%, heat of combustion = 250 kcal/hamburger. What Data Are Implied? The energy intake must be 10 times the amount used because the useful work is only 1/10 of the total energy input. Assume g = 9.8 m/s2. It is assumed that the total fuel value of the hamburgers is used by the human body. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The mechanical equivalent of heat is what is needed for this problem. The potential energy needed or the work done, to climb to the top of the Nebraska capitol building. What Equations Are to be Used? Work done in climbing = DP.E. = mgh Number of hamburgers = work done in kilocalories / (efficiency)250kcal/hamburger Algebraic Solution N = W = mgh [W(1 kcal/4186 J)/250 kcal/lb.]/(efficiency) Numerical Solution W = (91 kg)(9.8 m/s2)(131 m) = 1.2 x 105 J W = 28 kcal Energy needed = W/efficiency = 28/.1 = 280 kcal. N = 280 kcal / 250 kcal/lb. = 1.1 hamburgers. During his climb up to the top he would use up about the energy of one hamburger for climbing and for maintaining his body conditions. Thinking About the Answer If you assume his other food is used to maintain his body conditions and he ate an extra hamburger, in order to keep from gaining weight he would have had to climb to the top of the capitol building 9 times. This shows why dieting rather than exercise is the easiest way to maintain, or reduce, body weight. GAS LAWS 4. A weather balloon contains 280 m3 of helium gas at sea level where the atmospheric pressure is 1.01 x 105 N/m2 and the temperature is 27øC. Calculate the volume of the balloon when it reaches an altitude of 16 km where the pressure is 1.00 x 104 N/m2 and the temperature is -55øC. What Data Are Given? V1 = 280 m3; P1 = 1.01 x 10 5 N/m2; T1 = 27øC or 300øK; P2 = 1.00 x 104 N/m2, and T2 = -55øC or 218øK. What Data Are Implied? That the balloon skin applies no extra pressure to the gas on the inside of the balloon, so the gas laws can be applied directly using the given data. It is assumed helium is an ideal gas. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The combined laws of Boyle's and Charles' for ideal gases can be used. What Equations Are to be Used? P1V1/T1 = P2V2/T2 (10.15) Algebraic Solution V2 = (T2/T1)(P2/P1) V1 Numerical Solution V2 = (218øK/300øK) x (1.01 x 105/1.00 x 104) (280 m3) V2 = 2060 m3 Thinking About the Answer The effect of the greatly reduced pressure to allow the balloon to expand is much more important than the reduced temperature that causes the gas in the balloon to have a reduced volume. The reason for this, of course, is the fact that absolute zero is many degrees below the range of temperatures occurring in this problem. Suppose absolute zero were only -60øC instead of -273øC. How would the results of this problem be changed? See Fig. SPECIAL PRACTICE PROBLEM FOR FUN 4. A well-known secret fact about Robinson Crusoe is that he was an amateur entomologist. While shipwrecked on his island every day at noon (sun directly overhead) he counted the number of ants coming out of the largest anthill in about one minute (70 beats of his heart). He noticed that on hot days the ants were more active than on cold days, so he constructed his own Robinson Crusoe temperature scale. He assumed there was a linear relationship between the number of ants he counted and the temperature. He made his own simple temperature scale, zero ants was 0øRC and 100 ants was 100øRC. After he was rescued he desired to calibrate his ant hill from known meteorological data and to fill in the missing numbers in his daily log. Fill in the missing numbers in the table below: Meteorological Data for the temperature of his island at noon. See Fig. ANSWERS: The relationship between the two temperature scales is given by T(RC) = 2.5 T(øF) - 150. So 86øF = 65øRC; 92øF = 80øRC; 72øF = 30øRC. Do you think this is a creepy problem? PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Problems; Answers; Evaluations; ; Temperature; Thermal Physics; Temperature Scales; Fahrenheit Scale; Celsius Scale; Pressure In Gases; Heat; Thermal Expansion; Charles' Law; Boyle's Law; Calorimetry 1. Find the Celsius temperatures corresponding to the following common Fahrenheit temperatures. a. Room temperature (68øF) b. Human body temperature (98.6øF) c. Cold winter temperature (-4øF) d. Ice melts (32øF) e. Water boils (212øF) 2. An automobile tire at 32øF has a gauge pressure of 24 lb/in 2 (then its absolute pressure is 2.6 x 105 N/m2). Immediately after running at high speed on the interstate highway, the tire pressure is measured to be 32 lb/in2 (its absolute pressure is 3.2 x 105 N/m2). What is the temperature of the tire, assuming the volume of the tire remained constant? 3. On a hot summer day (40øC) a physics student fills the 72 liter gasoline tank of her car with cool gasoline (10øC) from a self-service pump. Why will the gasoline overflow the tank? How much gasoline will flow out of the tank? (Coefficient of volumetric expansion of gasoline = 0.90 x 10-3/øC) 4. A 5 kilogram lead sphere falls from a 100 meter high building and lands on a hard concrete sidewalk. If all the heat energy created at impact is assumed to be retained by the sphere, answer the following questions. ________a. How much heat is generated at the impact? ________b. What is the final temperature of the lead if its initial temperature was 22øC? (Specific heat of lead = .13 J/gmøC). ANSWERS: 1a. 20øC b. 37øC c. -20øC d. 0øC e. 100øC 2. 60øC 3. Increase in the temperature of the gasoline causes volumetric expansion; 1.9 liters 4a. 5,000 J b. 29.7øC Chapter Thermal Transport (11): GOALS Keywords: ; Thermal Physics; Learning Objectives; Thermal Transport; Conduction; Convection; Radiation; Heat When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define the following terms, and use them in an operational definition: conduction radiation convection Energy Transfer Problems Solve numerical problems that involve a transfer of energy, temperature gradients, and conduction, convection, or radiation. Living System Thermal Properties Explain basic thermal effects in living systems. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter, you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 9, Transport Phenomena, and Chapter 10, Temperature and Heat. OVERVIEW Keywords: Learning Objectives; ; Heat; Thermal Physics; Thermal Transport From Chapter Nine you should recall that three Transport Phenomena were highlighted. In this chapter, the flow or transport of heat is considered in greater detail. Please note that the chapter deals with three major forms of Thermal Transport: Conduction (Section 11.2), Convection (Section 11.3), and Radiation (Section 11.4). SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE To begin your study of this chapter, please read all the Chapter Goals: Definitions, Energy Transfer Problems, and Living System Thermal Properties. For an expanded treatment of each of the terms listed under Definitions, turn to the next section of this chapter. Next, read text sections 11.1-11.5. Even though the algebra becomes involved in example 2 in section 11.2, try to go through the problem as you may find the result surprising. As you read the text sections, consider the questions asked. The answers to these questions are answered in this chapter. Now read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-9 and do Algorithmic Problems 1-4. Next, complete Exercises and Problems 1, 4, 6, 7, and 10. Additional examples of the major concepts presented in this chapter are found in the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test in the at the end of this chapter. Check your answers. If you have difficulties, please refer to the specific section of this chapter again. This study procedure is outlined below. -----------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ----------------Definitions 11.1, 11.2, 11.3 1-5 4, 6, 10 11.4 Transfer 11.2, 11.3, 11.4 6 1-4 1, 7 Problems Living System 11.5 7-9 Thermal Properties DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Conduction; Radiation; Convection; Thermal Physics; Thermal Transport; Heat CONDUCTION Transfer of thermal energy by the interaction of neighboring portions of a substance at rest. Conduction is a most effective transfer mechanism in solids, particularly in metals. CONVECTION Transfer of thermal energy by the motion of matter as in liquids and gases. Convection arises because of the different densities of warm and cool fluids which cause buoyant forces in the earth's gravitational field. In the weightless environment of space, convection ceases to be an energy transfer mechanism. RADIATION Transfer of energy by electromagnetic fields. Microwave cooking is a most recent example of using radiation to heat objects. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Microwaves; Answers; Applications; SECTION 11.6 Microwave Cooking The explanation of microwave cooking taken from the cookbook of the Litton Systems may seem more vivid but it certainly carries some wrong implications. Food does not "attract" microwaves anymore than you would say that sunglasses attract light. Sunglasses absorb light that would otherwise strike your eyes. Foods, especially fats and sugars, absorb the microwaves that pass through other materials. The absorption process leads to the transformation of microwave, electromagnetic energy into thermal energy. The Consumer Reports description is more in accord with our present day scientific model to explain these phenomena. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Thermal Physics; Thermal Transport; Conduction; Thermal Conductivity; Arithmetic; Convection; Radiation; Stefan-Boltzmann Law; Cooling; Heat ENERGY TRANSFER PROBLEMS 1. The wooden handle of a frying pan has an area of 10 cm2 and is 15 cm long. If the pan is at 120øC and the free end of the handle is at 30øC, how much heat will flow through the handle in 10 minutes? (Kwood = 0.15 Wm-1 deg-1) What Data Are Given? The area of the handle, the high and low temperatures, the distance between those two temperatures, the time, and the thermal conductivity of the material. What Data Are Implied? It is assumed that no heat escapes from the handle out the sides, but that heat only flows along the handle. The problem can be treated as a one-dimensional problem. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The concepts of thermal conduction are needed. What Equations Are to be Used? We can make use of the one dimensional thermal conductivity equation 11.2 H = -KA (DT/DX) (11.2) Algebraic Solution H = -KA (DT/DX) where H is in joules/second Heat flow in 10 minutes = 600 H Numerical Solution Heat Flow in 10 minutes = 600 sec. x (-0.15/m ¥ deg)(J/sec) x (10 x 10-4m2) x [(30 120)øC/0.15 m] = 600 (-.15)(10-3) (-90/.15) joules = 54 J Thinking About the Answer Notice that the units for the answer, joules, are correct. 2. In a room of temperature 20øC, two identical open pans, one containing ice water, the other boiling water, are placed in front of an air-circulating fan. If the pans contain equal amounts of water, compute the ratio of the initial rates of their temperature changes. Is the ratio a positive or negative number? What Data Are Given? The temperature of the room in a situation of forced air convection. What Data Are Implied? The two pans are assumed to be in identical situations with respect to the forced air circulation. The only difference between the two pans is their initial starting temperatures. One pan has a temperature 0øC. The other pan has a temperature of 100øC. What Physics Principles Are Involved? This problem can be solved using Newton's law of cooling; i.e., the rate of change of temperature of an object is proportional to the difference between the temperature of the object and its surroundings. What Equations Are to be Used? The heat capacity equation, Q = mcDT, (Equation 10.9). The forced convection equation, rate of thermal energy flow = H = -K1 (Ts - Ta) (11.6) Algebraic Solution Let Tc be initial temperature of the cold water Let Th be initial temperature of the hot water for cold water Hc = -K1 (Tc - Ta) for hot water Hh = -K1 (Th - Ta). The rate of heat flow of an object is related to the temperature change of an object by Equation 10.9 D0 = mc DT, but H =DQ/Dtime. so: H = DQ/Dt = mcDT/Dt Since the masses and specific heat of the two systems of water are equal, then DTc/Dt = -K1 (Tc - Ta) andDTh/Dt = -K1 (Th - Ta) The ratio of the initial rates of temperature change are given by (DTc/Dt) / (DTh/Dt) = (Tc - Th) / (Th - Ta) Numerical Solution (DTc/Dt) / (DTh/Dt) = (0ø - 20ø)C / (100ø - 20ø)C = -20/80 = -1/4 The ratio is a negative number because one container is warming up so its DT/Dt is positive and the other container is cooling down so its DT/ Dt is negative. Hence the ratio is negative. Thinking About the Answer Notice that the answer for this question is a pure number with no units because it is a ratio of similar quantities. It is always a negative number. For the case given the hot water is cooling down four times as fast as the cold water is heating up. 3. In a cryogenics (low temperature) experiment the temperature of the sample is decreased from liquid helium temperatures (4øK) to 1øK. How much is the rate of heat loss by radiation decreased? What Data Are Given? The absolute temperature of the sample is given. What Data Are Implied? Any heat radiated to the samples from the environment is neglected. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The Stefan-Boltzmann equation for radiation. What Equations Are to be Used? Rate of energy radiated = P = sAT4 (11.8) Algebraic Solution Ti = initial temperature; Tf = final temperature Pf/Pi = Tf4/Ti4 = (Tf/Ti)4 (2) Numerical Solution Pf/Pi = (1øK/4øK)4 = 1/256 = 3.9 x 10-3 Thinking About the Answer You can notice that even though the temperature is only changed 3ø, there is a large change in the amount of energy lost by radiation. 4. Suppose you double the absolute temperature of an object. How much will the three types of heat transfer change? (Hint: Assume the ambient room temperature is one-half the original temperature of the object.) What Data Are Given? The initial temperature of the object is Tc. The initial ambient temperature is T0/2. The final temperature of the object is 2T0. What Data Are Implied? The situation is such that all of the first order heat transfer equations are valid, Equations (11.2), (11.6), and (11.8). What Physics Principles Are Involved? The basic concepts of conduction, convection, and radiation are needed. What Equations Are to be Used? Conduction H = -KA DT/DX (11.2) Convection H = -K1(Ts - Ta) (11.6) Radiation P = sAT4 (11.8) Algebraic Solution Let Ti = initial temperature, Tf = final conduction temperature, and Ta = ambient temp. Conduction: Hi a (Ti - Ta) / Dx and Hf a (Tf - Ta) / Dx so ratio Hf/Hi = (Tf - Ta) / (Ti - Ta) (3) Convection: Hi a (Ti - Tu) and Hf a (Tf - Ta) ratio Hf/Hi = (Tf - Ta) / (Ti - Ta) (4) Radiation: Pi a Ti4 - Ta4; i.e., heat lost by the object goes at T4, but heat received from the environment goes at Ta4, so the net rate of radiated energy is the difference in the fourth power of the temperatures. Pf a Tf4 - Ta4 ratio Pf/Pi = (Tf4 - Ta4) / (Ti4 - Ta4) (5) Numerical Solutions Conduction Hf/Hi = (2T0 - T0/2) / (T0 - T0/2) = (3/2)/(1/2) = 3 Convection Hf/Hi = (2T0 - T0/2) / (T0 - T0/2) = (3/2)/(1/2) = 3 Radiation Pf/Pi = [(2T0)4 - (T0/2)4] / [T04 - (T0/2)4] = (255/16)/(15/16) = 15.9 Thinking About the Answer Once again you see the strong temperature dependence of radiation as a form of energy transfer. See Fig. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Thermal Physics; Questions; Answers; Heat; Convection; Conduction; Radiation; Anatomy And Physiology; Thermal Transport 1. A hot cup of black coffee sits in a cool room in a black coffee cup. a. Name and describe the thermal processes which are actively involved in the transfer of heat from the cup to the room. b. Explain how the coffee, the cup, or the room environment could be altered to reduce the thermal transport by each of the processes named in Part A. 2. A modern home is insulated with 15.2 cm (6 inches) of glass wool (K = .042). How many cm thick must a brick wall be constructed (K = .147) to achieve the same insulating factor? 3. The human body has an intricate set of regulating systems which act together to keep the core of the body at a constant temperature of 37ø C. a. What is the typical temperature of the body at the skin's surface? Does the temperature vary over the skin's surface? (If it does, give an example showing the magnitude of the variation.) b. The major core regulating process is by "forced convection". Explain briefly how this process works. ANSWERS: 1. Convection (to room air), conduction (to room air and to table), radiation (to each object in the room which is lower in temperature and to the walls, ceiling, and floor). To change; convection (reduce air currents), conduction (insulate cup), radiation (change color of cup and/or coffee or room walls as increase temperature of room walls. 2. 53.2 cm 3. 33øC, Yes, about 3øC less at exposed extremities: vasodilation regulates the flow of blood and therefore the direction of heat flow (see section 11.5). Chapter Thermodynamics (12): STUDY GUIDE Citation: H. Q Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications. (Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors. 12 Thermodynamics GOALS Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Thermal Physics; Heat Pumps; Thermodynamics; Heat Engines; Carnot Cycle; Efficiency; Thermodynamic Processes; Adiabatic Processes; Isobaric Processes; Isothermal Processes; Isochoric Processes; PV Diagrams; The Laws Of Thermodynamics When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: PV diagram efficiency of a heat engine isochoric process Carnot cycle isobaric process refrigerator isothermal process coefficient of performance adiabatic process of a refrigerator heat engine Laws of Thermodynamics State three laws of thermodynamics, and explain the operation of a physical system in terms of these laws. Thermodynamics Problems Solve problems consistent with the laws of thermodynamics. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 5, Energy, and Chapter 10, Temperature and Heat. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Thermal Physics; Thermodynamics The problem of converting heat energy into useful work energy is an important consideration for an industrial society. The Three Laws of Thermodynamics stated in this chapter express our understanding of how thermal processes operate. As you look over this chapter, please note the importance of the idea of system and the idealized processes by which a system can be changed. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE As you begin your study of this chapter, carefully read the three Chapter Goals: Definitions, Laws of Thermodynamics, and Thermodynamic Problems. If you need additional assistance with any of the terms listed under Definitions, refer to the next section of this chapter. Next, read chapter sections 12.1-12.11. Be sure to read the examples given at the end of most of these text sections. Answers to most questions posed during your reading are discussed in the second section of this chapter. Now read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-7. Then do Algorithmic Problems 1-5. Now complete Exercises and Problems 1, 3, 5, 6, 11, 12, 17, 19, and 21. For additional work, see the Examples section of this . Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulty with any of the concepts, check the appropriate section of the text for further help. ---------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ---------------------Definitions 12.1,12.2,12.7, 1,2,3 12.8 4,5 Laws of 12.4,12.9 6 Thermodynamics Thermodynamics 12.3,12.5,12.6, 7 1,2,3,4, 1,3,6,11, Problems 12.10,12.11 5 12,17,19, 21 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Thermal Physics; Heat Pumps; Thermodynamics; Heat Engines; Carnot Cycle; Efficiency; Thermodynamic Processes; Adiabatic Processes; Isobaric Processes; Isothermal Processes; Isochoric Processes; PV Diagrams; The Laws Of Thermodynamics P-V DIAGRAM Graphical representation of a process using pressure-volume axes. See Fig. The work done during a process is shown as the area under the curve. ISOCHORIC PROCESS Takes place at constant volume. After hot foods are sealed in glass containers during canning, the cooling of a constant volume of material helps to seal the can shut. ISOBARIC PROCESS Takes place at constant pressure. The expansion of a heated gas in a flexible container open to the atmosphere illustrates this process. ISOTHERMAL PROCESS Takes place at constant temperature. The slow compression of a gas can occur at constant temperature. ADIABATIC PROCESS A process that takes place with no change in thermal energy in the system. When we make a rapid change in the pressure of the air in a bicycle tire, we can think of it as an adiabatic process. HEAT ENGINE Absorbs a quantity of energy from higher temperature reservoir, does work, and rejects a quantity of energy to lower temperature reservoir, and returns to its original state. An automobile engine is a heat engine. It makes use of the thermodynamic properties of combustion and gases to convert the chemical energy of gasoline into the kinetic energy of the automobile. EFFICIENCY OF HEAT ENGINE Ratio of useful work output divided by energy input. If we can improve the efficiency of our automobile engines we can save many gallons of gasoline. CARNOT CYCLE Cycle of an ideal engine which includes an isothermal expansion at higher temperature, an adiabatic expansion, an isothermal compression at lower temperature, and an adiabatic compression. REFRIGERATOR A heat engine that operates by the input of work when energy is extracted from a lower temperature reservoir and transferred to a higher temperature reservoir. COEFFICIENT OF PERFORMANCE OF A REFRIGERATOR Ratio of heat absorbed to the amount of work supplied to the refrigerator. EXAMPLES Keywords: PV Diagram; Isochoric Process; Isothermal Process; Isobaric Process; Worked Examples; The First Law Of Thermodynamics; Ideal Gas Law; Arithmetic; Thermal Physics; Thermodynamics; Thermodynamic Processes; Work; Internal Energy THERMODYNAMIC PROBLEMS 1. A container sealed by a moveable piston holds 0.908 moles of an ideal gas. The gas is originally at a pressure of 1.01 x 105 N/m 2, a temperature of 300øK and a volume of 22.4 liters. The gas was heated at constant volume until the temperature reached 750øK. Then the gas was allowed to expand isothermal until it reached its original pressure. Then the gas was compressed isobarically back to its original state. Draw a P-V diagram for the three processes. Calculate the pressure, volume, and temperature of the gas at the end of each process. Calculate the work done, the change in internal energy and the amount of heat added to or subtracted from the system during each of the processes. What is the efficiency of this cycle of three processes? What Data Are Given? The initial conditions for the 0.908 moles of gas are given: P1 = 1.01 x 105 N/m2; V1 = 22.4 x 103 cm3 = 2.24 x 10-2 m3; T1 = 300øK. The highest temperature T 2 = 750øK = T3. The three processes between the initial state, the second state, the third state, and the return to the initial state are all given. What Data Are Implied? The fact that the confined gas is an ideal gas allows us to use equation (12.6), (12.8), and (12.12) to calculate properties of a system where Cv = 3/2 R; Cp = 5/2 R. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The first law of thermodynamics can be used in conjunction with the ideal gas laws to solve this problem. What Equations Are to be Used? Process 1 = isochoric compression P2 = (P1T2)/T1 (10.15) DU = DQ = ncvDT (12.6) Process 2 - isothermal expansion P3 = (P2V2)/V3 (10.15) DQ = DW = PDV = P2V2ln (V3/V2) (12.12) Process 3 - isobaric compression V1 = (P3V3T1)/(P1T3) (10.15) DQ = ncpDT (12.8) DU = ncvDT (12.6) Algebraic Solution See Fig. (a) The P-V diagram - let T2 be given as some constant times T1, T2 = kT1; then P2 = kP1; V2 = V1 Then T3 = T2; but P3 = P1; so V3 = kV1. DQ12 = ncv (T2 - T1); DQ23 = P2V2 ln (V3/V2) DQ31 = ncp (T1 - T3) DU12 = DQ12 DU23 = 0 DU31 = ncv (T1 - T3) efficiency = (DW23 +DW31) / DW23 Numerical Solution P2 = (1.01 x 105 N/m2) (750øK/300øK) = 2.53 x 105 N/m2 V2 = V1 = 2.24 x 10-2 m3 V3 = 5.60 x 10-2 m3 DQ12 = (0.908 mole)(3/2)(8.31 J/mole øK) x (750øK - 300øK) = 5.09 x 103 J DW23 = DQ23 = (2.53 x 105 N/m2)(2.24 x 10-2m3) x ln (5.60 x 10-2)/(2.24 x 10-3) = 5.19 x 103 J DQ31 = (0.908 moles)(5/2)(8.31 J/moleøK) x (300 - 750)øK = -8.49 x 103 J DU31 = (0.908 moles)(3/2)(8.31 J/mole øK)(300 - 750)øK = -5.09 x 103 J DW31 = P1(V1 - V3) = (1.05 x 105 N/m2)(2.24 x 10-2 m3 - 5.60 x 10-2m3) DW31 = -3.40 x 103 J Efficiency = (5.19 x 103 - 3.40 x 103) J/ (5.19 x 103 J) = 34.0% The French cyclist, Sadi Carnot, In a race against a Peugeot Whose driver Michael Smashed his cycle Which lives on in spite of the blow... See Fig. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Problems; Answers; Evaluations; Thermal Physics; Thermodynamics; Carnot Cycle; Heat Engines; Isochoric Processes; Isobaric Processes; Isothermal Processes; Thermodynamic Processes; The First Law Of Thermodynamics; The Second Law Of Thermodynamics; The Laws Of Thermodynamics; Questions; Internal Energy; Work 1. A Carnot engine operates between two temperatures of 600ø and 300øC. a. Calculate this engine's efficiency. b. If the engine absorbs 1000 Joules of heat energy at the higher temperature, how much heat is exhausted at the lower temperature? c. How much mechanical work is produced by the engine per cycle? 2. A heat engine is operated through the cycle process AçBçCçDçA as illustrated below. See Fig.. a. Identify each process as isochoric, isobaric, or isothermal BçC CçD DçA b. Calculate the work done by the system during each cycle and give the net work done per cycle. WAçB = Joules WBçC = Joules WCçD = Joules WDçA = Joules Net work done = Joules (per cycle) c. If 60 x 105 Joules of heat energy are absorbed during the thermal process A-B, what internal energy change occurs during this process? 3. Is it possible to cool a kitchen during the summer by leaving the door of the refrigerator open? Defend your answer using the Laws of Thermodynamics. ANSWERS: 1. a. 34 b. 660 c. 340 2. a. isochoric, isobaric, isochoric b. 1.05 x 106, zero, -3 x 105, zero, +7.5 x 105 c. 49.5 x 105 Joules 3. No, the heat produced in running the electric motor for cooling exceeds the heat removed from the air inside the refrigerator compartments. This arrangement would be possible only if the system was vented to allow for pumping the heat to the outside. The first law predicts that this is true; the kitchen system has energy added in the form of electrical energy. Thus, when converted to heat, the overall effect is to raise temperature. The second law also predicts the temperature increase; for any system, the entropy either increases or stays constant. Thus, another system (i.e., outdoors) must be involved to cool (or lower the entropy) one system. Chapter Elastic Properties of Materials (13): to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications: 13 Elastic Properties of Materials GOALS Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Mechanics; Elasticity; Young's Modulus; Bulk Modulus; Stress; Strain; Shear Modulus; Pressure In Solids When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: elastic body Young's modulus stress bulk modulus strain modulus of rigidity elastic limit Hooke's Law State Hooke's law. Stress and Strain Calculate the strain and stress for various types of deformation. Elasticity Problems Solve problems involving the elastic coefficients. PREREQUISITES Before you begin this chapter, you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 4, Forces and Newton's Law, Chapter 5, Energy, and Chapter 8, Fluid Flow. OVERVIEW Keywords: Elasticity; Mechanics; ; Instructions This is a short but important chapter concerning the reaction of materials to deforming forces. The recognized method for reporting these results for various materials is a number called Modulus, which is simply the ratio of stress to strain. Thus Young's Modulus, the Modulus of Rigidity, and the Bulk Modulus rate a material's reaction to forces producing elongation, change in volume, or sheer distortion respectively. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Before you begin to study this chapter, be familiar with theChapter Goals: Definitions, Hooke's Law, Stress and Strain, and Elasticity Problems. An expanded discussion of each of the terms listed under theDefinitions goal can be found in the Definitions section of this chapter. Next, read text sections 13.1-13.5, and consider the Example problems discussed. Please note the three major measures of elastic properties of matter outlined in table 13.1 on page 297. These are Young's Modulus, the Modulus of Rigidity and the Bulk Modulus. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-11. Check your answers against those given on page 301. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1-5 and do Exercises and Problems 1, 2, 5 and 6. For additional work, turn to the Examples section of this chapter and complete each problem. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test found at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulty with any of the answers, please refer to the appropriate text section for additional assistance. -----------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ----------------Definitions 13.1,13.2 1-9 Hooke's Law 13.3 3 Stress and Strain 13.4,13.5 1,2,4 Elasticity Problems 13.4,13.5 10,11 5 1,2,5,6 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Mechanics; Elasticity; Stress; Strains; Young's Modulus; Bulk Modulus; Pressure In Solids; Shear Modulus ELASTIC BODY Any material or body which is deformed by an applied force and returns to its original shape after the distorting force is removed. We often think of elastic materials as the ones most easily distorted from the original shape, such as rubber bands. In physics, a high elastic material requires a large force to produce a distortion. This notion is contrary to the common use of the word. STRESS Ratio of the applied force to the area. This is the force applied to change the shape of an object. STRAIN Ratio of change in a given physical dimension to the original dimension; i.e., change in length to original length, or change in volume to original volume. This is the measure of the changes in shape of an object acted upon by a stress. ELASTIC LIMIT Limit of distortion for which deformed body returns to original shape after deforming force is removed. Many students have their lives so stretched by college that they cannot return to their original life. Have they exceeded their elastic limit? YOUNG'S MODULUS Elastic constant of proportionality for a linear deformation. For most solids this is a large number ~1010 N/m2. To stretch most solids by even 1% we would need to apply a pressure of about 1000 times the pressure of the atmosphere. BULK MODULUS Elastic constant of proportionality for a deformation of volume. This can be measured by squeezing an object in a hydrostatic press and measuring its change in volume. MODULUS OF RIGIDITY Elastic constant of proportionality for a shear deformation. Some materials, such as graphite, shear much more easily in one direction than in others. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Elasticity; Mechanics; Hooke's Law; Bulk Modulus; Elastic Potential Energy; Shear Modulus; Mechanics; Elasticity ELASTICITY PROBLEMS 1. A measuring device is able to apply a force of 1.0 x 10 5 N. A student wishes to use the device to study the elastic properties of a 1 cm cube of steel. What is the student likely to find? What Data Are Given? The applied force = 1.0 x 105 N. The material being studied is steel whose elastic coefficients are given in Table 13.1. What Data Are Implied? It is assumed that the applied force is not too great so as to exceed the elastic limit of the steel sample. What Physics Principles Are Involved? We can make use of the basic definitions of the linear, bulk, and shear deformations. Then we can predict what will happen in each case. What Equations Are to be Used? Linear deformation DL/L = (l/Y) (F/A) (13.1) Bulk deformation DV/V = (-l/B)P (13.7) Shear deformation f = (l/n)(F/A) (13.8) Algebraic Solutions These are all given above, since we wish to predict the kinds of deformations that will occur in each case. Numerical Solutions 1. Suppose the student applies the 1.0 x 105 N force across the ends of the cube to stretch it. Then its length will be changed DL/L = (l/Y)(F/A) = (m2/ (10.0 x 1010 N)) x ((1.0 x 105 N)/(1 x 10-4 m2)) DL/L = 5.0 x 10-3. The new length = 1.005 cm. 2) Suppose the student uses the device to apply a 1.0 x 10 5 N force to each of the six faces of the cube; then the volume of the cube will be decreased. DV/V = (-l/B)P = ((-1)m2)/(16.0 x 1010N) = (1.0 x 105 N)/10-4m2 DV/V = -6.3 x 10-3; new volume = 9.937 x 10-7 m3 3) Suppose the student uses the device to apply a 1.0 x 10 5 N force tangent to the top of the cube while holding the bottom fixed, then the cube will be deformed by an angle f where f = ((1 m2)/(8.0 x 1010 N)) x ((1.0 x 105 N)/(1 x 10-4 m2)) = 1.25 x 10-2 radians f = 0.72ø; so the sides of the cubes are inclined 0.72ø from vertical. Thinking About the Answers For which case is the elastic energy the greatest? In each case Hooke's Law is obeyed so the energy is of the form E = 1/2 kDx2 but Dx = F/k so E = 1/2 F2/k; The energy is inversely proportional to the elastic constant for a constant force, so the most elastic energy is stored in the shear case (3) above. From where does the extra energy come? See Fig. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Questions; Problems; Evaluations; Answers; Young's Modulus; Stress; Strain; Bulk Modulus; Elasticity; Mechanics; Pressure In Solids 1. Which of the three elastic moduli (Young's, Bulk, or Rigidity) are most important in each of the case below? a. A front car tire is deformed as the car rounds a turn on a flat dry road. b. In the use of a bicycle pump, a cyclist forces down on the pump handle to force the air into the flat tire. c. A workman uses a screwdriver to tighten a screw. (Consider your answer for the steel shaft of the screwdriver.) d. A rubber band is stretched to fit around a pile of loose papers. 2. Design an experiment for finding the elasticity constant for a rubber band. What equipment is needed? What measurements must be made? What results do you anticipate? 3. In an experimental test, the following data was collected for stretching a rubber "tiedown" strap: cross-sectional area, A = 5.3 cm2 length, L = 75 cm elongating force, F = 10 Newtons length increase, Dx = 4 cm a. Calculate the stress b. Calculate the strain c. Find a value for Young's Modulus for rubber. ANSWERS 1. Rigidity, Bulk, Rigidity, Young's 2. Your experiment should include known weights to be used to stretch the band. As the band stretches as each weight is added, the length of stretch should be measured. The elasticity constant in the ratio of weight to length of stretch. The results should give a constant K until the band is stretched to near its limits of elasticity. 3. Stress = 1.9 x 104 N/m2, strain = .05, Young's Modulus = 3.8 x 105 N/m2 Chapter Molecular Model of Matter (14): 14 Molecular Model of Matter Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Fluids; Fluid Statics; Surface Tension; Capillarity; Cohesion; Adhesion; Osmosis; Fluid Motion; RMS Velocity; Gases; Macroscopic Description Of Ideal Gases; Properties Of Fluids; Molecular Model Of Matter GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: rms velocity surface tension adhesion capillarity cohesion osmosis Molecular Model Explain the properties of fluids using the molecular model. Problems Solve problems that relate the gas laws to the properties of the gas and that involve surface tension, capilarity, and osmosis. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 4, Forces and Newton's Laws, Chapter 5, Energy, Chapter 6, Momentum and Impulse, Chapter 10, Temperature and Heat, and Chapter 13, Elastic Properties of Materials OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Fluids; Molecular Model Of Matter Molecules are extremely small. Only the very largest molecules have been photographed and only with indirect methods using an electron microscope. The model scientists use to describe molecules and their movements and interactions is only an ideal representation. However, this model helps us gain an understanding for phenomena we can observe for a large number of molecules acting together. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Begin this chapter by reading the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Molecular Model, and Problems. For additional discussion of the terms listed under the goal of Definitions, turn to theDefinitions section of this chapter. Now, continue by reading text sections 14.1-14.11. In section 14.3 you may have difficulties following all the assumptions and mathematical steps. Even though this may be the case, pay close attention to the results as expressed by equations (14.14), (14.15), and (14.18). The example on page 312 will help clarify the use of the results derived in this section. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-13. Check your answers carefully against those provided. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1-8 again checking your answers with those provided. Now do Exercises and Problems 1, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, and 12. For additional work on the contents of this chapter, see the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Molecular Model of Matter provided at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulties with any of the concepts involved, please refer to the appropriate section of the text or this for more assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. ------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ------------------Definitions 14.1,14.6,14.7 1-6 14.11 Molecular Model 14.2,14.3,14.4, 7 14.5 Problems 14.8,14.9,14.10 8-13 1-8 1,4,5,6, 9,10,12 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Fluids; Fluid Statics; Adhesion; Cohesion; Surface Tension; Capillarity; Osmosis; Fluid Motion; RMS Velocity ROOT MEAN SQUARE VELOCITY The square root of the sum of the squares of the velocities divided by the number of the particles. If we have two particles, one with a velocity of -20 m/s and the other with +20 m/s, their mean velocity is zero; their rms is +20 m/s. If we have two particles, one with velocity +50 m/s, the other with a velocity of +100 m/s; their mean velocity is +75m/s; their rms velocity is 56 m/s. ADHESION Attraction of unlike molecules. The new epoxy cements have brought a whole era of adhesives for daily use. COHESION Attraction of like molecules. Cohesive forces in solids are stronger than cohesive forces in liquids. SURFACE TENSION Force necessary to break a unit length of surface. Have you ever seen a water spider "skate" along on the surface of a pond? CAPILLARITY The rise of water in a capillary above the water level in the surrounding area. This arises when a liquid adheres to the walls of a narrow tube. OSMOSIS Motion of fluid through a semipermeable membrane until the potential energy on the two sides of the membrane is the same. Osmosis is extremely common in biological systems. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Momentum; Kinetic Theory; Pressure In Gases; Microscopic Description Of Ideal Gases; Ideal Gas Law; Avogadro's Number; Boltzmann Constant; Molecular Model Of Gases; Algebra KINETIC THEORY OF GASES 1. Assume that all the molecules in a gas are travelling in the x direction (1/2 of the molecules are headed in the plus x direction and 1/2 of the molecules are headed in the minus x direction). Assume that all the molecules have the same magnitude of velocity, v, and that n molecules strike a wall of area A in a time t. (a) From what volume do the molecules come that reach the area A of the wall in time t? (Sketch this volume on the figure below.) See fig. (b) Assume that all n molecules strike the wall head-on, are perfectly elastic, and rebound with a velocity v in the opposite (or - x) direction. What is the impulse imparted to the wall? (mass of each molecule = m) (c) What is the pressure on the wall? (d) In part (a) above, what is the number of molecules per unit volume that produce the bombardment of the wall? (e) In a closed container which has a volume V and contains a total of N molecules the number of molecules per unit volume is N/V. Make the correct substitution into your answer of part (c) and find an expression for the pressure of a gas in terms of N and V as well as m and v. What Data Are Given? Ther are n molecules of mass m travelling with velocity v in the positive x direction that strike an area A of the wall perpendicular to the x-axis in a time of t. What Data Are Implied? The molecules are perfectly elastic and obey the laws of classical physics during the motion and collisions. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The fundamental laws of motion and collisions will be needed. What Equations Are to be Used? distance = velocity ¥ time impulse = change in momentum = force ¥ time pressure = force / area Algebraic Solution (a) In a time t, the molecules moving with a velocity v will travel a distance of vt. So the n molecules that hit the wall in time t had to be within a distance vt of the wall. (b) For each molecule p = -mv = (mv) = -2mv Impulse of wall on molecule = -2mv Impulse of a molecule on wall = +2mv Total impulse on the wall = n(2mv) = 2nmv (c) Pressure = force / area = (Impulse/time) / area = (2nmv) / (At) (d) Number per unit volume = number / volume = (rn) / (Avt) = rn then pressure = 2rnmv2 (1) (e) In a closed container only 1/6 of the molecules will have a positive x component of velocity since there are six equivalent orthogonal directions, +x, -x, +y, -y, +z, -z. So the r in Equation (1) is only 1/6 N/V; thus pressure = 2 (1/6 x N/V)mv2 = 1/3 ((Nmv2) / (v)) (2) 2. By the middle of the nineteenth century, the ideal gas law was written as PV = nRT (3) where the three variables are the pressure P (dynes/cm2), the volume V(cm3), and the temperature T (øK). The quantity n is the number of moles of gas in the sample (dimensionless) and R is a universal constant simply called the gas constant. The experimental value of the gas constant R is R = 8.31 x 107 ergs/øK where an erg = 1 dyne ¥ cm Later work by Avogadro led to a re-expression of the same law as PV = NkT where the quantity N is the total number of molecules in the sample of gas and k is Boltzmann's constant. The experimental value for k is k = 1.38 x 10-16 ergs/øK (a) Derive an expression for N in terms of k, n, and R. (b) Avogadro's number, No, is the number of molecules in a mole (N/n). From the above data, determine the numerical value of No. Thinking About This Problem The problem does not involve any profound knowledge of physics; rather straightforward manipulation of Equations (3) and (4) is all that is necessary. pV = nRT = NkT (a) so N = nR/k (b) Avogadro's number No = N/n = R/k = (8.31 x 107 ergs/øK)/(1.38 x 10-16 ergs/øK) = 6.02 x 1023 PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Questions; Problems; Answers; Evaluations; Fluids; Fluid Statics; Surface Tension; Adhesion; Cohesion; Molecular Model Of Liquids 1. In an interesting physics demonstration, a young physics teacher placed a thin film of water between two flat panes of glass. The result is a bond which holds the two pieces of glass firmly together. Is this an example of adhesion or cohesion? Explain your answer as if you were teaching the class. 2. The rms speed of oxygen (O2) molecules at 27øC is 482 m/sec. Assume that this is an ideal gas for the following questions. (The Boltzmann constant is 1.38 x 10-23 J/molecule- øk) a. Find the mass of the oxygen molecule in kilograms. b. Calculate the energy of an individual oxygen molecule. c. If the energy is to be reduced by a factor of 3, what reduction in temperature is required? 3. The surface tension of an unknown liquid is measured at room temperature with the apparatus shown below. First the system is balanced using a small counter balance m. After the ring of radius r (10 cm) is placed in the unknown liquid, an additional mass of Dm must be added to pull the circular wire from the liquid. If m = 50.2 grams and Dm = 18.8 grams, calculate the surface tension of the liquid at room temperature. (Express your answer in dynes/cm.) See Fig. ANSWERS: 1. Adhesion. Water molecules adhere (are attracted) to glass molecules. The forces between individual water molecules are cohesive forces. 2. 5.34 x 10-26 kg, 6.2 x 10-21 Joule, Reduce temperature by 200øK. 3. 7.1 dynes/cm Chapter Simple Harmonic Motion (15): Citation: H. Q Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications. (Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors 15 Simple Harmonic Motion Keywords: Learning Objectives; ; Waves And Sound; Oscillations; Simple Harmonic Motion; Oscillatory Motion; Period; Amplitude; Phase; Damped Oscillations; Frequency; Properties Of Oscillations GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: period frequency simple harmonic motion restoring force amplitude damping phase angle UCM and SHM Correlate uniform circular motion and simple harmonic motion. SHM Problems Solve problems involving simple harmonic motion. Energy Transformations Analyze the transfer of energy in simple harmonic motion. Superposition Explain the application of the principle of superposition to simple harmonic motion. Natural Frequencies Calculate the natural frequencies of solids from their elastic moduli and density values. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 5, Energy, Chapter 7, Rotational Motion, and Chapter 13, Elastic Properties of Materials. OVERVIEW Keywords: Instructions; ; Waves And Sound; Oscillations; Properties Of Oscillations; Oscillatory Motion Examples of repeated motion are all around us. Examples include a child in a swing and the up and down motion of a fish bobber. Most repeated motions are either uniform, simple harmonic motion, or reduce to nearly this type of motion for small amplitudes. In this chapter you will learn how repeated motion of this type is treated mathematically. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Begin your study by carefully reading the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, UCM and SHM, SHM Problems, and Energy Transformations. For an expanded discussion of the terms listed under the goal of Definitions, see the Definitions section of this chapter. Now, read text sections 15.1-15.4 looking carefully at the examples given. The mathematics in Section 15.4 become somewhat difficult, but the use of Figure 15.5 will help you visualize the meaning of the equations. Remember to look in the second section of this for the answers to all questions posed throughout the reading sections. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-14. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1-6 and check your answers carefully. Next, complete Exercises and Problems 2, 5, 7, 12, and 21. For additional work on the concepts presented in this chapter, turn to the Examples section of this . Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test provided at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulties with any of the problems, please refer to that particular part of the text or to the sections of this chapter. This study procedure is outlined below. ------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ------------------Definitions 15.1 1-4 UCM and SHM 15.2,15.3 5-14 4 2 SHM Problems 15.2,15.3,15.4 1-3,5,6 5,7,12,21 ------------------------------------------------Superposition 15.6 15,16 9 Natural 15.5,15.6 17,18 8 Frequencies DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Waves And Sound; Oscillatory; Properties Of Oscillations; Oscillatory Motion; Period; Simple Harmonic Motion; Amplitude; Phase; Frequency; Damped Oscillations PERIOD The time required for a system to go through one complete cycle of motion and usually measured in seconds. The period of motion of a second hand on a clock is 60 seconds as it takes 60 seconds for a second hand to go completely around the face of a watch. The period of the hour hand is 12 hours, since it makes two complete cycles in 24 hours. SIMPLE HARMONIC MOTION If the restoring force is proportional to the displacement and oppositely directed, the system will execute SHM when displaced from equilibrium. The motion of a simple pendulum through small angles is a very familiar example of a system that executes simple harmonic motion. AMPLITUDE Maximum displacement from equlibrium position. The amplitude of motion of a pendulum is the maximum angle from the vertical to which the pendulum swings. PHASE ANGLE Angular displacement at the starting time. It is common for us to start a SHM system moving by displacing it from its rest position. The initial location determines the value of the phase angle. FREQUENCY Number of complete oscillations per second. If you have a SHM system that requires 8 seconds to make a complete cycle, then that system goes 1/8th of a cycle in one second. We say its frequency is 1/8 cycles per second or 1/8 hertz. RESTORING FORCE Force acting to return a displaced body to equilibrium position. DAMPING A loss of energy during vibration because of friction. It shows its pressure by a decrease in the amplitude of vibration. In all real, isolated oscillating systems the friction forces finally bring the system to rest in its position of lowest energy. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Waves And Sound; Oscillations; Oscillatory Motion; Simple Harmonic Motion SECTION 15.1 Introduction The universality of simple harmonic motion, the simplest kind of periodic motion, is striking. It has been suggested that the pervasive existence of simple harmonic motion is one of the miracles provided by the nature of our universe. A mathematical derivation can be used to show how the universality of SHM arises (see Taylor's Theorem in the enrichment section 15.7). The simplicity of SHM and the completeness with which we can treat SHM, makes it a favorite model for physicists. It is widely used to explain atomic phenomena such as the vibration of atoms in solids and the oscillations of atomic nuclei. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Waves And Sound; Oscillations; Oscillatory Motion; Simple Harmonic Motion; Hooke's Law; Newton's Second Law; Kinetic Energy; Potential Energy; Period; Frequency; Young's Modulus; Energy; Resonance; Resonant Frequencies; Properties Of Oscillations; Temperature; Arithmetic SHM PROBLEMS 1. Of all the possible forces in the universe, there is only one force that results in simple harmonic motion. (a) What is the equation for that force? (b) What is this force called? (c) Sketch the magnitude of this special force IFI as a function of displacement. (d) Sketch the force F as a function of the displacement. (e) Explain in words the relationship between this force and the magnitude and direction of the acceleration of the body upon which it acts. What Data Are Given? Consider an ideal system which undergoes simple harmonic motion in one dimension. What Data Are Implied? 222 Assume that friction can be neglected and that the amplitude and period have constant, finite values. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The problem only involves the dynamics of SHM as discussed in Section 15.3. What Equations Are to be Used? Newton's Second Law of Motion and Hooke's Law are all that is required for this problem. F = ma (4.1) F (Hooke) = - kx (13.3) Algebraic Solution (a) The equation for the force is Hooke's Law (Equation 13.3) Force = -kx where k is a positive constant and x is the displacement. (b) This force is called a Hooke's Law force on a linear restoring force. (c) See Fig. 15.1 IFI = I-kxI, so F = kx for x ò 0 F = -kx for x ó 0 (d) F = -kx See Fig. (e) Combining Equations (4.1) and (13.3) we obtain the equation of motion for SHM ma = -kx (1) so a = -k/mx where k and m are both positive constants. So the acceleration of the body is opposite in direction to the displacement. It is directly proportional to the displacement with a proportionality constant equal to k/m. 2. Draw a graph of the total energy, kinetic energy, and potential energy of a onedimensional system that undergoes simple harmonic motion. What Data Are Given? Consider an ideal system in one dimension, say x, which uses SHM. What Data Are Implied? Neglect friction and consider a finite system. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The energy concepts discussed in Section 15.4 What Equations Are to be Used? Potential Energy = 1/2 kx2 (15.12) Kinetic Energy = 1/2 mv2 = 1/2 m(k/m (A2 - x2)) (15.16) Total energy = KE + PE = 1/2 kA2 = 1/2 mvmax2 (15.14 & 15.17) Algebraic Solution See Fig. 3. A 8 kg monkey grabbed onto an elastic grapevine hanging from a jungle tree. The vine stretched 16 m. (a) What force was applied to the vine by the monkey? (b) What is the effective force constant k of the vine, assuming the applied force did not stretch it beyond its elastic limit? (c) Write Newton's Second Law of Motion equation for the motion of the monkey up and down. (d) What is the frequency in Hertz of the up and down motion? (e) Suppose the monkey wishes to reach down 2 meters from its equilibrium position to catch a banana. What is the total energy of the monkey as it reaches the banana with respect to an assumed total energy of zero at the equilibrium position? (f) What is the velocity of the monkey as it passes through the equilibrium position? (g) Calculate the period of oscillation and sketch the motion of the monkey as a function of time. Show the units on both the vertical and time axes. What Data Are Given? A vertical unstretched vine will stretch down 16 m when an 8 kg mass is hung onto it. That mass is then displaced 2 m and allowed to oscillate up and down. What Data Are Implied? The equlibrium position, 16 m below the starting position of the monkey, is to be taken as the zero energy elevation. Ideal SHM is assumed near the surface of the earth where g = 9.8 m/s2. What Physics Principles Are Involved? This problem requires the coordination of the kinematics, dynamics, and energy relationships of SHM, Sections 15.2, 15.3, and 15.4. What Equations Are to be Used? F = w = mg (4.5) F = -kx (13.3) F = 1/2p ¥ (SQR RT)(k/m) (15.8) Espring = 1/2 kA2 = 1/2 mv2 + 1/2 kx2 (15.14) PEgravity = mgh (5.5) Vmax = ñwA (15.17) T = 2p ¥ (SQR RT)(m/k) = 1/f (15.9) x = A cos (wt + f) (15.2) Algebraic Solutions See Fig. (a) Force on the vine = mg (b) Force constant = mg / (elongation of the vine) (c) ma = -ky where y is the change in elevation from the elongated position of the vine (d) f = 1/2p ¥ (SQR RT)k/m Hz (e) Total Energy = 1/2 kA2 - mgA at the bottom (f) V = ñwA (g) T = 1/f sec. Numerical Solutions (a) Force on the vine = (8 kg)(9.8 m/s2) = 7.8 x 101 N (b) Force constant = (7.8 x 101 N)(1.6 x 10 1 m) = 4.9 N/m (c) acceleration = ((-4.9 N/m)/8 kg)y = (0.61 N/kg.m)y (d) f = 0.12 Hz (e) E = 1/2 (4.9 N/m)(2 m)2 - (8)(9.8)(2) = -150 Joules (f) Vmax = ñwA = I2pfA = ñ 2(p)(.12) (2 m) = 0.75 m/s (g) T = 1/f = 8.0 seconds See Fig. Thinking About the Answer Notice how the need to also consider the gravitational potential energy changes this problem. In other kinds of SHM problems negative energies would not be possible. Consider shifting the zero in gravitational potential energy to the bottom of the motion - what is the energy at the equilibrium position then? NATURAL FREQUENCIES 4. A bell manufacturer constructed a copper bell with a resonance frequency of 440 Hz. He found that if he made it of lead (Y lead = 1.7 x 1010N/m2) it would have the same resonance frequency only near liquid nitrogen temperature (~73øK). Estimate the temperature coefficient for Young's modulus for lead and the room temperature resonance frequency for the lead bell. What Data Are Given? Ylead = 1.7 x 1010 N/m2 at normal temperatures. Ycopper = 12 x 1010 N/m2 at normal temperatures (from Table 13.1), copper normal temperature ÷ 20øC ÷ 293øK; LN2T ÷ 73øK What Data Are Implied? The densities of the materials are needed to determine natural frequencies. From Table 8.1 density of lead = 11.3 x 103 kg/m 3; density of copper = 8.9 x 103kg/m3. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The dependence of the natural frequency of a solid is given by Equation 15.18. In this problem let us consider only the compressional waves in the materials so that the natural frequency depends upon the square root of the ratio of Young's modulus to the density. The temperature coefficient can be found by calculating the Young's modulus value at 73øK; then find the ratio temperature coefficient = change in Y's modulus / change in temperature What Equations Are to be Used? f0 = (1/2p) ¥ (SQR RT)(Young's Modulus / ((density)(area)) (15.19) temperature coefficient = change in Young's Modulus / change in temperature (2) Algebraic Solutions Since all the dimensions of the two bells are the same, the ratio of the natural frequencies will only depend upon the ratio of the square roots of Young's modulus to density. fPb/fcu = (SQR RT)[(YPb/rPb)/(Ycu/rcu)] = (SQR RT)[(YPb ¥ rcu)/ (rPb ¥ Ycu)] (3) temperature coefficient = (YR. T. - YLN2T)/R. T. - LN2T (4) Numerical Solutions fPb = (SQR RT)[((1.7 x 1010) ¥ (8.9 x 103))/ ((11.3 x 103) x (12 x 1010))] To have the same frequency the ratio of Young's modulus to density must be the same, so Young's Modulus Pb at 73øK / (11.3 x 133 kg/m3) = (12 x 1010 N/m2)/(8.9 x 103 kg/m3) Young's modulus Pb at 73øK = 15.2 x 1010 N/m2 temperature coefficient = (1.7 x 1010 - 15.2 x 1010) / (293øK - 73øK) = (-13.5 x 1010 N/m2) / 220øK temperature coefficient = (-6.3 x 108 N/m2) / øK Thinking About the Answer Notice that the temperature coefficient is negative. As the temperature increases, the Young's modulus decreases. This is typical of many materials. They become less elastic as they are heated. Use the molecular theory of matter to explain this phenomenon. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Problems; Answers; Evaluations; Graphs; Velocity; Anatomy And Physiology; Uniform Circular Motion; Velocity; Period; Displacement; Waves And Sound; ; Oscillations; Oscillatory Motion; Properties Of Oscillations Energy 1. A patient's heart of effective mass 0.05 kg has a maximum displacement given by Z = 0.02 sin3pt where Z is in meters and t is in seconds. a. Sketch a graph of the motion of this heart on the axis provide below. See Fig. b. Find the position of the heart at .75 seconds. c. Give the frequency of oscillation of the heart. d. What is the total energy of the heart? e. What is the maximum displacement of the heart? f. Calculate the maximum velocity of the heart at Z = 0. g. The projection of uniform circular motion is simple harmonic motion. On the axis below, specify the requirements of a mass undergoing uniform circular motion so that the projection of the motion on the Z axis will be exactly the same as the heart above. See Fig. 2. In another monitoring session, the patient above is again observed. The position of the heart is again a periodic function and is illustrated below. See Fig. a. Write the equation of the relation found in this graph. b. What is the maximum energy of the heart in this situation? ANSWERS: 1. a. See Fig. b. .014 meter c. 3/2 hertz d. .009 J e. .02 M f. .19 m/s g. g. See Fig. 2. Z = .03 cos 5pt, .19 J Chapter Traveling Waves (16): 16 Traveling Waves Keywords: Learning Objectives; Waves And Sound; Waves; Behavior Of Waves; Properties Of Waves; Frequency; Wavelength; Amplitude; Longitudinal Waves; Transverse Waves; Phase; Intensity; Reflection; Refraction; Superposition Principle; Interference; Diffraction; Standing Waves; Types Of Waves; Fourier Expansion; Dispersion GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms as it is used in physics, and use the term in an operational definition: frequency refraction wavelength superposition principle amplitude interference longitudinal wave diffraction transverse wave standing wave phase Fourier's theorem intensity dispersion reflection Wave Forms Sketch a longitudinal wave and a transverse wave. Wave Problems Solve wave problems involving the relationships that exist between the different characteristics of waves. Superposition and Fourier's Theorem Use the superposition principle and Fourier's theorem to explain the wave form of a complex wave. Standing Waves Use the superposition principle to explain the formation of standing waves in different situations. Inverse Square Law Use the inverse square law to calculate the intensity of a wave emanating from a point source. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 5, Energy, Chapter 13, Elastic Properties of Materials, and Chapter 15, Simple Harmonic Motion. OVERVIEW Keywords: Waves And Sound; Waves; Instructions; The motion of waves is a fascinating topic. Whenever you see a wave of water move along the surface of a quiet lake, you are observing the movement of energy. Most of the cases of energy transported by waves cannot be seen but are detected through our other senses. Examples include both sound and light. This chapter will expand your knowledge of simple harmonic motion (Chapter 15) to include a description of wave motion. As you look over the chapter you should note that in general waves can be classified as Transverse or Longitudinal depending upon their mode of vibrating. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE When you begin your study of this chapter, please concentrate your attention on the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Wave Problems, and Inverse Square Law. For an expanded discussion of each of the terms listed under Definitions, see theDefinitions section of this chapter. Now, read text sections 16.1-16.15. Be sure to note that the description of wave motion is included in Sections 16.4-16.6. The remaining parts of the Chapter describe many of the properties of waves. Answers to the questions you encounter in your reading can be found in the second section of this chapter. Next, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-6 and 8. Check your answers carefully. Now, do Algorithmic Problems 1, 3, 5, and 9, and Exercises and Problems 1, 2, 4, 5, 6, and 13. For additional work with the important concepts introduced in this chapter, turn to the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test included at the end of this chapter. Be sure to check your answers after you have considered the problems posed. Refer to the text section or to this chapter for additional help if needed. -----------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -------------------Definitions 16.1-16.3, 1-3,4,6, 16.7-16.13 7 Wave Problems 16.3-16.6,16.14 5 1,3,5 1,2,4,5, 6 Inverse Square 16.15 8 9 13 Law --------------------------------------------------Wave Forms 16.4,16.8, 4 5,6 16.11,16.12 Superposition 16.8,16.12 6 9,10 and Fourier's Theorem Standing Waves 16.11 7 16 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Waves And Sound; Waves; Behavior Of Waves; Types Of Waves; Properties Of Waves; Frequency; Wavelength; Amplitude; Longitudinal Waves; Transverse Waves; Phase; Intensity; Reflection; Refraction; Superposition Principle; Interference; Diffraction; Standing Waves; Dispersion; Fourier Expansion FREQUENCY The number of complete oscillations made by a wave in one second is called its frequency. Frequency is measured in complete oscillations, or cycles, per seconds. The unit is named hertz, one hertz means one cycle per second. WAVELENGTH The distance a wave moves during one time period. As waves travel out from the place a pebble hits still water the distance between successive peaks is one wavelength. AMPLITUDE The maximum displacement of the oscillating system from its equilibrium position. Large ocean waves are those of the greatest amplitude. LONGITUDINAL WAVES The individual particle vibrates in a direction parallel to the direction of propagation of the wave. The shaking back and forth in the direction of the stretching of a Slinky toy creates longitudinal waves along the Slinky. TRANSVERSE WAVE The plane of vibration is perpendicular to the direction of propagation of the wave. The shaking up and down of the end of a Slinky in a plane perpendicular to the length of the toy creates transverse waves that travel along the toy. PHASE The starting position of a wave with respect to the equilibrium position. Two locations of a traveling wave that differ in phase by 180ø must be one-half of a wavelength apart. INTENSITY Energy transported through a unit area in one second. If you make the amplitude of a traveling wave twice as large you make its intensity four times as large. REFLECTION A phenomenon which occurs at the interface between two media and the wave from the interface is in the same media as the incident wave. An echo is a reflected sound wave that comes back to your ear some time after it first fell on your ear. REFRACTION A phenomenon which occurs at the interface between two media and the direction of the wave in the second medium is different than in the incident medium. When a water wave passes through a region of abrupt change in depth from shallow water to deep water, its direction of propagation is changed. SUPERPOSITION PRINCIPLE The resultant effect is equal to the sum of the individual independent effects. A principle that holds true for linear systems. Most complex systems in physics are analyzed into simpler linear systems. Then the resultant is the sum of the individual parts. A free body diagram is an example of the superposition concept applied to a problem of mechanical equilibrium. INTERFERENCE The superposition of two or more waves with constant phase differences produces interference. Two waves that interfere constructively will have a maximum amplitude greater than either one alone. Two waves that interfere destructively will have a reduced maximum amplitude. DIFFRACTION Occurs if a wave front encounters an object and there results a superposition of wave fronts. The bending of sound waves around corners is a result of the diffraction of sound waves. STANDING WAVES These result from the superposition of two traveling waves of equal frequency moving in opposite directions in the medium and 180ø out of phase. For a given physical system standing waves result at its resonance frequency. The sounds that originate from the vibrating strings of a guitar represent the standing waves of the strings. FOURIER'S THEOREM Any wave form may be produced by the superposition of sine waves of specific wavelengths and amplitudes. DISPERSION The speed of a traveling wave may be different for different wavelengths of the wave. This difference results in the spread of the various wavelengths of a complex traveling wave as it passes through various media. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Answers; Waves And Sound; Waves; Behavior Of Waves; Reflection; Refraction; SECTION 16.7 Reflection and Refraction Most of our common experiences with reflection and refraction occur with light. Your use of a mirror to check on your appearance is a use of reflection. Have you ever noticed how shallow a very clear lake appears to be? That deception results from refraction. If the energy reaching a surface is to be conserved, then the incident energy must equal the energy leaving the surface. Since both reflected and transmitted waves are leaving the surface, then Incident Energy = Reflected Energy + Transmitted Energy. Divide both sides by the incident energy and multiply by 100 to convert to percentage, then 100% = % Reflected Energy + % Transmitted Energy. SECTION 16.13 Dispersion If air were a dispersive medium for sound, then the different frequencies, or pitches, of sounds would travel at different speeds. Suppose, for example, that low frequency waves, bass notes, travelled faster than high frequency waves, soprano notes. Then students seated at the back of a large lecture hall would hear different sounding words than the students seated near the front! EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; Waves And Sound; Waves; Velocity; Amplitude; Frequency; Properties Of Waves; Arithmetic; Sound; Intensity Of Sound; Properties Of Sound; Power; Units; Watts; Functions WAVE PROBLEMS 1. The equation for a travelling wave y(m) when x is in meters and t is in seconds is given by y = 10 cos(4x + 200t). (a) What is the amplitude of this wave? (b) What is its wavelength? (c) What is its frequency? (d) What is its velocity? (e) Sketch the wave at t = 0. (f) Sketch the wave at t = p/800 sec. (g) In which direction is the wave moving? What Data Are Given? The standard travelling wave equation with numerical values is given. What Data Are Implied? The wave is transverse with amplitude in the y - direction and motion along the x - axis. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The basic definitions of the various aspects of travelling waves as presented in Sections 16.4 and 16.5 are needed. What Equations Are to be Used? y = A sin 2pft - (2px / l) (16.4) vwave = lf (16.2) Algebraic Solution The problem involves primarily the recognition of the various terms in Equation 16.4 and identifying their values from the numbers given in the problem. Once the wavelength l and the frequency f have been identified from Equation 16.4, then they can be multiplied together to obtain the wave velocity as shown in Equation 16.2. Numerical Solution y(m) = 10 cos (4x + 200t) and y = A sin (2pft - (2px / l)) (16.4) (a) So the amplitude of the wave A = 10 meters. (b) The wavelength of the wave, 2p / l = 4; sol = p/2 meters (c) The frequency of the wave, 2pf = 200; so f = 100/p Hz. (d) The wave velocity v = lf = (p/2)(100/p) = 50 m/s. See Fig. (g) The peaks of the wave have moved to the left in p/800 seconds, so the wave is moving in the negative x - direction. The trans ocean swimmer named Dave, Got caught by a traveling wave. The waves w, Nearby Bodega, Did cause his watery grave. See Fig. INVERSE SQUARE LAW 2. A sound wave of pressure amplitude 3 x 10-2 N/m 2 is eminating from an 80 watt hifi speaker. (a) What is the amplitude of the sound wave at a distance of 3 meters from the speaker? (b) What is the intensity of the sound 3 meters from the speaker? (c) What is the amplitude of the sound wave at a distance of 10 m from the speaker? (d) What is the intensity of the sound at a distance of 10 m from the speaker? What Data Are Given? The pressure amplitude is given as 3 x 10-2 N/m 2. The power output of the hi-fi speaker is given as 80 watts. What Data Are Implied? It is implied that the sound wave eminates in a spherically uniform way and that all of the power output of the speaker is carried away by the sound wave. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The definition of amplitude and the inverse square law are needed for this problem. What Equations Are to be Used? Intensity = E / (4pr2t) (16.11) Algebraic Solutions Amplitude is independent of distance from the source for ideal, undamped systems. Intensity = (E/t) / (4pr2) = Power / (4pr2) Numerical Solutions (a), (c) Amplitude = 3 x 10-2 N/m2 at all distances. (b) Intensity3 = 80 W / (4p(3 m)2) = 80 W / 36pm2 = 0.707 W/m2 (d) Intensity10 = 80 W / (4p(10 m)2) = 80 W / 400p = 0.064 W/m2 Thinking About the Answer The answer to (d) should be [(3)2 / (10)2] times the answer to (b); dividing (d) by (b) we obtain 0.090 which is equal to 32 / 102. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Problems; Questions; Answers; Evaluations; Amplitude; Frequency; Velocity; Reflection; Phase; Sound; Intensity Of Sound; Functions; Waves; Waves And Sound; Properties Of Waves; Behavior Of Waves 1. The motion of a wave moving along a string is described by the equation y(m) = 10 cos (4.0 x - 200t) where x is in meters and t is in seconds. For this wave find the following: a. Amplitude = b. Wavelength = c. Frequency = d. Velocity = e. In which direction is the wave moving? 2. If the positive pulse shown below is sent down a taut string, describe the pulse as itreflects from a rigid post. See Fig. 3. A large bell is located in a tall church tower is rung for several minutes. Local physics students are measuring sound levels in the open field nearby. Their measurements show that at 100 meters, the intensity of the ringing bell sound is 10 -6 watts/m2. What would be the intensity of sound received by a person standing only 3 meters from the bell tower? See Fig. ANSWERS: 1. (a) 10 meter, (b) 1.6 meter (c) 32/sec, (d) f = 51 m/sec, (e) left to right 2. 180ø phase change 3. 1.1 x 10-3 watts / m2 Chapter Sound and the Human Ear (17): to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications: 17 Sound and the Human Ear Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Waves And Sound; Sound; Properties Of Sound; Intensity Of Sound; Amplitude; Frequency; Wavelength; Acoustical Impedance; Infrasonic; Ultrasonic; Standing Waves; Beats; Doppler Effect; Waves; Properties Of Waves; Behavior Of Waves; Distortion GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms and use it in an operational definition: sound wave infrasonic intensity of sound wave ultrasonic amplitude distortion frequency standing wave wavelength beats acoustic impedance Doppler effect decibel Sound Wave Form Graph the amplitude of a sound wave in pressure versus space or time coordinates. Sound Level Calculate the sound level in decibels (dB). Sound Intensity Solve sound intensity and sound amplitude problems. Sound Application Explain the use of sound in selected medical applications. Hearing System Describe the properties of the human sound detection system. Doppler Effect Solve Doppler-effect and standing-wave problems. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 5, Energy, Chapter 15, Simple Harmonic Motion, and Chapter 16, Traveling Waves, respectively. OVERVIEW Keywords: Waves And Sound; Waves; ; Instructions Our bodies have a delicate sound receiving apparatus, the human ear. Each day we utilize our sense of hearing to go about our regular routine. In this chapter you will discover more about the nature of both the sound which carries information to the ear and about the ear as a sound transducer. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE As you begin to study this chapter, be familiar with the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Sound Level, Sound Intensity, Sound Applications, and Hearing System. For an expanded discussion of the terms listed under Definitions, turn to the Definitions section of this chapter. Next, read text sections 17.1-17.9 and 17.11-17.13. Answers to the questions asked in the text readings can be found in the second section of this chapter. Be sure to note one of the important ideas introduced in section 17.4 is the development of a logarithmic scale for describing sound intensity. If you have difficulties using the logarithmic form suggested, you should refer to chapter 0 of this and to the Appendix, Section A.8. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-8, 12, and 13. Check your answers carefully against those provided. Now do Algorithmic Problem 1 and Exercises and Problems 3-7 and 14. Be careful to check your answers carefully. For assistance, refer back to the appropriate text section. For additional exercises with the concepts presented in this chapter, refer to the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Sound and the Human Ear provided at the end of this Study Guide chapter. If you are unsuccessful with any of the questions, you should refer back to the text or to this chapter for assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. ------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ------------------Definitions 17.1,17.2,17.5- 1-8 17.9,17.11-17.13 Sound Level 17.4 1 5,6,7,14 Sound Intensity 17.3 3,4 The Hearing 17.12 13 System Sound 17.3,17.5,17.13 12 Applications --------------------------------------------------Sound Wave Form 17.2 9-11 1,2 Doppler Effect 17.10 14,15 2,3,4 8,9,15 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Waves And Sound; Sound; Properties Of Sound; Intensity Of Sound; Amplitude; Frequency; Wavelength; Acoustical Impedance; Infrasonic; Ultrasonic; Standing Waves; Beats; Doppler Effect; Waves; Properties Of Waves; Behavior Of Waves; Distortion SOUND WAVE A longitudinal pressure wave which travels through matter. This definition answers the question "Is there sound if no human is around to hear it?" What is the answer, according to this definition? INTENSITY OF SOUND WAVES The energy per unit area per second transmitted by sound waves. The usual intensity units are watts / (meter)2, and typical sounds, such as normal conversation have an intensity of about 1 x 10-6 W/m 2. AMPLITUDE The maximum pressure obtained during the periodic variations of pressure in a sound wave is the amplitude. Typical pressure amplitudes of sound waves are of the order of 10-2 N/m2. This can be converted to an equivalent displacement amplitude using Equations 17.3 and 17.2, A = Po / Wrvs For typical values, then A is of the order of 10-9 m. FREQUENCY The number of complete pressure oscillations that occur in a sound wave in one second. Common audible sounds have frequencies in the tens and hundreds of oscillations per second. The dominate frequency of middle C on a piano is about 250 Hz; so the third C above middle C has a frequency of about 2000 Hz and the third C below middle C has a frequency of about 30 Hz. WAVELENGTH When we picture sound as a spatial distribution of periodic pressure oscillations then we can measure the distance between adjacent regions of equal pressure to find the wavelength of the sound wave. Typical (audible) sounds have wavelengths in the range from about 10 meters (35 Hz) to about 1/10 meter (3500 Hz). ACOUSTIC IMPEDANCE The inertia of a medium in its response to pressure oscillations is called its acoustic impedance. It is measured in kg/m2 ¥ s. The acoustic impedance of air is about 102 kg/m2 ¥ s, while the acoustic impedance of water is about 106 kg/m2 ¥ s. DECIBEL The sound level is measured on a logarithmic scale of intensity ratios using a unit called decibel. The equation used to calculate the sound level in decibels is Equation 17.6. Average audible sound levels range from 40 dB in the average room to about 110 dB for a rock music concert. Human discomfort is caused by sound levels above 120 dB. INFRASONIC Sounds which have frequencies below the usual human auditory limit of 20 Hz are called infrasonic sounds. The effects of infrasonic sounds on living systems is not well understood. ULTRASONIC Sounds which have frequencies above the usual human auditory limit of 20,000 Hz are called ultrasonic sounds. Much human tissue is transparent to ultrasonic waves. These waves can be used to observe internal features of the human body. DISTORTION A sound wave is distorted by any media which do not obey Hooke's Law. If the output of a sound amplifier system is not proportional to the input to the system for all frequencies, then the output from the system will be distorted. Many electronically amplified music groups use distortions caused by amplifying high intensity sounds to create their unique sounds. STANDING WAVE The superposition of traveling waves of the same wavelength and opposite velocities results in waves that do NOT appear to move. Typical guitar string vibrations are standing waves. BEATS If two pure sinusoidal sound waves of nearly equal frequencies occur in the same region of space, then they may be heard as a number of periodic fluctuations in the sound intensities called beats. If you excite two tuning forks, one of frequency 440 Hz and the other of 444 Hz, you can hear periodic intensity fluctuations of the sounds with a frequency of 4 Hz. DOPPLER EFFECT Moving sources of sound waves and moving receivers of sound waves will cause apparent shifts in the frequencies of the observed sounds. You may have noticed the apparent change in pitch of a train whistle or automobile siren as it went passed you. Can you recall how the pitch changed? ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Waves And Sound; Waves; Behavior Of Waves; Diffraction; Behavior Of Sound; Sound; Infrasonic; Ultrasonic; Frequency SECTION 17.1 Introduction Sound originates from vibrating objects. Sound travels around objects of typical sizes by diffraction. The vibrating ruler on your desk can be used to produce different frequencies of sounds by changing the length of the ruler that extends beyond the edge of the desk. From the definition of sound given above you will notice that the presence of a human observer is not required for sound to exist. SECTION 17.5 Infrasonics and Ultrasonics Ultrasound readily penetrates much human tissue with little loss of energy. Hence ultrasonic waves can pass through tissue without damage. When focused into a small volume of absorptive tissue the ultrasonic energy can be deposited to produce changes in the tissue. Ultrasound is a high frequency pressure wave. This wave causes high frequency (~ 40,000 Hz) oscillations in the molecules in tissue. One model would be to assume that the high frequency pressure waves cause changes in the chemical structure of tissue, thereby changing the biological properties of the tissue. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Intensity Of Sound; Doppler Effect; Watts; Units; Frequency; Power; Functions; Arithmetic; Waves And Sound; Sound; Behavior Of Sound; Properties Of Sound SOUND LEVEL AND SOUND INTENSITY 1. A railroad train has a whistle that emits an isotropic sound of 300 watts. The train is approaching you along a straight track that passes within 5 meters of where you are standing. The train whistle begins to blow when the train is 100 meters from you and continues to blow until the train is passed its nearest position to you. What is the lowest sound level of the whistle that you hear? What is the highest level of the whistle that you hear? What Data Are Given? Whistle power = 300 watts; farthest distance = 100 m; nearest distance = 5 m What Data Are Implied? The inverse square law can be used since the sound is equally intense in all directions. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The definition of sound level and the inverse square law. What Equations Are to be Used? dB = 10 log (I/Io) (17.6) I = (E/t)/(4pr2) (16.11) Algebraic Solutions Lowest level occurs when the whistle is a maximum distance from the observer rmax. dBlowest = 10 log (Ilowest / Io) where Ilowest = Power / (4pr2max) Highest level occurs when the whistle is the minimum distance from the observer, rmin. dBmax = 10 log (Imax / Io) where Imax = Power / (4pr2min) Io = 10-12 W/m2 Numerical Solution Ilowest = 300W / (4p(100)2) = 2.4 x 10-3 W/m2; dBlowest = 94 db Imax = 9.5 x 10-1 W/m2; dBmax = 120 dB Thinking About the Answer Notice that the ratio of the distances is 20 to 1, so the ratio of intensities is 1 to 400, yet the dB value only changes from 94 dB to 120 dB. DOPPLER EFFECT 2. The operator of the world's largest ferris wheel in Vienna, Austria, with a radius of 30 meters needs to determine how fast his ferris wheel turns at its maximum speed. Since the operator has perfect pitch and his assistant has taken physics, they decide to utilize the Doppler shift for making this measurement. The assistant rides the wheel and blows a concert A on a pitch pipe. As the wheel reaches its maximum velocity, the operator stands near the bottom and listens for the frequency while the operator is approaching. The data collected is as follows; observed frequency of approach is 444 vibrations/sec, velocity of sound is 345 meters/sec. Utilize the information to find the tangential velocity of ferris wheel. What Data Are Given? The radius of the wheel = 30 meters, the observed frequency of approach = 444 vibrations/sec., at rest frequency = 440 vibrations/sec., and the velocity of sound = 345 m/sec. What Data Are Implied? This problem implies that the frequency difference (moving - at rest) can be detected with enough accuracy that the Doppler relationship can be utilized to solve for the velocity of the source. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The Doppler effect relationship for source moving, observer at rest. What Equations Are to be Used? f1 = (f(vs + vo)) / (vs - v) (17.11) This is a general equation for relative approach. In our problem, the observer's velocity, vo = 0. Therefore, equation 17.11 is reduced in this case to the following: f1 = (f(vs)) / (vs - v) Algebraic Solution Since we are attempting to solve for v, the velocity of the source, we must rearrange the relationship above solving for v. Please note that vs is the speed of sound. Then, f1(vs - v) = f(vs) f1vs - f1v = f(vs) f1v = f1(vs) - f(vs) v = (f1(vs) - f(vs)) / f1 = vs (1 - (f/f1)) Numerical Solution v = 345 (1 - 440 / 444) v = 2.8 m/s See Fig. Thinking About the Answer Note that the answer seems reasonable; if the moving frequency was closer to 440 vibrations/sec, the calculated velocity would be closer to zero. If the observed frequency was much higher than 440 vibrations/sec, the calculated velocity would be increased as expected. Can you predict what frequency the operator would hear when the assistant was moving away from him? See Fig. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Problems; Questions; Evaluations; Answers; Intensity Of Sound; Power; Watts; Units; Ear; Sensory Systems; Anatomy And Physiology; Energy; Transducers; Feedback; Acoustical Impedance; Waves And Sound; Sound; Ultrasonic; Frequency; Properties Of Sound 1. The sound intensity measured in a large factory is .10 watts/m2 a. What is the level of this sound in decibels? b. If through the use of sound absorbing material the sound intensity is reduced to 1/2 its original value, what would be the new decibel level? 2. The block diagram below represents the various parts of the human ear system. See Fig. Identify the parts of the ear labeled A, B, and C above, and describe the form of the energy input and energy output of each part (i.e., mechanical, electrical, chemical, etc.) Part of the Ear Energy Input Energy Output A. B. C. 3. There are several medical applications for Ultrasonic sound. a. Give the approximate frequency range for ultrasonic waves. b. Outline the one particular use of ultrasonic waves in neurosonic surgery. ANSWERS: 1. a. 110 dB b. 107 dB 2. A. Ear drum (outer ear) Sound (Mechanical) Mechanical B. Bones (middle ear) Mechanical Mechanical C. Eustachian tube(inner ear) Mechanical Electrical 3. a. Any greater than 20,000 Hz b. Ultrasonics are focused on a particular part of the brain thus destroying tissue at focal point without harming other surrounding tissue Chapter Optical Elements (18): STUDY GUIDE Citation: H. Q Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications. (Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors. 18 Optical Elements Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Light And Optics; Images; Nature And Propagation Of Light; Behavior Of Light; Reflection; Ray Diagrams; Internal Reflection; Refraction; Index Of Refraction; Ray Model Of Light; Mirrors; Focus; Lenses; Lens Aberration; Spherical Aberration; Magnification; Optical Instruments; Cameras; Microscopes; Fiber Optics GOALS When you have mastered the content of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms and use it in an operational definition: light ray optical axis object distance converging optical elements image distance diverging optical elements index of refraction real image reflection coefficient virtual image internal reflection magnification focal point aberrations - chromatic and spherical Ray Diagrams Draw ray diagrams for some common optical systems. Lens and Mirror Equations Apply the basic equations for lenses and mirrors to optical systems with one or two components. Optical Devices Explain, using physical principles, the operation of a reading glass, camera, microscope, and fiber optics. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 16, Travelling Waves. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Light; Light And Optics; Nature And Propagation Of Light; Optical Components Light travels rapidly through free space in a straight line. When light rays are deviated from this straight line motion, either reflection or refraction is usually involved. In this chapter you will be introduced to the reflection properties of plane and curved mirrors plus the refraction properties of single thin lenses and combinations of lenses. The image producing properties of each of these phenomena will be outlined with application examples. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE As you begin to study this chapter, be familiar with these Chapter Goals: Definitions, Ray Diagrams, Lens and Mirror Equations, and Optical Devices. Remember to look at the next section of this for an expanded discussion of each of the terms listed under Definitions. Next, read chapter sections 18.1-18.9. Remember that answers to questions asked in the text are answered in thesecond section of this Chapter. As you read, pay special attention to the many figures which illustrate the properties of reflection, refraction, and image formation. Also, be sure to practice the rules given on page 408 and 412 for drawing ray diagrams for curved mirrors and thin lenses, respectively. Although Section 18.9 is short, the information presented about cameras is important. See the examples section of this for additional information. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and completeSummary Exercises 1-16. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1-4 and completeExercises and Problems 1, 8, 9, 10 and 12. For additional practice with the concepts presented in this chapter, work through the additional problems provided in the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test given at the end of this chapter. If you are unsuccessful with any part, refer to that portion of the text. This study procedure is outlined below. ---------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ---------------------Definitions 18.1,18.4, 1, 2, 3,4, 1,2 1 18.5 5,6,7 Ray Diagrams 18.2,18.3, 8,13,14 8,9 18.6,18.7 Lens & Mirror 18.6,18.7 9,10,11 3 8,9,10,12 Equations Optical Devices 18.8,18.9 12,15,16 4 13,20 -----------------------------------------------------18.10,18.11 14 5,6 14,15 18.12 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Light And Optics; Images; Nature And Propagation Of Light; Behavior Of Light; Reflection; Ray Diagrams; Internal Reflection; Refraction; Index Of Refraction; Ray Model Of Light; Mirrors; Focus; Lenses; Lens Aberration; Spherical Aberration; Magnification; Optical Instruments; Cameras; Microscopes; Fiber Optics LIGHT RAYS Radii of spherical waves. Imaginary lines drawn in the direction of the light wave propagation. These rays are of special help when drawing diagrams for locating images formed by concave mirrors and convex lenses. OBJECT DISTANCE The axial distance from the center of a lens or mirror to the object position. IMAGE DISTANCE The axial distance from the center of a lens or mirror to the image position. INDEX OF REFRACTION Ratio of the velocity of light in a vacuum to the velocity of light in the refractive material. The index number gives a rating of a transparent material's ability to bend light as it transverses from outside to inside the material. Diamond has a high ability to bend light (n = 2.4) whereas water has less ability to bend light (n = 1.33). REFLECTION COEFFICIENT OF LIGHT For normal incidence, the fraction of light intensity reflected. The reflection coefficient depends upon the relative comparison of the index of refractions of the materials on either side of the reflection boundary. INTERNAL REFLECTION (total) When angle of incidence is equal to or greater than critical angle qc, light is totally reflected back into incident medium. This reflection occurs only when light traveling in a medium of high index of refraction is incident on a boundary where a medium of lower index of refraction exists. FOCAL POINT The location on the axis of a lens or mirror where parallel light converges to a point. In the special cases of the convex mirror and the concave lens, the focal points are located at a point on the axis where parallel rays Seem to the observer to have originated. OPTICAL AXIS The line of symmetry through the center of a lens or mirror. The focal point and the center of curvature point are both located on the optical axis. CONVERGING OPTICAL ELEMENTS Optical elements which converge parallel rays of light to a focus and can produce a real image. Both the concave mirror and the double convex lens are of this type. DIVERGING OPTICAL ELEMENTS Optical elements which diverge parallel rays of light and form virtual images. Both the convex mirror and the double concave lens are examples of this type. REAL IMAGE An image formed by a mirror or a lens which can be displayed on a screen. Real light rays actually converge to form this image. VIRTUAL IMAGE An image formed by either a mirror or a lens which can be seen but cannot be displayed on a screen. These images seem to exist but real light rays do not converge to produce them. MAGNIFICATION The ratio of image size to object size. The ratio of the angle subtended by the image with lens to an angle subtended by the object at the near point. The magnification value may be used to predict how large (or small) an image will appear in relation to the original object. CHROMATIC ABERRATION The effect produced by the dependence of focal length on the frequency (color) of light. This effect is mainly of concern with lenses. As light of a different color (wavelength) is bent by the lens, different colors are bent by different amounts. Thus the focal length will be different for different colors. SPHERICAL ABERRATION The effect resulting in different focal lengths for off-axis rays when incident on spherical lenses or mirror surfaces. Even for a lens which is perfectly spherical, a true focal point will be difficult to produce. Since rays bent by the outer edges of the lens or mirror are bent more than rays along the optical axis, these rays will be influenced more. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Light And Optics; Answers; Nature And Propagation Of Light; Magnifying Glasses; Microscopes; Lenses; Mirrors; Types Of Mirrors; Refraction; Index Of Refraction; Answers; ; Optical Components; Cameras; Microscopes; Reflection; Wavelength; Geometric; Optics SECTION 18.2 Straight-Line Wave Propagation and Ray Diagrams Let us draw your attention to the relative wavelengths of sound waves and light waves. Typical audible sounds have wavelength of the order of 1 meter. The wavelength of typical visible light is 5 x 10-7 m. So sound waves are about 10 million times as long as light waves. Consider the properties of waves discussed in Chapter 16 and propose various phenomena that might occur because of the great difference in wavelength between sound and light. SECTION 18.6 Reflection from Spherical Mirrors You will notice that is only for the case shown in Figure 18.11 (a) do the actual rays pass through the image and the image is located on the object side of the mirror. Hence, only the image in (a) is a real image and can be shown on a screen. For both (b) and (c) of Figure 18.11, the images are behind the mirror. The rays must be extended behind the mirror to intersect at the location of the image. A virtual image cannot be shown on a screen, but must be viewed through an optical system, such as the human eye, capable of constructing an image from the rays that appear to come from the virtual image. SECTION 18.7 Lenses The power of a lens to refract and focus rays depends upon the ratio of the index of refraction of the lens to the index of refraction of the surrounding medium. If the index of refraction of the media is increased then the focusing power of the lens is decreased. The focal length of the lens is lengthened. SECTION 18.8 Magnifier or Reading Glass Examples: 1. You can use Equation 18.14 for calculating the magnification of a typical reading glass for a person with a near point 25 cm from the person's eye. M = 1 + 25 (cm) / f (cm) = 1 + 25/10 = 3.5 How is the magnification changed if your near point is 15 cm? 2. You can use Equation 18.14 to find the focal length of a lens if you know the magnification. M1 = 1 + 25/f; so f = 25/(M-1) = 25/7 = 3.6 An experimental way to determine the focal length of a lens is to measure the distance from the lens to a real image of a distance object. Use Equation 18.13 to justify this experimental procedure. How distant must the object be to determine the focal length within ñ 10% using this method? SECTION 18.9 Cameras The total energy that enters a camera lens and falls on the film is proportional to the product of the lens area, the light intensity and the time; Energy = Area x Intensity x Time f - number = focal length / diameter of lens aperture Area = p/4 (diameter)2 =p/4 x (f.1./(f - no.))2 The area is proportional to the inverse square of the f - number. Table of Values f - no. 1.4 2.0 2.8 4 5.6 8 11 16 22 103 x inverse 510 250 130 63 32 16 8.3 3.9 2.1 square of f-no. To keep the total energy constant the product of the area and the exposure time must be held constant. Time = constant / (inverse sq. of the f-no.) = constant ¥ (f-no.)2 If an exposure time of 1/100 of a second is correct for an f - number of 1.4, then the approximate exposure table is as below f-number 1.4 2.0 2.8 4 5.6 8 11 16 22 exposure .01 .02 .04 .08 .16 .32 .61 1.26 2.42 Hence, the exposure time doubles each f - number, or the energy per unit area is decreased by 50% each time. SECTION 18.11 The Compound Microscope The image you see in a microscope is enlarged, inverted, and virtual. You cannot show a microscope image on a screen without adding an additional lens to make a real image on a screen. In order to photograph a microscope image you need to use a camera with a focusing lens on it. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Lenses; Mirrors; Types Of Mirrors; Types Of Lenses; Thin Lenses; Ray Diagrams; Magnification; Light And Optics; Focus; Optical Components; Algebra; Geometric Optics LENS AND MIRROR EQUATIONS 1. An object is placed a distance equal to twice the focal length in front of (a) a diverging spherical mirror and (b) a diverging spherical lens. Locate the image in each case. Characterize the image and compute the magnification. What Data Are Given? Two different optical elements: a diverging (convex) mirror and a diverging (concave) lens. According to the sign convention given in the text, both of them will have negative focal lengths, say - f. What Data Are Implied? The conditions are assumed to be appropriate for Equations (18.8) and (18.13) to be used. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The basic physics of geometric optics was used to derive the equations for this problem. What Equations Are to be Used? 1/p + 1/q = 1/f (18.8 or 18.13) m = -q/p (18.6 or 18.9) Algebraic Solution p = 2f; then if f is a positive number 1/2f + 1/q = 1/-f; 1/q = -1/f - 1/2f = (-2 -1)/2f q = -2f/3; so q is virtual and less than f. m = -(-2f/3)/2f = 1/3; positive m indicates an upright, virtual image Ray Diagram Solutions See Fig. Thinking About the Answer Even though these two different optical elements give the same results, notice the difference in the location of the image. In one case the image is behind the optical element and in the other case the image is in front of the optical element. If you have a chance in a laboratory experiment, compare these two optical elements by using them to view different objects. 2. Two thin lenses each of focal length +0.20 m are 0.20 m apart. An object is located 0.40 m left of the left lens. Find the magnification and location of the final image using a ray diagram and appropriate equations. What Data Are Given? The location of the object = 0.40 m. The focal lengths of the two lens = ñ 0.20 m. The distance between the two lens = 0.20 m. What Data Are Implied? The lens equations can be used so the object is appropriate to the sizes of the lenses. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The basic principles of geometric optics are used as given in Equations 18.9 and 18.13. What Equations Are to be Used? 1/p + 1/q = 1/f (18.13) m = -q/p (18.9) Algebraic Solution let f1 = focal length of left lens, f2 = focal length of right lens, d = distance between the lenses, and p1 = object distance from left lens 1/q1 = 1/f1 - 1/p1; q1 = (f1p1)/(p1 - f1) (1) where q1 is the location of the first image. p2 = object distance with respect to the right lens = d - q. then q2 = (f2p2)/(p2 - f2) = f2(d - d1)/(d - q1 - f2) (2) Total magnification = -q1/p1 - q2/p2 = (f1/(p1 - f1)) (f2/(d - q1 - f2)) (3) Numerical Solution q1 = (0.20)(0.40)/(0.40 - 0.20) = 0.40 m thus p2 = 0.20 m - 0.40 m = -0.20 m final image = q2 = ((0.20)(-0.20))/(-0.20 - 0.20) = -0.04/-.40 = 0.1 m to the right of the right lens magnification = (0.20/(0.40 - 0.20)) (0.20/(-0.20 - 0.20)) magnification = 1(0.20/-0.40) = -1/2 Ray Diagram inverted; real: reduced image See Fig. See Fig. It is during the study of light, With mirrors and lenses and sight, That a person can tell, The old wisdom of Snell, His sine law makes the rays bend just right. Thinking About the Answer For multiple lens or mirror problem it is important to pay careful attention to the sign convention used to determine which terms are treated as positive and negative. The use of a ray diagram to check your answer is a helpful technique. See Fig. Oh, the mirror in Tom's new boutique, Can transform even Zorba the Greek! From the fat to the thin, From the neck to the shin, It can make you and me look so sleek! PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Problems; Answers; Evaluations; ; Ray Diagrams; Optical Components; Optical Instruments; Cameras; Magnification; Images; Mirrors; Light And Optics; Geometric Optics 1. An object (represented by the arrow) is placed on the axis in front of a concave mirror as shown below. The focal point is 20 cm. from the mirror and the object is placed at 10 cm. See Fig. a. Calculate the image distance. b. Draw the principal ray diagram to locate the image formed by the lens. c. Describe the image: Is it real or virtual, upright or inverted? Calculate the magnification of this mirror system. 2. A classroom slide projector contains a converging lens of focal length 10.0 cm. It projects an image on a screen that is 2.50 m from the lens. a. What is the distance between the slide and the lens? b. What is the magnification of the image? c. Calculate the width of the image of a slide 35 mm wide formed on the screen. 3. Suppose you have a camera with a 10 cm. focal length. a. What is the diameter of the lens aperture for an F number of 2.8 (f/2.8 setting)? b. With this lens the proper exposure time for a given scene is 1/100 sec. at the setting f/2.8. What would be the exposure time for the same scene at a f/5.6 setting? ANSWERS: See Fig. 1. -20 cm; virtual, upright, larger, m = +2 2. 10.4 cm, 24, 84 cm 3. 3.6 cm, .04 s Chapter Wave Properties of Light (19): 19 Wave Properties of Light Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Light And Optics; Nature And Propagation Of Light; Interference; Diffraction; Dispersion; Polarization; Birefringent Materials; Refraction; Double Refraction; Optical Activity; Fermat's Principle; Coherence; Lasers; Resolution Of Optical Instruments; Gratings; Holography; Thin Film; Wave-Like Nature GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: interference optical path length diffraction optical activity dispersion coherent polarization noncoherent birefringence Application of Wave Properties Explain the physical basis for: thin film colors polarimetry diffraction grating spectrometry holography resolving power of optical systems Problems Involving Wave Properties Solve problems involving interference, diffraction, and polarization. Optical Activity Design an experimental system capable of measuring the optical activity of a solution. Lasers Compare the laser with other light sources in terms of their optical characteristics. PREREQUISITES Before you begin this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 16, Traveling Waves, and Chapter 18, Optical Elements. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Light And Optics; Nature And Propagation Of Light; Behavior Of Light; Wave-Like Nature Under most day-to-day conditions, we see light behave as though it were a wave. Primarily, these wave phenomena include interference, diffraction and polarization. In this chapter, you will be introduced to the quantitative aspects of these phenomena in addition to many applications of these phenomena. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE When you begin to study this chapter, read the following Chapter Goals carefully: Definitions, Applications of Wave Properties, Problems Involving Wave Properties, and Lasers. An expanded discussion of each of the terms listed under Definitions can be found in the next section of this . Next, read text sections 19.1-19.5 and 19.7-19.11 and 19.14. Answers to questions posed in each section are discussed in this chapter, section three. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-8. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1-6 and Exercises and Problems 1-5, 7, and 17. For more work with the concepts of this chapter, see the Examples section of this . Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test provided at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulties with any individual problem, refer to that particular part of the text or this chapter for assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. -------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -------------------Definitions 19.1 Applications of 19.2,19.3,19.4, 1,2 2 1,2 Wave Properties 19.5;19.7,19.8, 19.9,19.10,19.11, and 19.14 Problems 19.3,19.5,19.7, 3,4,5 3,5,6 3,4,5,7, Involving Wave 19.10 6,7,8 17 Properties Lasers 19.13 10 ---------------------------------------------Optical Activity 19.12 9 7 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Interference; Diffraction; Dispersion; Polarization; Birefringent Materials; Optical Activity; Fermat's Principle; Coherence; Light And Optics; Behavior Of Light; Wave-Like Nature; Refraction; Double-Refraction INTERFERENCE The superposition of two or more waves with constant phase differences produces interference. In a case when two waves meet in phase, the interference will be constructive. When the waves meet out-of-phase, the interference will be destructive. DIFFRACTION Occurs if a wave front encounters an object and there results a superposition of wave fronts. Diffraction is the bending of waves around objects. The most common example of diffraction is the spreading out (bending) of a wave which must pass through a narrow opening. DISPERSION A medium will produce a dispersion of waves if the wave velocity is a function of the frequency. As light passes through glass, different wavelengths (frequencies) are slowed by different amounts. Thus the wavelengths do not move the same distance in the exact same amount of time. POLARIZATION The process by which a light wave loses its random orientation of transverse propagation and only a single direction of transverse propagation is allowed. BIREFRINGENCE Property of crystals that have different velocity of light for different directions. This property allows double refraction of light. OPTICAL PATH LENGTH Equals thickness of sample multiplied by index of refraction for wavelength in the sample. More generally, this is the length from source to screen travelled by a light wave. OPTICAL ACTIVITY Phenomenon produced by certain materials that rotate the plane of polarization as light passes through. COHERENT Light emitted from a laser has each wave in phase with the other waves emitted. NONCOHERENT Light emitted from an ordinary incandescent bulb is randomly produced, thus the waves are not in phase. ANSWER TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Interference; Thin Films; Polarization; Light And Optics; Behavior Of Light; Nature And Propagation; Wave-Like Nature; Index Of Refraction SECTION 19.3 Interference One condition necessary for interference between waves is that the frequency be the same for all the waves. Most common light sources emit a wide range of frequencies of light. So it may not be so obvious to the casual observer of natural events that interference occurs. The color patterns of an oil film on the surface of water and of some insect wings can be attributed to interference. Most light sources are polychromatic and noncoherent, so if the light waves are all present in the same region of space, a detector will measure the superposition of all the wave amplitudes. As shown in Figure 19.1, if two equal waves destructively interfere, then the resultant amplitude is zero. Such a case for two traveling waves would not hold true for all directions in space. The energy conservation concept applies to a total system, not just to some individual waves within the system. If the waves are added up over the whole system, then energy is conserved. SECTION 19.4 Effective Optical Path Lengths Since the index of refraction in a vacuum is by definition exactly one, then the error for not correcting for the index of refraction of air is equal to (1.0003 - 1.0000)/1.00 = 33 x 10-4 or 0.03%. That seems like a very small difference, right? But consider the number of complete wavelengths of yellow-green light that extend 1 cm in a vacuum compared to 1 cm of air. The wavelength of yellow-green light is, say 550.06 nm; then 18,180 wavelengths extend for 1.00000 centimeters in a vacuum, but that is 18,185 wavelengths in 1 cm of air, a difference of 5 wavelengths. SECTION 19.5 Thin-Film Interference Patterns The wings of insects can be studied using interference techniques. If you have available a monochromatic source of light whose wavelength you can vary, then you could study the various interference patterns for different wavelengths of light. What results might you expect? SECTION 19.10 Polarization We may construct almost any model for the emission of light from natural objects that we like, but as long as isotropic randomness of microscopic systems is preserved, as seems to be required by the second law of thermodynamics, unpolarized light would be most common from typical emission systems. One interesting way to study polarization effects in your daily environment is to tip your head 90ø while wearing Polaroid sunglasses. With your head in its usual vertical position the plane of polarization of Polaroid sunglasses is vertical to screen out the intense horizontally-polarized reflected light. By tipping your head sideways you permit the horizontally polarized light to reach your eyes. Some strain patterns in automobile windows are observable with Polaroid sunglasses. As shown in Figure 19.13, the fact that Rayleigh scattering is more pronounced for the short wavelength blue light than for red light can be used to explain the redness of sunsets and sunrises. The direct light falling on your eyes from the sun has more of its blue light scattered away so it appears more red than when directly overhead. This is a result of the increased distance the light travels through the earth's atmosphere at sunrise or sunset, see the figure below. See Fig. 19.13. The sunset you see almost daily, Is attributed to Mister Rayleigh. That reddish hue, Comes from blue, That colors the sky, oh so gaily. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Light And Optics; Wave-Like Nature; Interference; Phase Shifts; Index Of Refraction; Wavelength; Diffraction; Gratings; Polarization; Nature And Propagation Of Light; Algebra PROBLEMS INVOLVING WAVE PROPERTIES 1. What wavelengths of light will be most strongly reflected by an oil (noil - 1.40) film 2.80 x 10-7 mm thick (a) floating on water (nwater = 1.33) or (b) on a glass plate with an index of refraction (nglass = 1.50). What Data Are Given? The thickness of the oil film is 2.80 x 10-7 mm. The indices of refraction of the three media, oil, water, and glass are given as 1.40, 1.33, and 1.50 respectively. What Data Are Implied? Assume the angle of incident of the light is 0ø; i.e., the incoming light is perpendicular to the oil interfaces. The most strongly reflected waves are the ones which undergo constructive interference. What Physics Principles Are Involved? This problem uses the ideas of interference and phase shift upon reflection as discussed in Section 19.5 for constructive interference. What Equations Are to be Used? Constructive Interference with no phase shift upon reflection at 2nd surface 2nt = (m/2)l m = 1, 3, 5 (19.5) Constructive interference with a 180ø phase shift upon reflection at both surfaces. 2nt = l/2 (m + 1) m = 1, 3, 5 (1) Algebraic Solutions Note that in going from a region of lower index of refraction to higher index of refraction the reflection wave undergoes a phase change of 180ø or l/2. Case (a) air - oil - water - In this case there is a phase change at the air - oil surface only, thus 2nt = (m/2) l m = 1, 3, 5 (19.5) Case (b) air - oil - glass - In this class there are phase changes at the air - oil and oil glass surfaces, thus 2nt = (l/2)(m + 1) m = 1, 3, 5, ... (1) Numerical Solutions (a) 2(1.40)(2.80 x 10-7) = (l1) / 2 = (3l2) / 2 = (5l3) / 2 = . . . l1 = 1.57 x 10-6 m; l2 = 5.23 x 10-7 m; l3 = 3.14 x 10-7 m; l1 = 1570 nm; l2 = 523 nm; l3 = 314 nm; . . . (b) 2(1.40)(2.80 x 10-7) = l1 = 2l2 = 3l3 = ... l1 = 7.84 x 10-7m; l2 = 3.92 x 10-7 m; l3 = 2.61 x 10-7 m ... l1 = 784 nm; l2 = 392 nm; l3 = 261 nm ... 2. A diffraction grating has 1250 lines per centimeter (a) Over what range of angles will it spread the first order visible spectrum (350 nm to 700 nm)? (b) If you use this grating as a monochromator to produce light of 588 nm, what other wavelengths occur at the same angle? What Data Are Given? The distance between the slits = d = 1 cm/1250 = (10-2 m)/1.25 x 103 = 8.00 x 10-6 m wavelength's range; 350 nm ó l ó 700 nm What Data Are Implied? The problem asks you to calculate the angles of constructive interference from a diffraction grating, see Figure 19.6, assuming normal (90ø) incident light. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The problem uses interference from a diffraction grating as discussed in Section 19.8. What Equation is to be Used? d sin q = ml; m = 1, 2, ... (19.3) Solutions (a) The smallest angle will occur for the smallest wavelength; for first order m = 1 sin qmin = l/d = 350 nm / 8.00 x 10-6 m = (3.5 x 10-7) / (8.0 x 10-6 m) = 4.38 x 10-2 The largest angle will occur for the largest wavelength sin qmax = 700 nm / 8.00 x 10-6 m = (7.0 x 10-7) / (8.0 x 10-6 m) = 8.75 x 10-2 q = 5.0ø So the first order visible spectrum is spread between the angles of 2.5ø and 5.0ø with respect to the incident angle. Compare these angles with the example on p. 439. What accounts for the differences? (b) From Equation 19.3 you can see that the angle q will be the same for all constant products for a given grating. Hence the first order 588 nm light will coincide with second order 294 nm; third order 196 nm; fourth order 147 nm, sixth order 98 nm, seventh order 84 nm; etc. None of these wavelengths are visible, other than 588 nm. However, if you are using a grating monochromator with transducers that have a wider spectral response than the human eye, care must be taken to avoid multiple orders. 3. A lens is used to convert the light emitted from a light bulb into a plane wave of light traveling in the positive x - direction. Three polarizers are arranged along the x - axis with their axes of polarization along the y- axis, 30ø from the y - axis, and 90ø from the y - axis, as shown below. Assume that the intensity before passing through the first polarizer is Io. Find the intensity, amplitude, and direction of polarization at (a) point A, (b) point B, and (c) point C. See Fig. What Data Are Given? The initial intensity Io and the angles of polarization of three polarizers. What Data Are Implied? It is to be assumed that the light at the beginning is unpolarized of intensity Io, associated with an electromagnetic wave of amplitude Eo. What Physics Principles Are Involved? The concepts of polarization as related to a transverse wave of amplitude Eo are needed for this problem. See Section 19.10 and Figure 19.11. What Equations Are to be Used? E = Eocos q (2) IaE2 = Eo2 cos2 q (3) I = Io cos2 q (19.11) Algebraic Solutions (a) The amplitude of the wave is unchanged by an ideal polarizer; so EA = Eo. Since the light at the beginning is completely unpolarized we can resolve it into two components that are right angles to one another. Then half of the intensity at Point A is one-half Io, 1/2 Io. The direction of polarization is parallel to the y - axis. (b) The light now polarized along the y - axis of amplitude Eo and intensity Io/2, comes to the second polarizer oriented 30ø from the y - axis. The amplitude after passing through the second polarizer is Eo cos q or Eo cos 30ø for this case. The intensity is reduced by a factor of cos2 q or cos2 30ø for this case. At Point B: EB = EA cos 30ø = 0.87 Eo IB = IAcos2 30ø = 0.75 IA = 0.38 Io The angle of polarization is 30ø from the x - axis. (c) The light is now polarized at an angle of 30ø to the y - axis, with amplitude 0.87 Eo and intensity 0.75 Io. It now comes to a polarizer at an angle of 60ø to its plane of polarization. So the amplitude at point C is Eb cos2 qBC or EB cos 60ø or 0.87 Eo cos 60ø. The intensity at Point C = IB cos2qBC = IB cos2 60ø At Point C; E = 0.87 Eo cos 60ø = 0.44 Ec IC = IB cos260ø = 0.38 Io (0.25) = 0.10 Io the polarization is parallel to the z - axis. Thinking About the Answer Notice that the first and third polarizers are at right angles to one another. If they were the only polarizers in the system NO light would pass through the system. The insertion of a third polarizer between the two crossed polarizers allows some light to pass through the system. In this case, it is at an angle of 30ø with respect to the first polarizer and 10% of the initial light gets through the system. Is that the maximum amount you can get through such a system? What is the best angle for the middle polarizer in order to obtain the maximum intensity through the system? When dealing with Rayleigh's criteria, The students displayed mass hysteria. For tests they had cram'da, One point two times lambda, And such terms as hypermetropia. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Problems; Answers; Evaluations; Questions; Phase Shifts; Reflection; Diffraction; Coherence; Lasers; Gratings; Nature And Propagation Of Light; Wave-Like Nature 1. A thin air wedge is formed from two microscope slides and a thin piece of masking tape. The wedge is illuminated with green light. See Fig. Will the wedge at point A appear dark (black) or bright (green)? Explain your answer by treating the "wedge" as a thin film. 2. If one looks at a light bulb filament through a piece of sheer curtains the pattern seen is that of a diffraction grating. The first order pattern is centered at 0.01 radians with respect to the central maximum. If a wavelength of 500 nm is used, calculate the thread spacing in the sheer curtains. 3. How does the light from a laser source differ from the light emitted by an ordinary source, like an incandescent bulb? ANSWERS: 1. At A, wedge appears dark. Light entering wedge undergoes 180ø phase change and is reflected. At bottom surface, reflected light undergoes no phase change. Therefore, since the optical path approaches zero, the two reflections will be 180ø out of phase and produce destructive interference. 2. 5 x 10-3 cm 3. Light from ordinary sources is incoherent, or not produced in a constant phase relationship. Emitted light is randomly produced in an incandescent bulb. Normal light sources (white) contain many wavelengths which taken together produce a nearly white color. Laser light is both monochromatic (single wavelength or color) and coherent (produced with a single phase relationship). See Fig. Chapter Human Vision (20): STUDY GUIDE 20 Human Vision Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Biology; Anatomy And Physiology; Sensory Systems; Optical Systems; Eye; Lenses; Study Of Contemporary Life GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Human Vision Characterize the physical parameters that are significant in human vision. Visual Defects Explain the causes and corrections for the visual defects of myopia, hypermetropia, presbyopia and astigmatism. Characteristics of Vision Define the following terms: visual acuity accommodation scotopic vision dichromat photopic vision Corrective Lenses Solve problems involving visual defects and their corrections using lenses. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 18, Optical Elements, and Chapter 19, Wave Properties of Light. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Biology; Anatomy And Physiology; Sensory Systems; Optical Systems; Eye; Study Of Contemporary Life; Lenses In the simplest sense, the human eye is a single lens, refractive system with a retina as a screen. But in practice, the operation of the eye is amazing. In this chapter, you will learn about many of the intricate and delicate operations performed by eye parts. In addition, optically defective eyes will be classified and corrected using additional converging and/or diverging eye glasses. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE As you begin to study this chapter, become familiar with the following Chapter Goals: Human Vision, Visual Defects, Characteristics of Vision and Corrective Lenses. Please note that the terms listed under the goal ofCharacteristics of Vision are discussed under the first section of this , Definitions. Next, read text sections 20.120.7. Answers to the questions you encounter in your reading can be found in the second section of this chapter. Next, turn to the end of the chapter and read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-10. Check your answers carefully with those provided. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1 and 2, and completeExercises and Problems 1, 2, 5, and 12. For additional work with the concepts presented in this chapter, see the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to test your understanding of the important parts of this chapter. Attempt the Practice Test provided at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulties with any of the individual parts of the test, see that part of the text or refer to this chapter. This study procedure is outlined below. ----------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ----------------------Human Vision 20.1,20.2,20.3 1 1 1 Visual Defects 20.3,20.4 2,3 Characteristics 20.1, 20.2,20.5, 4-9 of Vision 20.6, 20.7 Corrective 20.4 10 2 2,5,12 Lenses DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Resolving Power; Eye; Optical Systems; Sensory Systems; Biology; Colors; Focus; Anatomy And Physiology; Study Of Contemporary Life VISUAL ACUITY OF THE EYE The minimum separation between two equidistant point objects that can be resolved as separate objects. The resolving power of the eye allows a driver to detect that an oncoming light source is actually two headlights of an approaching automobile. SCOPTIC VISION Vision of the dark-adapted eye. The rod cells of the retina are more concentrated on the periphery around the fovea and are more sensitive to low light intensity. PHOTOPIC VISION Vision of bright-light adapted eye. The cone cells of the retina are more concentrated in the center fovea and are most sensitive to high light intensity. ACCOMMODATION The ability of the eye to focus on objects between the near point and far point of the eye. The maximum change in power of the eye as it focuses on distant objects and then on near objects. The accommodation is measured in diopters and is produced by the change in power of the eye lens. DICHROMAT Color vision resulting from only two of the three pigments required for normal color vision. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Resolving Power; Eye; Rayleigh Criterion; Optical Systems; Biology; Sensory Systems; Ear; Anatomy And Physiology; Auditory Systems; Study Of Contemporary Life; Systems In Organisms; Wavelength; Frequency; Perception SECTION 20.5 The Receptive Eye The relative sensitivity of the human eye is shown as normalized to the most sensitive wavelength in figure 20.4. You will notice that the eye is sensitive to light that is within about 40% of the most sensitive wavelength. Let us compare that to the frequency response of the human ear. Ear Eye Lowest frequency 2x101Hz 4.3x1014Hz Most sensitive 2x103Hz 5.5x1014Hz Highest frequency 2x104Hz 7.5x1014Hz Compared to Figure 20.4 the relative sensitivity of the human eye is a broad peak with a maximum at 2000 Hz. The ear stretches over three orders of magnitude in its frequency response! Notice also that monochromates are able to function in our society with little loss in information input. A person who could hear only one frequency would appear to have great difficulty with human communication. SECTION 20.6 The Perceptive Eye If you use the Raleigh criterion for acuity of the human eye, assuming an iris size of 3mm and light of 550mm wavelength, the angular separation between just resolvable sources of light is about 2x10-4 radians. This is a larger angle, than the angle between the cones. For some conditions human vision seems to be Rayleigh limited which changes only a small amount for visible light. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Optical Instruments; Lens Aberration; Correction Methods; Thin Lenses; Glasses; Lenses; Worked Examples; Eye; Light And Optics; Algebra CORRECTIVE LENSES 1. An elderly person can see distinctly with unaided vision only objects between 64cm and 540cm from her eyes. What kind of eyeglasses does she require? For what distances does she not see objects clearly when she is wearing her spectacles? What data are given? Persons near point = 64 cm. Persons far point = 540 cm. What data are implied? The use of simple lens equations are assumed to be adequate. There is an implication that the person needs bifocal eye glasses since both her near point and far points are not the normal values of 25 cm. and infinity. What physics principles are involved? This problem is just an additional application of the physics principles discussed in Section 20.4. What equations are to be used? 1/p + 1/q = 1/f (18.13) Solutions In order to compensate for the person's inability to see near objects she needs to have a lens that will put the virtual, upright image of an object at 25cm at her near point of 64cm. 1/25 + 1/-64 = 1/f; so f = +41 cm. To compensate for her farsightedness she needs a lens of +2.4 diopters. To compensate for her nearsightedness, she needs a lens that will make objects at infinity appear to be at 540cm. This clearly demands a diverging lens because an object a long distance from a converging lens has an image at its focal point. So the image will be a virtual image 1/ì - 1/q = -(1/f) 1/ì - 1/5.4m = 1/f; f = -5.4m She needs a lens of -0.19 diopters. In general such eyeglasses are composed of a lower portion of positive power and an upper portion of negative power. For objects farther away from her than 38 cm, the positive power portion of her lens will give her a virtual image outside of her far point of 540 cm. So for all objects between 38 cm and 64 cm she will not see them clearly when she is wearing her spectacles. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Questions; Problems; Answers; Eye; Optical Systems; Sensory Systems; Anatomy And Physiology; Optical Instruments; Glasses; Lens Aberrations; Biology 1. The block diagram below represents the various parts of the human eye. See Fig. Identify the parts of the eye involved in each of the systems A, B, and C above and describe the functions of each in processing light information. Parts of the Eye Function A. B. C. 2. A person, looking at an eye chart that contains an arrangement of lines similar to those at right, finds that some of the lines appear blurred to him or of unequal intensity. See Fig. A. What visual defect does this person probably have? B. What is the usual cause of this defect? C. How can this defect be corrected? 3. Typical optical data for an elderly man is shown below. See Fig. A. What is the power of accommodation of this man's eye without glasses? B. What is the power of accommodation of his optical system, with glasses? C. What type of eyeglasses does the man wear? D. Calculate the power of these eyeglasses. ANSWERS: 1. A) Cornea, lens, muscles (refracts and focus of light on retina, muscles contract changing curvature and power of eye lens) B) Iris (adjusts the opening of the eye thus controlling the intensity of light admitted) C) Rods & Cones - Retina (transducers which convert light energy to electrical nerve impulses which are imparted to the brain via the optic nerve) 2. Astigmatism, nonuniform curvature of the cornea, using a cylindrical lens which is produced to compensate for the defect in curvature of the cornea. 3. .93 diopters, 4 diopters, bifocals,-.4 diopters and +2.7 diopters Chapter Electrical Properties of Matter (21): to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications: 21 Electrical Properties of Matter Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Electrostatics; Electricity And Magnetism; Electric Fields; Potential Difference; Capacitance; Dielectrics; Capacitors; Equipotential Lines; Electric Potential Energy; Electric Potential; Electric Charge; Charges Moving In Electric Fields; Gradients; Applications GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: dielectric constant equipotential surfaces electrical field dipole potential gradient capacitance of a capacitor potential difference Coulomb's Law Apply the basic model of an electrostatic field, and use Coulomb's law to calculate the force on one, two, or three given point charges. Potential Gradient Apply the gradient to electrical field phenomena. Moving Charged Particles Explain the motion of charged particles in an electric field. Capitance Solve capacitance and capacitor problems, including the use of a capacitor as a means of storing electrical energy. Applications of Electrostatics List a number of applications of electrostatic principles to daily living and to medical equipment. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 2, Unifying Approaches, Chapter 4, Forces and Newton's Laws, Chapter 5, Energy, and Chapter 9, Transport Phenomena. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Electricity And Magnetism; Electrostatics; Instructions The fundamental laws of electricity are abstract. As you look at this chapter you will find reference to "point" charges and "fields." These and other strange ideas have been introduced by scientists in an effort to explain the action in and around groups of charged particles interacting among themselves and with other groups of charges. Although some of the concepts seem difficult, most will be important throughout your study of electricity (e.g., force, work and voltage). SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Begin your study of this chapter by reading the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Coulomb's Law, Moving Charged Particles and Capacitance. In the first section of this you will find a discussion of each of the terms listed under the goal of Definitions. Next, read text sections 21.1-21.4, 21.8 and 21.9. Be careful to note the vector nature of the electrical force as illustrated in the Examples on page 476, whereas electrical potential is a scalar quantity see Figure 21.5. Questions you encounter in your reading of the above-mentioned sections will be answered in the second section of this chapter. Now turn to the end of the chapter and read the Chapter Summary and completeSummary Exercises 1, 4, 5, 7-11, and 14-16. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1-6 and Exercises and Problems 2, 4, 5, 8, 10, and 15. For additional work with the concepts introduced in this chapter, see the Examples section of this . Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test provided in the last section of this chapter. When you finish the entire test, check your answers carefully against those given. If you have difficulty with any part of the test, refer back to a specific portion of the text or to a part of this chapter for additional assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. ---------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ---------------------Definitions 21.1,21.4 1,4,5 1 Coulomb's Law 21.2 9,10,&11 Moving Charged 21.3 14&15 2 2,4,5,10 Particles Capacitance 21.8,21.9 7,8,&16 3,4,5,6 8,15 Applications of 21.5,21.7 17 17,18 Electrostatics DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; Farads; Electrostatics; Electricity And Magnetism; Electric Fields; Potential Difference; Capacitance; Dielectrics; Capacitors; Equipotential Lines; Electric Potential Energy; Electric Potential DIELECTRIC CONSTANT The ratio of the permitivity of a material to permitivity of a vacuum. Materials with high dielectric constants (like water), tend to be highly polar molecules. Thus when an external electric field is established, the material becomes polarized and acts to reduce the overall field within the substance. ELECTRIC FIELD A property of space defined as the electric force per unit charge at each point. If the electric field is given for each point in space surrounding a charge distribution, the force on any single charge brought into that region can be found by multiplying the magnitude of the charge by the electric field value. The direction will be in the direction of the field if the charge is positive. POTENTIAL GRADIENT The rate of change of potential in space; a vector quantity oriented in the direction of maximum change of potential. The potential gradient is identical in magnitude to the electric field in a region of space. POTENTIAL DIFFERENCE If a charge is forced to move through a region of space against an electrical force, the work done in Joules per coulomb of charge is defined as the potential difference in volts. If a +1 coulomb charge is moved through a battery from the negative terminal to the positive terminal and 12 joules of work are done, then the battery has a potential difference of 12 volts. EQUIPOTENTIAL SURFACE The surface defined by constant potential coordinates. Moving a charge along a line or surface of euipotential requires no work because no net voltage change occurs. DIPOLE Equal but opposite charge distributions separated by some small distance. CAPACITANCE Defined as the ratio of charge to voltage for a system of conductors 1 farad = coulomb/volt. Any arrangement of surfaces capable of storing electrical charges. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Answers; Electricity And Magnetism; Electrostatics; Charges In Electric Fields; Electric Forces; Electric Fields; Newton's Second Law; Worked Examples; Electrical Potential; Electric Potential Energy; Equipotential Lines; Electrophoresis; SECTION 21.3 Electrical Forces Acting on Moving Charges Examples-1. On particles of charge -e in an upward vertical electric field E the force is acting downward. The downward force has a constant magnitude and direction, eE downward. Since there is no horizontal force on the charges, if they enter the electric field with a constant horizontal velocity, they will continue to maintain their constant horizontal motion. In addition they will feel a constant downward force. To what other type of motion is this similar? If you combine Newton's Second Law with the equations given in Section 3.8 what do you notice? The motion of this particle in this electric field is exactly like idealized projectile motion of an object near the surface of the earth except the gravitational force is increased by the addition of the downward electric force of magnitude eE. The path of the projectile is a downward curved parabola. This is a good place to show the relative strength of the electric field when compared to the gravitational field near the surface of the earth. Let us consider two of the so-called fundamental particles, the electron and the proton. The electron is attributed a charge of - 1.6 x 10-19C and a mass of 9.1 x 10-31 kg. The proton is ascribed a charge of +1.6 x 10-19C and a mass of 1.7 x 10-27 kg. A very weak electric field is of the order of 1 V/m. Right now you are probably seated a few meters from a 110 volt electric line so you are sitting in an electric field on the order of 10 to 50 volts/meter, which you are not able to detect. So a low field of 1 V/m is well below a level of human detection, nevertheless the electric force on either an electron or a proton in such a field is many times larger than the gravitational force on these particles, for the electron Fe/Fg = qE/mg = ((1.6 x 10-19C)(1 V/m))/((9.1 x 10-31kg) x (9.8 m/s2)) = (1.6 x 10-19N) / (8.9 x 10-30N) Fe/Fg = 1.8 x 1010 (1) The electric force is 18 billion times the gravitational force acting on an electron in a weak electric field near the surface of the earth! for the proton Fe/Fg = qE/mg = ((1.6 x 10-19C)(1 V/m))/((1.7 x 10-27kg) x (9.8 m/s2) = (1.6 x 10-19N) / (1.7 x 10-26N) Fe/Fg = 9.4 x 106 (2) The electric force on a proton in a weak electric field near the surface of the earth is almost 10 million times the gravitational force on the proton! So you can see why it is possible to neglect the gravitational aspects of problems that involve the electric forces on fundamental particles. The gravitational forces on fundamental particles are so small for experiments carried out on the surface of the earth that they can be neglected. 2. The speed of migration of a constituent of a fluid in an electric field will be determined by such properties as the electric charge of the constituent, the mass of the constituent, and the resistance to flow of the constituent through the fluid. SECTION 21.4 Electric Potential Question - Let us begin by assuming that there exists an equipotential surface Vo and at some point A on that surface there is an electric field (vector)E which is not perpendicular to the surface at point A. Then we can resolve (vector)E into two components, one component Eê which is perpendicular to the surface and ET which is tangential to the surface. The tangential component of E is able to do work on an electric charge and move it from point A to another point along the surface, say point B. Since the tangential component of (vector)E did work on the charge to move it from point A to point B, then point B must have a different electric potential than point A. But A and B are both points on the same equipotential surface. We have reached a contradiction. Something we have assumed to be true must not be true. The item that turns out to be false is the existence of a non-zero tangential component (vector)E. Therefore ET must be zero, so (vector)E is perpendicular to the equipotential surface. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Electricity And Magnetism; Electrostatics; Electric Forces; Coulombs Law; Vectors; Algebra; Electric Fields; Electric Potential; Potential Difference; Gradients; Capacitors; Circuits Containing Capacitors; Conservation Of Energy; Conservation Of Charge; Capacitance COULOMB'S LAW 1. Find the magnitude and direction of the total force acting on a +4.0C point charge at the origin if a +16.0C point charge is located at 4.0 m along the x-axis and a +9.0C charge is located at 3.0 m along the y-axis. What data are given? The numerical values of this problem are shown in the sketch below at points 1, 2, and 3: See Fig. 21-1. What data are implied? The three charges are point charges, i.e. have no spatial dimensions, so we can use Coulomb's law to calculate the force between any two of the charges. Then the total force on any particle can be found by superposition. What physics principles are involved? We need to use Coulomb's law to find the vector forces between the charges. Then we will use the rules of vector algebra to add the individual vectors to find the total force. What equations are to be used? Coulomb's Law (vector)F12 = (kq1q2)/ (r2) r12 (21.5) Algebraic Solutions Let us begin by finding the total force acting on a charge Q2 located at point 2. (vector)F12 = (kQ1Q2)/ (r12)2 r12 (negative y-direction) (3) (vector)F32 = (kQ3Q2)/ (r32)2 r34 (negative x-direction) (4) (vector)F2 = (vector)F12 + (vector)F32. This is in case the two vectors (vector)F12 and (vector)F32 are at an angle q = 90ø with respect to one another. So we must use the vector algebra to add them. The magnitude of F2 = (SQR RT)(F122 + F322) if q2 = angle of F2 downward from the negative x- axis; then tan q2 = ((kQ1Q2)/(r12)2)/ (kQ3Q2)/(r32)2) =Q1(r32)2/Q3(r12)2 (5) See Fig. 21-2 Now let us find the total force on a charge Q1 located at point 1 inFigure 21-1 above. (vector)F21 = (KQ2Q1)/ (r21)2 r21 (positive y-direction) (6) (vector)F31 = (KQ3Q1)/ (r31)2 r32 (an angle b from the positive y-axis) (7) See Fig. 21-3. The two forces acting on charge Q1 are not at right angles, but we can use the knowledge of force components to add them together. The forces (vector)F21 and (vector)F31 in Figure 21-3 at equivalent to the following three forces: See Fig. 21-4. Thus the magnitude of the total force = (SQR RT)((F31sin b)2 + (F21 + F31cos b)2) (8) if q1 is the angle from the positive y-axis then tan q1 = (F31sinb)/(F21 + F31cosb) = [((kQ3Q1)/(r31)2) x sinb]/ (kQ2Q1/(r21)2 + kQ3Q1/(r31)2 cosb) tan q1 = (Q3 sinb/(r31)2) / ((Q2/(r21)2) + (Q3 cosb/r31)2) This expression can be rewritten to eliminate the angle b if you wish. The size of b is determined by the distances r21 and r31 in the Figure 21-1, so sinb = r31/((SQR RT)(r312 + r212) and cosb = r21/((SQR RT)(r312 + r212) These expressions can be put into Equation (9) to find tan q1 in terms of Q2, Q3, r21, and r31. Notice how messy the algebra becomes for forces which are not at right angles or colinear to one another. In a similar way we can find the total force of the charge Q3. We resolve the forces into components, add the components, and use vector addition to find the magnitude of the total force. We use trigonometry to determine the direction of the total force. At this point we think it is more instructive to proceed with the actual numerical solution than to go farther with the more general algebraic solutions. Numerical Solutions Before we begin to add the forces let us calculate all the forces and their directions using Coulomb's Law: Force on charge Q1 from Q2 = (vector)F21 = ((9.0 x 109Nm2/C)(9.0C)(4.0C))/(3.0m)2 r21 (vector)F21 = 3.6 x 1010 N in the positive y-direction. Force on charge Q2 from Q1 = (vector)F12 = 3.6 x 1010N in the negative y-direction Force on charge Q3 from Q2 = (vector)F23 = ((9.0 x 109Nm2/C)(16.0C)(4.0C))/(4.0m)2 (vector)F23 = 3.6 x 1010N in the positive y-direction Force on charge Q2 from Q3 = (vector)F32 = 3.6 x 1010N in the negative y-direction The distance between charges Q1 and Q3 = (SQR RT)((3.0)2 + (4.0)2) = 5.0m Force on Q1 from Q3 = (vector)F31 = ((9.0 x 109Nm2/C)(16.0C)(9.0C))/(5.0m)2 N (vector)F31 = 5.2 x 1010N at an angleb from the positive y-axis where tan b = 4.0/3.0; b = 53ø Force on Q3 from Q1 = (vector)F13 = 5.2 x 1010 at an angle b from the negative y axis, or an angle a from the positive x-axis; a = 37ø. See Fig. 21-5. Now we can use vector addition and trigonometry to find the numerical values for the magnitudes of the three total forces (vectors)F1,F2 and F3 and the three angles q1, q2, and q3. Magnitude of (vector) F1 = (SQR RT) ((3.6 x 1010N + 5.2 x 1010N cos53ø)2 + (5.2 x 1010N sin 53ø)2)) = (SQR RT) ((3.6 x 1010 + 3.1 x 1010)2 + (4.2 x 1010)2 N) = (SQR RT)((6.7 x 1010)2 + (4.2 x 1010)2) = (SQR RT)(6.72 + 4.22) x 1010N F1 = 7.9 x 1010N angle q1 = tan-1 (4.2 x 1010/6.7 x 1010) = 32ø Magnitude of (vector)F2 = (SQR RT)((3.6 x 1010)2 + (3.6 x 1010)2) = 5.1 x 1010N angle q2 = tan-1 (3.6 x 1010/3.6 x 1010) = 45ø Magnitude of (vector)F3 = (SQR RT) ((3.6 x 1010 + 5.2 x 1010cos37ø)2 + (5.2 x 1010sin37ø)2) = (SQR RT)((3.6 x 1010 + 4.2 x 1010)2 + (3.1 x 1010)2) = (SQR RT)((6.8 x 1010)2 + (3.1 x 1010)2) = (SQR RT)(6.82 + 3.12) x 1010N F3 = 7.5 x 1010N q2 = tan-1 (3.1 x 1010/ 6.8 x 1010) = 25ø Thinking about the answer Consider the three charges as rigidly attached to one another by massless rods so that they form a rigid body. What will the total force on the body be from the sum of the forces (vectors)F1, F2, and F3? Can you think of a way to answer this question without using algebraic or numerical computations? (Hint: See Section 4.2 in the textbook) POTENTIAL GRADIENT 2. Use the potential gradient concept to estimate the sizes of the environmental electric fields in which you live, e.g. under an electric blanket, in a typical room of a house, under a high voltage (380,000 volts) transmission line. What data are given? Not much, three typical situations, with the voltage given in only one; Vtransmission lines = 380,000V. What data are implied? In the United States of America, except for certain high power electrical devices, all the electric potentials in buildings and homes are 110 volts. You need to know typical distances to calculate gradients. You are only a few centimeters from an electric blanket, a few meters from the electrical wires in a house, and a few tens of meters from a transmission line. What physics principles are involved? The basic concept of the electric fields as the gradient of the electric potential is all that is needed for this problem, see Section 21.4 in the textbook. What equation is to be used? E = -DV/Ds (21.23) Solutions Since we are only interested in the size of the electric field we will omit the negative sign. Electric Field under an Electric Blanket ÷ 110V / 7cm ÷ 20 V/cm ÷ 2000 V/m Electric Field in a House ÷ 110V / 3m ÷ 40 V/m Electric Field under a Transmission Line ÷ 380,000V / 10m ÷ 38000 V/m Thinking about the answers You see that you are always living in some manmade electric fields. What are the effects of these fields on living organisms? Little is really known. This is presently an area of active research. Why don't you plan a career to study this topic? CAPITANCE 3. A 3.0mF capacitor and a 6.0mF capacitor are connected in parallel and that combination is connected in series to a 4.0mF capacitor. This group of three capacitors is connected across a 24 V battery. a) Draw the circuit, labeling all the elements by their specified values. b) Calculate the equivalent capacitance of the 3.0mF and 6.0mF capacitors. c) Calculate the equivalent capacitance of the combination of three capacitors. d) Calculate the voltage across each capacitor and e) Calculate the energy stored in each capacitor. What data are given? This question can be answered by answering part (a) of this question. So let us draw the circuit diagram and label the parts. See Fig. 21-6. What data are implied? It is assumed that these are ideal capacitors that obey the conditions necessary for the deviations in Section 21.9 of the textbook to be valid. What physics principles are involved? The concepts of conservation of energy and conservation of electric charge can be used to derive equations for combining various combinations of capacitors. What equations are to be used? For a general system of three capacitors. Combined in Series: Vtotal = V1 + V2 + V3 (21.31) 1/Ctotal = 1/C1 + 1/C2 + 1/C3 (21.33) Qtotal = Q1 = Q2 = Q3 (21.30) Combined in Parallel: Vtotal = V1 = V2 = V3 (21.34) Ctotal = C1 + C2 + C3 (21.36) Qtotal = Q1 + Q2 + Q3 (21.35) Energy Stored in a Capacitor: E = 1/2 CV2 (21.39) Algebraic Solution Let us begin by combining capacitors C2 and C3 and replace them by one capacitor C23, then C23 = C2 + C3 (11) The circuit then looks as follows: See Fig. 21-7. We can combine C1 and C23 to obtain C 1/C = 1/C1 + 1/C23; C = (C1C23)/(C1 + C23) (12) V = V1 + V23 (13) The total charge Q is given by Q = VC = (V (C1C23))/(C1 + C23) (14) The separate charges Q1 and Q23 will be equal to Q since C1 and C23 are in series. V1 = Q1/C1 = Q/C1 = VC/C1 = VC23/(C1 + C23) (15) V23 = Q23/C23 = Q/C23 = VC/C23 = VC1/(C1 + C23) (16) The energy stored in the two capacitors can also be calculated E1 = 1/2 C1V12 = (C1V2(C23)2)/ (2(C1 + C23)2) (17) E23 = 1/2 C23V232 = (C23V2(C1)2)/ (2(C1 + C23)2) (18) We have completed the calculations we can make for the simplified circuit shown in Figure 21-7. We can now complete the calculations for the more complex circuit given in the problem. Since none of the values we have calculated for C1 will change if we consider the two parallel capacitors C2 and C3 which are equivalent to C23 we need not do any further calculations for C1. We do need to find the charge and energy stored for both C2 and C3. Since C2 and C3are in parallel we already know the voltage across them. V2 = V3 = V23 = (VC1)/(C1 + C23) (19) where C23 = C2+C3 from Equation (11). The charge on each capacitor is given by: Q2 = C2V2 = (C2VC1)/(C1 + C23) (20) Q3 = C3V3 = (C3VC1)/(C1 + C23) (21) The energy stored in each capacitor can be calculated also E2 = 1/2 C2(V2)2 = 1/2 C2 x (V2(C1)2)/ ((C1 + C23)2) (22) E3 = 1/2 C3(V3)2 = 1/2 C3 x (V2(C1)2)/ (C1 + C23))2 (23) We are finished. We have an algebraic solution for every part of this question: part (b) is answered by Equation (11); part (c) is answered by Equation (12): part (d) is answered by Equations (15) and (19); part (e) is answered by Equations (17), (22) and (23). Numerical Solutions part (b) Equivalent capacitance of 6.0mF and 3.0mF in parallel C23 = (3.0)+(6.0)mF = 9.0mF part (c) Equivalent capacitance of all three capacitors 1/C = 1/C1 + 1/C23 = 1/(4.0mF) + 1/(9.0 mF); C = 2.8mF part (d) Q = CV = (2.8mF)(24V) = 6.7 x 10-5C V1 = Q/C1 = (6.7 x 10-5)/4 F = 17V V23 = 7.4V = V2 = V3 part (e) E1 = 1/2C1(V1)2 = 1/2(4.0)(17)2 = 5.8 x 10-4 joules E2 = 1/2C2(V2)2 = 1/2(6.0)(7.4)2 = 1.6 x 10-4 joules E3 = 1/2C3(V3)2 = 1/2(3.0)(7.4)2 = 8.2 x 10-5 joules Thinking about the answers You will notice how keeping two significant figures in each of the answers leads to small peculiarities in some of the answers. We know that V1 and V23 should add up to 24V. If you add the numbers calculated separately you must add 17V and 7.4 Volts. How can you check the answer to part (e)? The total energy in the three capacitors should be equal to the sum of the three energies. Etotal = 1/2CV2 = 1/2 (2.8mF)(24V)2 = 8.0 x 10-4 joules add up the values obtained in part (e) 5.8 x 10-4 + 1.6 x 10-4 + 0.82 x 10-4 = 8.2 x 10-4 joules The small difference of 2 parts in 80 arises from the use of two significant figures in the calculations. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: Problems; Answers; Questions; Evaluations; Electricity And Magnetism; ; Electric Forces; Electric Fields; Coulomb's Law; Electrical Potential ; Electric Potential Energy; Potential Difference; Capacitors; Capacitances; Circuits Containing Capacitors; Field Lines 1. A proton (qp = +1.6 x 10-19 coulomb) and an electron (qe = -1.6 x 10-19 coulombs) are stationary and are separated by a distance of 5 x 10-10 meters (typical hydrogen atom separation). See Fig. A. Calculate the magnitude and the direction of the force exerted on both the proton and the electron due to the presence of the other. Show the direction of both of these forces on thediagram above. B. Sketch the electrostatic field which exists between the charges by drawing several lines of force between the charges in the diagram above. 2. An electron (qe = -1.6 x 10 coul and me = 9.11 x 10-31 kg) is accelerated through a series of three sets of parallel plates. Each set of plates (A, B, and C) has a similar voltage differential (100 volts) but a progressively increasing plate separation (10.0 cm, 20.0 cm, and 30.0 cm). (See the diagram shown below). A. Predict the electron's velocity when it leaves plate set A, at point x. B. What change in electron velocity occurs between points x and x1? C. Calculate the electron's energy at y and again at z. D. If a fourth set of plates were added, can you predict the final velocity of the electron? 3. Three capacitors are connected in a series arrangement as indicated by thediagram shown below. After the circuit was connected, a physics student finds that the lmf capacitor stores a charge of 27.5mcoul. A. What is the charge stored on each of the other capacitors? B. Find the voltage of the battery. C. Calculate the voltage drop across the 2.00mF capacitor. D. How much energy is stored by the entire series configuration of capacitors? ANSWERS: See Fig. 1. 9.2 x 10-10 N(AH reaction) 2. 5.9 x 106m/s, none, 8.3 x 106m/s, 10.2 x 106m/s, yes, 11.8 x 106m/s 3. A) 27.5 mcoul, B) 50 volts, C) 13.8 volts, D) 688 x 10-6 Joules Chapter Basic Electrical Measurements (22): to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications: 22 Basic Electrical Measurements Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Electricity And Magnetism; Electric Current; Amps; Ohms; Resistance; Resistivity; EMF; Peltier Effect; DC Circuits; DC Instruments; Seebeck Effect; Thermocouples; Piezoelectric Effect; Conductivity; Circuits Containing Resistors; Ohm's Law; Potential Difference; Electric Power; Applications; Anatomy And Physiology; DC Current GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: ampere electromotive force (emf) electrical conductivity Seebeck effect ohm Peltier effect resistivity piezoelectric effect Resistors Determine an equivalent resistance for a series or parallel combination of resistors. Ohm's Law Solve problems using the relationship among resistance, potential difference, and electric current-that is, apply Ohm's law to simple circuits. Power Loss Solve problems for instantaneous power in resistive elements obeying Ohm's law. DC Circuits Analyze direct-current circuits consisting of resistances and sources of emfs, and find the currents, terminal potential difference of sources of emfs, potential drops, and power developed in circuit elements. DC Instruments Explain the basic principle of operation of direct-current instruments: potentiometer, Wheatstone bridge, and thermocouple. Bioelectricity Describe some application of electricity in human physiology. PREREQUISITES Before you begin this chapter, you need to have mastered the basic concepts of Chapter 5, Energy, Chapter 11, Thermal Transport, and Chapter 21, Electrical Properties of Matter. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Electricity And Magnetism; Electric Current Most of the every day applications of electricity involve the flow of electric charges through circuits. In this chapter, many of the basic properties of electrical circuits will be discussed. From a simple discussion of Ohm's and Joule's Law in section 22.4, more sophisticated circuits are introduced. The remaining parts of the chapter deal with either electrical measuring devices or electrical physiology. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE To begin your study of this chapter, read the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Resistors, Ohm's Law, Power Loss, DC Circuits, and Bioelectricity. Each term listed under the Goal of Definitions is discussed in the first section of this chapter. Next, you should carefully read through the following chapter sections and work through the examples provided at the end of each: 22.1-22.4, 22.8-22.11, and 22.13. Questions you encounter during your reading are answered in the second section of this chapter. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and do Summary Exercises 1-11, 14 and 16. Check your answers carefully and compare them with those given at the end of the section. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 2-7 and Exercises and Problems 3, 7, 13, 17, and 18. Now, for more practice with the concepts of DC Circuits, complete each of the problems presented in the Examples section of this chapter. After completing the above procedure, you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Basic Electrical Measurements found at the end of this chapter. After you have completed each part, check your answers against those given at the end of the test. If you were unsuccessful in any of the areas, refer back to the text or to this chapter for additional assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. ------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ------------------Definitions 22.1,22.2,22.8 1-8 22.9,22.10 Resistors 22.3 9 2,3,4 OHM's Law 22.4 10 5 3,7 Power Loss 22.4 11 7 17,18 DC Circuits Bioelectricity 22.11,22.13 14,16 13 --------------------------------------------------DC Circuits 22.14 12 16 DC Instruments 22.5,22.6,22.7 13 8,9,10,12 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Electricity And Magnetism; Electric Current; Amps; Conductivity; Resistance; Ohms; Resistivity; EMF; Seebeck Effect; Thermocouples; Peltier; Effect; DC Circuits; DC Instruments; Piezoelectric Effect; Glossary; DC Current AMPERE A measurement of the flow of charges through an electrical conductor. The passage of one coulomb of electric charge in one second is one ampere. ELECTRICAL CONDUCTIVITY The proportionality constant between current density and potential gradient. OHM (unit of resistance) The OHM is the resistance that has a potential difference of one volt across it when it carries a current of one ampere. Each individual component of an electrical circuit will display a unique resistance to the flow of electrical charges. RESISTIVITY The reciprocal of conductivity with units of ohms-meter. This constant reflects a general resistance property for a material like copper or lead. It is not dependent upon the length and/or cross-sectional arrangement of a circuit component. ELECTROMOTIVE FORCE (emf) The potential difference across a source of electrical energy with no current flow. An emf of a battery is a voltage measurement when the current flow through the battery is zero. Thus the terminal voltage has a maximum value. SeeBECK EFFECT The physical process that produces the emf generated by junctions of dissimilar metals when they are heated or cooled, (e.g., thermocouples). PELTIER EFFECT The process characterized by the generation or absorption of heat at a junction of dissimilar metals when a current passes through the junction. (The reverse of the Seebeck effect.) An electric current flowing through the junction of dissimilar metals produces either a liberation or absorption of heat (depending upon the direction of the current) in direct proportion to the quantity of charge passing through the junction. PIEZO ELECTRICITY The ability of certain crystals (e.g., quartz) to generate an emf when subjected to mechanical strain. A common crystal microphone operates as a mechanical energy-electrical energy transducer using this effect. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Electricity And Magnetism; Electric Current; Energy; Electric Power; Resistivity; Resistance; DC Current; Amps; Electrons; Joule's Law; Electrical Equivalent; Ohm's Law; Galvanometers; Wheatstone Bridges; Piezoelectric Effect; Threshold; DC Circuits; DC Instruments; Circuits Containing Resistors; Conductors SECTION 22.1 Introduction The proliferation of electrical appliances has become a hallmark of the United States. Many electrical energy supply systems have a procedure for charging less per unit of energy the more energy you use. The economics of the system has encouraged the development of a vast array of electrical devices from electric toothbrushes to electric garage door openers. A typical person in a single family house may use about 10 units of electrical energy per day. The units used to measure electrical energy by the electrical energy supply systems are kilowatt hours rather than joules. There are 3.6 x 106 joules in one kilowatt hour. SECTION 22.2 Electrical Charges in Motion The resistivity r (rho) is typically measured in the units of ohm ¥ centimeters. Questions - 1 and 2. Since the electrical charge of an electron is 1.6 x 10-19C, if 6.25 x 1018 electrons passed a location in one second, there would be an electrical current of one ampere passing that location. If the current density were 1A/m 2, then 6.25 x 1018 electrons would be passing through an area of 1 square meter or 104 square centimeters. The current density of 1A/m2 is equal to 6.25 x 1014 electrons per square centimeter. 3. If the potential difference is linear with distance along the circuit then the total potential difference from end to end divided by the total length will be equal to the ratio of the change in voltage to change in displacement for any portion of the circuit. If we rewrite Equation 22.3 in terms of the electric field it becomes J = sE. 4. A good conductor will have a small value of resistivity. SECTION 22.3 Sources of Electrical Energy If you measure the internal resistance of a battery then you find low resistance means a good battery and high resistance of the same kind of battery means a bad, or dead, battery. 5. If various portions of electrostatic systems are connected by conducting materials, then electric charge can always flow in response to electric potentials and no large electrostatic potentials can develop. SECTION 22.4 Electric Circuits: Ohm's Law and Joule's Law 6. Equation 22.6 is a statement of Ohm's Law, V=IR. Suppose you have two resistances, R1 and R2, in parallel with one another and you put a voltage V across them. There will be a current of I1=V/R1 through the first resistance R 1 and there will be a current of I2=V/R2 through the second resistance. The total current in the circuit will then be equal to I1+I2. What equivalent resistance R do you need to hook across the voltage V in place of R1 and R2 that will draw the same amount of current, namely I1+I2? To answer this question let us set the potential difference across the equivalent resistance equal to the potential difference across each separate parallel resistor, V = R (I1+I2) = I1R1 = I2R2. We can use the right sides of these equations to derive equations for the currents I1 = V/R1 and I2 = V/R2, so V = R (V/R1+V/R2); 1 = R(1/R1 + 1/R2) = R((R2 + R1) / R1R2) (R1R2) / (R1 + R2) = R (1) The equivalent resistance of two parallel resistors is the product of the resistances divided by the sum. 7. We can rewrite the Joule's Law expression of the power dissipated in a circuit by using Ohm's Law to replace the current in Equation 22.23 by the ratio V/R. Then Power = (V/R)2R = V2/R (2) 8. One experiment that can be used to relate the electrical energy to mechanical energy is to place a heating coil of wire in an insulated container that holds a known volume of water. Turn on the current and measure the potential difference, the current, the time, and the change in temperature of the water. You can then check to see if the VIt product is equal to the volume times change in temperature times 4.19 joules/milliliter for the water. SECTION 22.5 Galvanometers 9. The voltage across a 1000W galvanometer measuring a current of 10-9A is 10-6 volts. 10. A perfect ammeter would have a resistance zero. 11. A perfect voltmeter would have an infinite resistance. 12. In the circuit where the ammeter is in series with the resistance, the voltmeter reading is the voltage drop across both the unknown resistance and the ammeter. But the reading of the ammeter is the correct reading for the current through the unknown resistance. The voltmeter reading must be reduced by an amount equal to the current times the ammeter resistance, then divided by the ammeter current reading to find the correct value of the unknown resistance. R = (V - IARA) / IA (3) In the circuit where the voltmeter is in parallel with the unknown resistance the ammeter reading is the current through both the voltmeter and the unknown resistance. So the current reading of the ammeter must be reduced by the amount of current in the voltmeter, then divided into the voltmeter reading to determine the correct value of the unknown resistance, R = V / (IA - V/RV) (4) SECTION 22.7 The Wheatstone Bridge 13. When the Wheatstone Bridge is balanced there must be no current through the null detector so points (a) and (b) of the circuit must be at the same potential. Thus the potential difference across R1 and R2 must be the same, i.e. V1 = V2 or iaR1 = ib R2. Similar reasoning can be used to deduce that iaR3 = ib Rx. 14. If we assume the current detector can act as an infinite resistor to measure and voltage difference between (a) and (b), then we can write down the voltage difference from the top of the emf to point (b) by two routes; through R1 and the current detector and through R2. The potential difference must be the same in each case i1R1-Vab = i2R2 If we do not allow for any current flow through the detector then E = i1(R1 + R3) = i2(R2 + Rx) so Vab = i1R1 - i2R2 Vab = ((e / R1 + R3) R1) - ((e / R2 + Rx) R2) SECTION 22.10 The Piezoelectric Effect 15. A high input resistance device that draws very little current must be used with piezoelectric crystals. 16. The use of a periodic voltage to cause mechanical vibrations in a piezoelectric crystal is an example of a resonance phenomena. The frequency of the applied voltage must be the same as the natural frequency of the piezoelectric crystal. SECTION 22.13 Electric Thresholds and Effects 17. Typical amounts of static electricity are not able to produce any appreciate current flow through humans so they are not usually dangerous. 18. The energy dissipated in an electric shock is proportional to the square of the current times the resistance times the time. The resistance of an object is inversely proportional to its area. The combination of these concepts, Equations 22.7 and 22.23, leads to the relationship damage ° (current2/area) x time EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Electricity And Magnetism; Ohm's Law; DC Circuits; Electric Current; Circuits Containing Resistors; Voltage; Resistance; Electric Power; Kirchhoff's Rules; Joules's Law; Electrical Equivalent; Conservation Of Energy; DC Current RESISTORS 1. (a) What is the equivalent resistance of n equal resistors in parallel? (b) Combine this result with the Least Common Multiple concept from mathematics to devise a technique for finding the equivalent resistance for unequal resistors in parallel. (c) Use the technique to find the resistor equivalent to 20W, 30W, and 50W in parallel. What data are given? The number of equal resistors = n, an integer greater than zero. What data are implied? The circuit obeys Ohm's Law. What physics principles are involved? The conservation of electric charge and energy are used to derive the basic equations that are needed for this problem. What equations are to be used? We will use Ohm's Law to derive some other equations. V = IR Solutions See Fig. 22-1. Assume there is a voltage drop V across each of these resistors of value R. Then a current I flows through each branch of the circuit given by I=V/R. But the current in the rest of the circuit must be equal to the sum of all the currents in parallel branches of the circuit, so Itotal = I + I +...I = nI since there are n branches, each carrying a current I. Thus we have a voltage of V and a current of nI, what must the resistance be? The equivalent resistance Req must be Req = (V/nI) but (V/I) = R, so Req = R/n (5) The equivalent resistance of n equal resistors in parallel is the resistance of one resistor divided by n, the number of resistors in parallel. (b) Now take a circuit of unequal resistors R1, R2 and R3. We know from Equation (5) the resistor R1, for example, can be considered the equivalent of some member, say n1, of larger equal resistances, say R, in parallel. Likewise R2 can be equivalent to n2 of the larger resistances R in parallel and R3 equal to n3 of the R's in parallel. Then we can replace each of the unequal resistors by some numbers, n1, n2 and n3 respectively, of equal resistors and find the equivalent resistance of R1 , R 2 and R3 in parallel using Equation (5). Req = R / (n1 + n2 + n3) (6) See Fig. 22-2. How can we find the value of R and of n1, n2 and n3? Let us assume the R1, R2 and R3 have no common factors, then the Least Common Multiple of the three is just their product. L.C.M. = R1R2R3 (7) If we choose the LCM of R1, R2 and R3 for the value of R then we know that n1, n2 and n3 will all be integer numbers. Choose R in ohms = R1R2R3 Then n1 = (R1R2R3) / R1 = R2R3; n2 = R1R3 and n3 = R2R1 Thus Req = R / (n1 + n2 + n3) = (R1R2R3) / (R2R3 + R1R3 + R2R1) (8) (c) To see how this works let us consider the specific case of a 20W resistor in parallel with a 30W resistor in parallel with a 50W resistor. See Fig. 22-3. so n20 = 300/20 = 15; n30 = 300/30 = 10; n50 = 300/50 = 6 So these three resistors in parallel are equivalent to 15+10+6, or 31, branches of 300W resistors in parallel, thus Req = 300/31 = 9.7 W Thinking about the answers Look back over this procedure. Can you show that this result is equivalent to Equation (22.16)? Which technique do you prefer, the use of the sum of reciprocals, as in Eq. 22.16, or the use of the LCM as shown here? Take your pick, they give the same result. OHM'S LAW 2. A 3W resistor and a 6W resistor are connected in parallel. This combination is connected in series with a 4W resistor; then the group of three resistors are connected in parallel with a 12W resistor. These four resistors are connected to the terminals of a 12V battery with an internal resistance of 2W. (a) Draw the circuit, labeling all the elements by their specified values. (b) Calculate the resistance of the combination of 4 resistors. (c) Calculate the current through each portion of the circuit. (d) Calculate the voltage drop across each portion of the circuit and show that energy is conserved in the circuit. What data are given? The answer to this question can also answer part (a) of this question, so let us draw a circuit diagram and label at the parts. See Fig. 22-4. What data are implied? It is assumed that all aspects of this circuit satisfy Ohm's Law. What physics principles are involved? The conservation of energy and electric charge are combined with Ohm's Law to derive all of the circuit equations to be used. What equations are to be used? Vterminal = e-Ir (22.8) V = IR (22.6) Series Stotal = SIRi (22.9) Series Reff = R1 + R2...Rn (22.10) Parallel I = i1 + i2 + i3 (22.11) -1 -1 -1 -1 Parallel Reff = R1 + R2 +...Rn (22.16) Numerical Solutions Rather than work out a complete algebraic solution for this problem before putting in numbers, let us work out algebraic solutions to each part of the problem, then obtain a numerical result and carry the numerical result from one part of the problem to another. (b) To solve this portion of the problem we must begin with the 3W and 6W parallel combination so that we can combine that with the 4W resistor to find the equivalent resistance of those in parallel with the 12W resistor. See Fig. So the equivalent resistance of the top part of Figure 22-4 is 2W + 4W, or 6W. Finally, See Fig. The equivalent resistance of the four resistors is 4W. (c) To calculate the current through each portion of the circuit we will find the current through the battery first and then trace its subdivision through a portion of the circuit. The 12V battery is connected to 4W of external resistance plus having an internal resistance of 2W, so Ibattery = 12V / (4W + 2W) = 2A When the 2A current leaves the battery it meets an equivalent parallel circuit that contains 6W in parallel with 12W. The resistance (6W) is half as much in one branch so the current in that branch must be twice as much as in the other (12W) branch; thus I12 = [2/3]A; Itop branch = [4/3]A All of the [4/3]A will pass through the 4W resistor in the top branch. Note that the [4/3]A also comes to a parallel portion of the circuit where the ratio of resistances in the two branches is 2 to 1 (6W to 3W). The current through the 3W resistor will be twice the current in the 6W resistor. Thus I3 = [8/9]A; I6 = [4/9]A Of course, the current through the 2W resistance of the battery is the total of 2A. Notice how current is conserved at each branch point in the circuit. See Fig. 22-5 (d) We can find the voltage drops across each portion of the circuit by using Ohm's Law, V=IR. V3 = (8/9 A)(3) = 8/3 Volts V6 = (4/9 A)(6) = 8/3 Volts V4 = (4/3 A)(4) = 16/3 Volts V12 = (2/3 A)(12) = 8 Volts V2 = (2A)(2) = 4 Volts Conservation of energy Potential across the 3W and 6W in parallel = 8/3 V. Potential across the 12W and 3W resistor combination = 8V. Potential across all resistances = 12V = Emf of the battery. POWER LOSS 3. Find the power loss in each portion of the circuit in Problem 2 above. What data are given? See Figure 22-4 and the answers to part (c) and (d) of question 2. What data are implied? The circuit elements are ohmic. What physics principles are involved? The use of Joule's Law as discussed in Section 22.4. What equation is to be used? Joule's Law: P = VI = I2R (22.23) Solutions P3 = V3I3 = (8/3 V)(8/9 A) = 64/27 W = 2(10/27) W = 2.4 W P6 = V6I6 = (8/3 V)(4/9 A) = 32/27 W = 1(5/27) W = 1.2 W P4 = V4I4 = (16/3 V)(4/3 A) = 64/9 W = 7 1/9 W = 7.1 W P12 = V12I12 = (8 V)(2/3 A) = 16/3 W = 5.3 W P2 = V2I2 = (4 V)(2 A) = 8 W Power Output of the Battery = eI = (12V) (2A) = 24W Is that equal to the total power loss of the complete system? Power Loss = 2.4 + 1.2 + 7.1 + 5.3 + 8.0 = 24W Thinking about the answers The power supplied by the battery has to equal the power loss in the circuit for electrical energy to be conserved in this system. From where does the electrical energy come for this circuit? Please note that if you were given a circuit and asked to find the power loss in each circuit element you would have to go through the procedures used in problem 2 first to find the current in each branch of the circuit, then use P=I2R to find the power dissipated in each circuit element. A procedure which may be lengthy, but if done systematically will yield the correct results. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Problems; Questions; Answers; Evaluations; DC Current; DC Circuits; Electric Current; Resistance; Resistivity; Kirchhoff's Rules; Voltage; Energy; Circuits Containing Resistors; Ohm's Law; Medicine And Health; Cardiovascular Systems; Anatomy And Physiology; Applications; Electric Power 1. Briefly describe the difference between resistance (OHMS) and resistivity (OHMmeters). Give an example of how each term is used in a practical situation. 2. The circuit outlined by the diagram below was used to show the electrical flow in a DC circuit. The 1 OHM resistor is the internal resistance of the 75 volt battery. See Fig. Using this information, find the following: A. The equivalent resistance of the circuit. B. The current measured by the ammeter. C. The voltage indicated by the voltmeter. D. The "Terminal" voltage of the battery in the circuit. 3. Three heat lamps (120 volts, 200 watts) are to be connected to a 120 volt electrical outlet. Circuit 1 shows the bulbs connected in parallel. See Fig. Circuit 1. A. What is the voltage drop across each bulb in circuit 1? B. What total current is required from the outlet where circuit 1 is connected? C. Find the cost for operating the circuit for a time of 3 hours if the charge is $1.05 for each KWH. 4. An important application of electricity in human physiology is the ECG. A typical output signal is shown below. See Fig. A. What is this signal called and what does it control? B. Briefly describe the electrical origins of the signal and what the function of each part of the wave serve. ANSWERS: 1. OHM - Rating given to a part of an electrical circuit offering a resistance to the flow of charges. For a 1 volt potential which can produce a current of 1 Amp, the resistance is 1 OHM. OHM - Meter - A basic property of a material substance rather than an individual device. The property is independent of any size and/or shape. The rating can predict the ohmic resistance of a material after being formed to a certain size and shape. 2. 25W, 3 Amp, 36 volts, 72 volts 3. 120 volt - AC, 5 Amps, 9 cents ($.09) 4. Electrocardiagram (ECG) - Heart, the electric origin of the signal is found within the center of the brain. The function is to synchronize the heart's pumping action: P (atrial changing dipole signal), QRS (Ventricular changing dipole), T (Ventricular dipole restoration). Chapter Magnetism (23): STUDY GUIDE Citation: H. Q Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications. (Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Magnetic Fields; Electricity And Magnetism; Magnetic Properties Of Matter; Charges Moving In Magnetic Fields; Magnetic Fields Of Currents; Devices Using Magnetic Fields And Current; Hall Effect GOALS When you have mastered the content of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: magnetic field current sensitivity magnetic forces ferromagnetism ampere Biot-Savart Law Apply the basic relationship between current and its associated magnetic field. Magnetic Forces on Moving Particles Explain the motion of a charged particle in a uniform magnetic field. Magnetic Interactions Discuss the interaction of magnetic fields. Electric and Magnetic Fields Explain the difference between the behavior of charged particles in electric and magnetic fields. Magnetic Field Applications Explain such applications as: electromagnetic pump, focusing of charged particles by a magnetic field, DC electric meters, motors, and the Hall effect. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 4, Forces and Newton's Laws. Chapter 21, Electrical Properties of Matter, and Chapter 22, Basic Electrical Measurements. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Electricity And Magnetism; Magnetism; Instructions As you skim over the contents of this chapter, you will surely notice that the description of magnetism is similar to that of Electrostatics; e.g., both produce interacting forces of attraction and repulsion and therefore can be modeled using the field concept. Be sure at the same time to notice that these concepts are basically different and that the interaction between magnetism and electric charges occurs only when there is relative motion between the magnetic field and the electric charge. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE To begin your study of this chapter, read each of the Chapter Goals: Definitions, BiotSavart Law, Magnetic Forces on Moving Particles, Magnetic Interactions, Electric and Magnetic Fields, and Magnetic Field Applications. An extended discussion of each of the terms listed under Definitions is given in the next section of this chapter. Next, read text sections 23.1-23.8 and 23.10-23.13. Be sure to be cautious of the vector product (cross product) nature of the magnetic field - moving charged particle interaction (e.g., equation 23.2, and Figure 23.9). Answers to the questions you encounter as you read are answered in the second section of this chapter. Now turn to the end of the chapter and read the Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-15. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1-5 and complete Exercises and Problems 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 9, and 11. For additional exercises with the concepts of this chapter, turn to the Example section of this . Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Magnetism provided at the end of this chapter. When you have completed the test, check your answers with those given. If you were unsuccessful with any of the concepts, refer to either a particular section of the text or this chapter. This study procedure is outlined below. ------------------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ------------------------------Definitions 23.1, 23.2, 23.3 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 Biot-Savart Law 23.4 6,7 3,4,5 4,6,8 Magnetic Forces 23.5 8,9 2 2,3,9 on Moving Particles Magnetic 23.7,23.8 10 1 11 Interactions Electric and 23.3 11,12,13 Magnetic Fields Magnetic Field 23.6,23.10, 14,15 Applications 23.11,23.12, 23.13 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Magnetic Fields; Magnetic Forces; Amps; Kinds Of Magnetism; Glossary; ; Magnetism; Electricity And Magnetism; Magnetic Fields And Currents; Magnetic Fields Of Currents MAGNETIC FIELD The magnetic (induction) field, B, is a quantity introduced to explain interaction between moving charges. (Units are weber/m2 ). In a region of space which is occupied by a magnetic field, a vector can be drawn which represents the force a unit north pole would receive if placed at that point. The force exerted on a moving charged particle is more complicated and is in a direction perpendicular to both the magnetic field and the velocity of the particle (see magnetic force). MAGNETIC FORCE The force on a moving charge (+q) with velocity (v) in a magnetic induction field (B) has the value of (q x v xB). The right-hand (vector-product) rule is used to determine the direction of this force. See Fig. 23.3. AMPERE The amount of current carried by two parallel conductors placed 1 meter apart in a vacuum so that the force between them is 2 x 10-7 Newtons per meter of length. CURRENT SENSITIVITY The proportionality constant between the current in a coil and its angle of deflection in a magnetic field. For highly sensitive galvanometers, k is the order of 0.00001mA/mm or 10-11 amp/mm. For less sensitive meters, k is a larger number. Please note that the term sensitivity is a technical term meaning the reciprocal of sensitiveness. FERROMAGNETISM The result of cooperative interactions of magnetic dipoles in such as iron, nickel, and cobalt. The result is very strong internal magnetic fields. Introducing an iron (ferromagnetic) core in an air core solenoid can increase the magnetic field produced by the same current by a factor 500 to 1000 times. This increase is attributed to the alignment of individual Fe atoms each with small magnetic dipole moments. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Answers; Electricity And Magnetism; Magnetism; Devices Using Magnetic Fields And Currents; Magnetic Properties Of Matter; Magnetic Fields And Currents SECTION 23.1 Introduction Today someone rung the doorbell of my house, the plunger which causes the ring was activated by an electromagnet. I have some messages attached to the front of our home refrigerator with small magnets. I used an electric blender to mix up a solution. The blender motor operates through the interaction of electric and magnetic forces. As I drove our automobile the alternator generated electrical energy, by means of a magnetic field, to recharge the battery. The door of our refrigerator is held shut by a magnetic strip. These are five ways that magnetism has played a part in my life today. How about yours? In each of these cases the magnetic field of the earth is much smaller than the field that influenced my life. The earth's magnetic field is about 10-4 times the typical values of magnetic fields in motors, etc. The exact role of the earth's magnetic field in various living systems is still not well understood. It seems to play a role in the migration patterns of animals, but its effects on humans is not known. With modern low field sensitive detectors, (discussed in section 23.13), we are beginning a more systematic study of the presence of weak fields and their possible effects on living systems. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Biot-Savart Law; Magnetic Fields; Charges Moving In Magnetic Fields; Algebra; Magnetic Fields Of Currents; Magnetism; Electricity And Magnetism; Magnetic Forces; Centripetal Force; Circular Motion BIOT-SAVART LAW 1. What is the magnetic induction B at the origin from a line carrying a current I along the negative x-axis to a position -a, around a circle in a clockwise manner to the negative y-axis at a point -a, and then out to a long distance. What data are given? The current I follows a path as shown below: See Fig. 23-1. What data are implied? The external aspects of this circuit which supply the emf are far, far away from the origin of this coordinate system. What physics principles are involved? The Biot-Savart relationship between electric current and magnetic induction can be used. What equations are to be used? Biot-Savart Law B = mo/4p (iDlsinq/r2) (23.3) Solution The angleq in Equation 23.3 is the angle between the current direction and the direction from the element of current iDl to the point where the magnetic induction is to be computed. Since the origin is in line with the straight line portions of the current circuit in Fig. 23-1, the angle q is zero or 180ø, so sinq = 0 for the current along the negative x-axis and the negative y-axis. Thus the only portion that makes a contribution to the magnetic field at the origin is the circular portion. It has a length of (3/4) (2pa), or 3pa/2. In addition the origin is at right angles and a distance a from all parts of the circular portion. We can put these values in Equation 23.3 to find the magnitude of B: B = mo/4p[(I)(3pa/2)sin 90ø / a2] B = mo / 4p3p I / 2a) = 3moI / 8a (1) What is the direction of B for this problem? Thinking about the answer Notice that the answer is just 3/4 of the value of the field at the center of a loop as given in Equation 23.4. Does that seem reasonable? Why? How can you determine the direction of the field in this case? Use a right rule or the vector product to show that the B points in the negative Z-direction. MAGNETIC FORCES ON MOVING PARTICLES 2. A beam of electrons with speed 2.0 x106 m/s is to be deflected 90ø by a magnet as shown in Fig. 23-2. (e = -1.6 x10-19C, m = 9.1 x10- 31kg). a) What must be the direction of B? b) What is the force on the electrons when in the magnetic field? c) What is the magnitude of B? d) What is the speed of the electrons after they leave the region of the magnetic field? What data are given? Electron speed = 2.0 x106 m/s Radius of path = 0.20 m Charge of electrons = -1.6 x10-19C Mass of electrons = 9.1 x10-31kg. What data are implied? The problem assumes that the path of the electrons is in a plane perpendicular to the magnetic field, not as shown in Figure 23.7(b) in the textbook. What physics principles are involved? The problems require that you know the force exerted on a moving charge by a magnetic field and the centripetal force on a particle moving in a circular path. What equations are to be used? Magnetic force Fm = Bqvsinq (23.2) Centripetal force F = mv2/r (4.6) Algebraic solutions The magnetic force will have to be equal to the centripetal force, Fm = Bqvsinq = mv2/r so: B = mv / rqsinq (2) Furthermore, the B field will have to point in a direction so that the force on negatively charged particles will point toward the center of their circular path, in Figure 23-2 that will be toward the lower left hand corner of the magnetic pole face. Numerical solutions Since the plane of the electrons path is perpendicular to the magnetic field the angleq is 90ø, so sinq = 1 in Equation (2). (a) Using the right hand rule, if you turn your fingers into the page from the direction of v your thumb points away from the center of curvature of the path which is the direction the force of the field into the page would be on positive charges. However, electrons have negative charge, so a magnetic field into the page would force them into the curved path as shown if it has a magnitude given by Equation (2). (b) The force on the electrons = mv2/r =[(9.1 x 10-31)(2.0 x 106m/s)2] / (0.20 m) = 1.8 x 10-17 N (c) B = 1.8 x 10-17N/qv = 1.8 x 10-17N / [(1.6 x 10-19C)(2.0 x 106m/s)] = 5.7 x 105W/m2 (d) The speed of the electrons remains unchanged, only the direction is changed. Thinking about the answers Notice that the magnetic field exerts a force on a moving electric charge which is always perpendicular to the direction of motion. Hence, no net work is done on the moving particle and the energy of the particle is not changed by its interaction with the magnetic field. PRACTICE TEST Keywords:: Evaluations; ; Problems; Answers; Questions; Electricity And Magnetism; Magnetism; Magnetic Forces; Charges Moving In Magnetic Fields; Biot-Savart Law; Field Lines; Devices Using Magnetic Fields And Currents; Pumps; Magnetic Fields 1. A section of the large electrical element inside an oven carries a large current. At the peak of the AC cycle, the current is 7 amperes. The element has a radius of .6 mm. Assume that this 7 ampere current is flowing into the cross-section of the conductor shown. a. Find the magnetic field produced by the section of wire at a distance of 25 centimeters from its center. (Given: B =m0I/2pr.) b. Sketch the magnetic field lines which surround the conductor. 2. An electron with a charge of -1.6 x 10-19 coulomb enters a magnetic field from the right and follows the path shown. Please indicate the direction of the magnetic field present in this region. Write a short statement explaining how you arrived at your result. 3. The drawing shows a square chamber which is to be the basis for an electromagnetic pump. The liquid to be moved can enter from the tube on the left, and leave via the tube on the right. What electrical components are needed in and/or around the square chamber area to operate the pump? Please draw a diagram showing the placement of the equipment and write a short paragraph explaining how and/or why it works as a pump. ANSWERS: 1. 5.6 x 10-6 W/m2 See Fig. 2. See Fig. The B field must be uniform and point into the pages in the region shown. Now using the right-hand rule with the fingers pointing to the "left" in the direction of the positive current flow (opposite to the direction of the negative charge velocity), the fingers must be rotated down into the page toward the magnetic field vector to get a force as shown. 3. The fluid must be a good conductor. Then the two important components are a) voltage source (v) connected to the sides of the pump which are parallel to the plane of the page. Then, a magnetic field is needed which provides a field B pointing down. See Fig. As positive ions drift toward the negatively charged front pump face, a force (F = q x v) is produced toward the liquid exit. Chapter Electromagnetic Induction (24): Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Electricity And Magnetism; Electromagnetic Induction; Faraday's Law; Inductance; Self Inductance; Lenz's Law; Henry; Applications Of Electromagnetic Induction; Electric Generators GOALS When you have mastered the content of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: Faraday's induction law Lenz's law self-inductance henry Applications of Induction Explain the physical basis for the operation of each of the following: AC generator electromagnetic damping search coil Faraday's Law Problems Solve problems involving Faraday's induction law. Lenz's Law Predict the correct directions for induced current flow in electromagnetic induction phenomena. Inductors Solve problems involving combinations of inductors. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter, you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 22, Basic Electrical Measurements, and Chapter 23, Magnetism. OVERVIEW Keywords: Instruction; Electricity And Magnetism; ; Electromagnetic Induction Much of our modern technology is based on the fact that an electrical current is produced by the relative motion between a magnetic field and a current conductor. In generalizing this phenomenon, Faraday found a simple rule for predicting the voltage induced. But predicting the magnitude of the voltage produced by applying equation (24.2) is only part of the solution; Lenz's Law predicts the direction of the induced current. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Start your investigation of this chapter by reading the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Applications of Induction, Faraday's Law Problems, andLenz's Law. An expanded discussion of each of the terms listed under the Definitions goal can be found in the next section of this chapter. Next, read chapter sections 21.1 - 21.5. As you read, be sure to pay particular attention to the relative directions of motion, magnetic field, and induced current in the examples given. In each case, the relative directions are predicted by Lenz's Law, Section 24.2. For more practice with Lenz's Law, see the Examples section of this chapter. Now turn to the end of the chapter and read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-10. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1-5. Check your answers carefully against those given. Now do Exercises and Problems 1-6, 8, and 12. For additional work with the concepts introduced in this chapter, see the Examples section of this chapter. After you have completed this study procedure you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test provided at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulty with any of the problems, refer to your text or to this chapter for further assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. ------------------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ------------------------------Definitions 24.1 1, 2, 3, 4 Applications of 24.3, 24.4, 24.8 7 5, 6 Induction Faraday's Law 24.2 8, 9, 10 1, 2 1, 2, 3 Problems Lenz's Law 24.2 3 4, 12 Inductors 24.5, 24.6 5, 6 4, 5 -----------------------------------------------------24.7, 24.8 11 8 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; Electricity And Magnetism; Electromagnetic Induction; Faraday's Law; Inductance; Self Inductance; Lenz's Law; Henry FARADAY'S LAW OF INDUCTION (law of electromagnetic induction) Predicts that a change in magnetic flux in time produces an induced emf. Relative motion between a closed loop conductor (which contains charges) and a magnetic field will produce an induced emf if the motion causes a change in either the magnetic field intensity around the conductor or the area enclosing the field or both. SELF-INDUCTANCE Self inductance, L, determines induced emf in a coil of wire due to change of current through the wire. The increasing or decreasing field around a coil, even though the field is due to the current in its own windings, will produce a current in the windings. The direction of the induced current will always act to inhibit an increasing current or sustain a decreasing current. LENZ'S LAW Predicts that the induced emf of Faraday's law gives a current that opposes the flux change producing the emf. This law is derived from the conservation of energy principle. If Lenz's Law were not true, it would be possible to build a perpetual motion machine. HENRY The unit for inductance (self and mutual) is the henry. Large inductors have inductance values of about .5 henries. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Electricity And Magnetism; Electromagnetic Induction; Faraday's Law; Applications Of Electromagnetic Induction SECTION 24.1 Introduction This chapter discusses the phenomena that are explained by a model of electricmagnetic interactions by which a rapidly fluctuating magnetic field causes changes in the electrical properties of circuits in those magnetic fields. The static or noise on the radio, the signal message on the radio, and the generation of AC voltage all are understood by means of this model. SECTION 24.3 Applications of Faraday's Law The more turns in a search coil the larger will be the angular deflection for a given value of magnetic induction, Equation 24.4. So the sensitivity of the detection process is at least partly determined by the number of turns in the search coil. However, the number of turns in the coil cancels out of the equation, number 24.5, which is used to calculate the size of an unknown field in relation to a known field. SECTION 24.8 Applications of Electromagnetic Induction Look up from this and look around to see how many applications of electro-magnetic induction (EI) you can deduce? For example, I am working at a desk in my study. The fluorescent lamp uses EI to start it. An electric calculator is plugged in to an AC-DC converter nearby. The telephone on the desk is an application of EI. The electric typewriter motor is an application of EI. In fact, a large portion of all of our electrical devices make some use of at least one result of electromagnetic induction. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Lenz's Law; Electricity And Magnetism; Electromagnetic Induction; Faraday's Law; Magnetic Flux; Electric Power; Inductors; Inductance; Conservation Of Energy; Conservation Of Charge FARADAY'S LAW PROBLEMS 1. A square coil of N turns, edge a, and resistance R is moved through a B field at a constant speed v. Assume the coil moves in the xy plane and the motion of the coil is in the positive y- direction. The B field is constant and parallel to the Z axis for all values of y less than zero. The B field is zero for values of y greater than zero. Assume that the coil is initially completely in the magnetic field. (a) Express the magnetic flux f linking the coil in terms of B, a, v and/or y, where y is the coordinate of the forward edge of the moving coil. Sketch the flux as a function of y to show any variation you predict. (b) Express the induced emf e in terms of these same variables and sketch it as a function of y also. (c) Find the power and total energy dissipated in the coil as it passes out of the B field. (d) What force must be applied to the coil to keep it moving at a constant speed? What data are given? Let us draw a diagram of this problem so we have a clear picture in our minds as to what the physical setting really is. See Fig. 24-1. What data are implied? Idealized motion is assumed. Friction is neglected. The magnetic field only exists in the negative y portion of the xy plane with the positive y half of the xy plane being entirely void of any magnetic fields. What physics principles are involved? Part (a) requires the definition of magnetic flux f. Part (b) requires the use of Faraday's Law of induction. Part (c) requires the use of the expression of the electric power dissipated in a circuit. Part (d) requires the use of the definition of power and the special case of a system moving with constant velocity. What equations are to be used? Magnetic flux f = BAcosq (24.1) Faraday's Law e = -Df/Dt (24.2) Power Dissipated P = e2/R = I2R = Energy/Time (22.23) Power = Fv (5.13) Solutions Part (a). When the coil is completely in the magnetic field B, i.e. the leading edge is still in the negative y portion of the plane then the flux f is just equal to B times the area of the coil f = Ba2 (1) As the leading edge of the coil emerges from the field the area of the coil is reduced. The area is reduced by the amount y of the coil that sticks out of the field See Fig. 24-2. See Fig. 24-3. Part (b). Now we can write the expression for the magnitude of the induced emf in a coil of N turns e = ND(f) / Dt = ND(Ba2 - Bay) / Dt (4) Notice that the only thing in the numerator that changes in time is the value of y; so Equation (4) is equivalent to e = NBaDy / Dt = NBav (5) since the change in y with respect to time is just the definition of speed, for O < y < a. For all other values of y there is no change in the flux as time changes since the flux is constant through the coil except for O < y < a. See Fig. 24-4. Part (c). The power dissipated in the coil P = e2/R = N2B2a2v2 / R (6) Since the power is a constant, the total energy will be equal to the power multiplied by the time required for the coil to leave the field. time to leave field = a/v = distance/speed (7) Energy = (Power)time = N2B2a2v2/R (a/v) Energy = N2B2a3v/R (8) Part (d). Since the coil is moving with constant speed, the power is equal to the force times the speed. Power = Fv (5.13) So Force = Power/v = N2B2a2v2 / Rv = N2B2a2v / R (9) Thinking about the answers This problem illustrates the essential aspect of Faraday's Law - if the magnetic flux is not changing there is no induced electromotive force. So it is only as the coil goes from one region of constant flux to another that there is an induced emf. Try using your knowledge of the units of the various quantities in Equations 5, 6, 8 and 9 to verify that they are correct dimensionally. LENZ'S LAW 2. A square wire loop is rotated upward from the positive x-axis about one edge that lies along the y-axis in a constant B field that points in the upward Z-direction. What are the directions of current flow when the coil is in each of the four portions of space defined by the xy plane and the yz plane? What data are given? See Fig. 24-5. What data are implied? This problem seeks only a directional answer, so it need only be assumed that the coil is always moving in the same direction but not necessarily with the same angular speed. What physics principles are involved? Lenz's law is needed in conjunction with the definition of magnetic flux. What equations are to be used? No equations are used. The notion needed is that the current induced in the coil is in a direction so that its magnetic field opposes the changes in the magnetic flux linking the coil. Solution Let us designate the position of the coil by the location of the edge of the coil that is rotating in a circle about the y-axis, shown by the line p p' in See Fig. 24-5.. As the coil rotates up from the positive x-axis, what is happening to the flux linking the coil? Since f is the product of B times the component of the area perpendicular to B and B is constant, we need to focus our attention on the component of the area perpendicular to the field. This component of the area is maximum when the coil lies in the xy plane and zero when the coil is rotated into the yz plane. As the coil is being rotated up from the x-axis the area perpendicular to B is being reduced so the flux is decreasing. According to Lenz's Law then the magnetic field from the induced current will try to increase the flux so the field caused by the induced current will be upward in the positive Z-direction so the induced current around the coil will be such that the current is directly from p to p' by use of a right hand rule, See Fig. 23.4 in the textbook. We can write out the answer to this problem as follows: See Figure. Thinking about the answers Notice that the direction of induced current is determined by the direction of the changes in the flux. In this case the flux is always in the positive Z-direction, but the direction of current flow changes. INDUCTORS 3. If you have three inductors of value 3H, 5H and 7H respectively, (a) how many different ways can you connect them together in a circuit always using all three of them? (b) what are the effective inductance values for each connection? What data are given? You have a 3.0H inductor, a 5.0H inductor, and a 7.0H inductor connected in various ways. What data are implied? You may assume it is a single wire circuit, i.e. each combination hooks into the circuit at only two points, since multiple wire circuits are beyond the scope of our treatment. What physics principles are involved? We will use the conservation of energy and charge as discussed in Section 24.7 to derive the equations for combining inductors. What equations are to be used? Series connections: Leff = L1 + L2 + L3 (24.11) Parallel connections: 1/Leff = 1/L1 + 1/L2 + 1/L3 (24.12) Algebraic solutions Assume you have three inductors of values L1, L2, and L3. How many different ways can you connect them. Of course you can connect them all in series, or you can connect them all in parallel. That makes two different combinations. You can connect any one of them in series with the other two in parallel. That adds three more combinations. Finally you can connect any two of them in series in parallel with the third one. That adds three more combinations for a total of eight different combinations as shown below: See Fig. 24-6. The effective inductances of each combination are (A) Series Leff = L1 + L2 + L3 (10) (B) Parallel Leff = L1L2L3 / (L1L2 + L2L3 + L3L1) (11) (C) Two in parallel: Leff = L1 + L2L3 / L2 + L3 (12) (D) Two in parallel: Leff = L2 + L3L1 / (L1 + L3) (13) (E) Two in parallel: Leff = L3 + L1L2 / (L1 + L2) (14) (F) Two in series: Leff = L3(L1 + L2) / (L1 + L2 + L3) (15) (G) Two in series: Leff = L2(L1 + L3) / (L1 + L2 + L3) (16) (H) Two in series: Leff = L1(L2 + L3) / (L1 + L2 + L3) (17) Numerical solutions Let L1 = 3.0H; L2 = 5.0H; L3 = 7.0H. Then the numerical values for the eight combinations above are(A) Leff = 3.0H + 5.0H + 7.0H = 15H (B) Leff = (3.0)(5.0)(7.0) / [(3.0)(5.0) + (5.0)(7.0) + (3.0)(7.0)] = 1.5H (C) Leff = 3.0 + (5.0)(7.0) / (5.0 + 7.0) = 5.9H (D) Leff = 5.0 + (3.0)(7.0) / (3.0 + 7.0) = 7.1H (E) Leff = 7.0H + (3.0)(5.0) / (3.0 + 5.0) = 8.9H (F) Leff = (7.0)(3.0 + 5.0) / (3.0 + 5.0 + 7.0) = 3.7H (G) Leff = (5.0)(3.0 + 7.0) / 15.0 = 3.3H (H) Leff = (3.0)(5.0 + 7.0) / 15.0 = 2.4H Thinking about the answers Notice that the dimensions of each answer come out to be henries to the first power. The values range from a high value for all of them in series (A) to a low value of all of them in parallel (B). PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Problems; Answers; Questions; Electromagnetic Induction; Electricity And Magnetism; Electric Generators; Faraday's Law; Applications Of Electromagnetic Induction; Induced Current; Devices Using Faraday's Law; Induced EMF; Inductors; Inductance; Lenz's Law; Energy 1. The drawing below represents the top view of a simple generator. Sketch the initial direction of current flow through the coil. See Fig. b. What type of current will be generated by this mechanism? Sketch a graph showing how it will vary with time. c. Name four design changes which will result in producing increased current output for the above apparatus. 2. A large rectangular shaped core of 50 turns of copper wire is pulled quickly from an intense magnetic field of 2500 Gauss which is confined to an area of 25 cm by 25 cm. A voltmeter is connected into the turns of wire to measure the induced voltage. See Fig. a. If the coil of wire is pulled from the position shown with a velocity of 100 cm/ sec, find the voltage induced as indicated by the voltmeter. b. Show the direction of the induced current in the coil of wire. 3. The large coil below has an inductance of .35 henry. This inductor is connected through a switch to a 70 volt batter. An ammeter is also placed in the circuit as shown below. See Fig. a. Explain the initial reaction of the inductor at the instant the switch is closed. b. When the current reaches its maximum value, what energy will be stored in the inductor if the ohmic resistance of the inductor is 35 OHMS? c. Explain the initial reaction of the inductor at the instant when the switch is opened. ANSWERS: 1. Clockwise; AC; speed of rotation, strength of B, number of turns in armature, area of coil. 2. 3.1 volt, clockwise 3. Inertial resistance to the increased current, .7 Joule, inertial resistance to the decrease current flow tends to maintain flow or produce a spark at the switch which releases the energy stored in the magnetic field. Chapter Alternating Currents (25): Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Electricity And Magnetism; AC Current; Impedance; Reactance; Resonance; Quality Factor; Electromagnetic Oscillations; Measurements In AC AC Circuits; AC Circuits; Phasors; Transformers; RMS Voltage; RMS Current GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms and use it in an operational definition: effective values of current and voltage power factor reactance resonance impedance Q-factor AC Circuits Solve alternating-current problems involving resistance, inductance, and capacitance in a series circuit. Phasor Diagrams Draw phasor diagrams for alternating current circuits. Transformer Explain the operation of the transformer. AC Measurements Describe the use of alternating currents in physiological measurements. PREREQUISITES Before you begin this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 22, Basic Electrical Measurements, and Chapter 24, Electromagnetic Induction. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Electricity And Magnetism; AC Current The electrical energy utilized in the homes of America is delivered by the use of AC circuits. In this chapter you will learn about the nature of the AC circuit and its energy equivalent relationship with the DC circuit. An in-depth study of the AC circuit: additional components such as inductors and capacitors give the series AC circuit many interesting phase relationships and the property of resonance as outlined in Section 25.5. Then in Section 25.8, the Transformer and Its Application, you will study one of the major advantages in using AC circuits. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE The key Chapter Goals in this chapter are Definitions, AC Circuits, Transformer, and AC Measurement. When you begin your study of this chapter, be familiar with each of these goals. Remember that each of the terms listed under Definitions is discussed in some detail in the first section of this chapter. Next, read Chapter Sections 25.1-25.9. Answers to the questions you encounter in your reading are answered in the second section of this chapter. In section 25.9, pay particular attention to Table 25.1. Now turn to the end of the chapter and read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-6 and 8-10. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1-4, 6, and 7, and Exercises and Problems 1-3, 5, 9, 11, 12, and 15. Check your answers to each of these questions against the answers given. If you have difficulty, refer back to the correct text section. For more practice with the concepts introduced in this chapter, see the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test on Alternating Currents provided at the end of this chapter. Complete the entire test before you check your answers. If you have difficulty with any part of the test, refer to either the appropriate section of the or the text. This Study Procedure is outlined below. -----------------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -----------------------------Definitions 25.1 1, 2, 3, 4 AC Circuits 25.2, 25.3, 5, 6 1, 2, 3, 1, 2, 3, 25.4, 25.5 4, 6 5, 9 Transformers 25.8 8 7 11, 12 AC Measurements 25.9 9, 10 15 ----------------------------------------------------Phasor Diagrams 25.4 7 5 7, 8 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Electricity And Magnetism; AC Current; Impedance; Reactance; Resonance; Quality Factor; Electromagnetic Oscillations; Measurements In AC AC Circuits; AC Circuits; Phasors; RMS Voltage; RMS Current EFFECTIVE VALUES OF CURRENT & VOLTAGE The values of AC current and AC voltage which will produce the identical heating in a resistor as a DC circuit. These values are referred to as RMS values meaning Root Mean Square. REACTANCE The proportionality factor (measured in ohms) between the current and voltage for capacitors and inductors in AC circuits. Two typical kinds of reactance are capacitive reactance (XC) and inductive reactance (XL), IMPEDANCE Just as ohms law for DC circuits defines resistance as the ratio of voltage (v) to the current (I), for AC circuits, the impedance of an AC circuit is the ratio of the effective voltage to the effective current. POWER FACTOR Equals the cosine of the phase angle, f, between voltage and current in an AC circuit. When f = 0ø, the maximum power is dissipated in the AC circuit. RESONANCE Occurs when the frequency of the external force equals a natural frequency of the system. The condition present in an RLC circuit when XL = XC . Q-FACTOR A measure of the sharpness of resonance. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; AC Circuits; Transformers; RMS Current; RMS Voltage; Measurements In AC Circuits; Quality Factor; Resonance; Energy; Inductors; Electricity And Magnetism SECTION 25.1 Introduction In alternating current circuits the electrical voltage is continuously changing since the voltage is given by a periodic function of time such as sin wt where w is the frequency. In the United States of America 60Hz or 120p radians/second is the usual frequency of AC circuits. Since the sine function changes its sign from positive to negative and back, this kind of electrical circuit is called an alternating current circuit. Usually electrical devices with no moving parts will work on either AC or DC. However the transformer is a major exception. This device with no moving parts is used to connect two portions of a circuit by means of linking, fluctuating electromagnetic fields. They are highly efficient devices for changing one voltage into another. SECTION 25.2 Nomenclature Used for Alternating Currents Since we specify, in common usage, the effective, or rms, value of an AC current or voltage the heating effect of AC and DC circuits are the same for equal currents -- as long as we used rms values for the AC circuit parameters. Remember it means that the actual current and voltages in the AC circuit vary by plus or minus 140% of the stated AC values, e.g. for the usual 110V line in a house the voltage maximum varies from - 155V to + 155V. SECTION 25.5 Resonance Questions - 1. The maximum current in a resonance circuit is determined by the effective resistance of the circuit. At resonance the current will be given by the voltage divided by the resistance. 2. At any instant in time the total energy of an AC circuit must add up to the input energy. But consider capacitors and inductors as devices that are able to store energy for some periods of time. Then at a time when energy has been stored in a capacitor it would be possible to take energy from the capacitor and from the emf itself to increase, for a short time, the energy stored in the inductor. SECTION 25.7 Q-Factor Questions - 3. The energy stored in an inductor is given by 1/2L I 2 and the energy dissipated in a circuit is I2R. Clearly then the ratio of energy stored to energy dissipated is proportional to the ratio of L to R. But L/R is also proportional to the Q-factor. In fact, if you divide the ratio of the energy stored to energy dissipated by the period of a cycle then you have the following: [(1/2 L I2) / (I2R)] / T = (L/2R) / (1/f) = fL / 2R = wL / 4pR = Q / 4p so the ratio of energy stored to energy dissipated per cycle is proportional to Q, in fact, it is equal to Q divided by 4p. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; AC Current; AC Circuits; Impedance; Reactance; Frequency; LRC Circuits; Quality Factor; Electricity And Magnetism; Phasors; Conservation Of Energy; Conservation Of Charge; Resistance; Ohm's Law; Measurement In AC Circuits; Graphs AC CIRCUITS 1. Consider a series AC circuit which contains a resistor of 100 ohms, a capacitor of 16.7 microfarads, and an inductor of 240 millihenries connected to a 100 volt (rms) variable frequency power supply. (a) Calculate the resistance, capacitive reactance, inductive reactance, impedance, current, and phase angle for frequencies of 15.9 Hz, 47.7 Hz, 79.6 Hz, 111 Hz, and 143 Hz. (b) Draw the following graphs for this circuit (i) Capacitive reactance versus frequency (ii) Inductive reactance versus frequency (iii) Resistance versus frequency (iv) (XL - XC) versus frequency (v) Z versus frequency (vi) Phase angle versus frequency (c) For what frequency is the phase angle equal to zero? (d) Draw the phasor diagram for each of the above frequencies. (e) Calculate the Q factor for this circuit and draw a graph of the current versus the frequency. Show the half-width on the graph and illustrate the Q factor. What data are given? The circuit as shown below is given: See Fig. 25-1. What data are implied? All of the circuit components are assumed to be ideal. The power supply has zero effective impedance. The resistor has zero reactance and the reactances have zero resistance. What physics principles are involved? Ohm's Law and the conservation of energy and charge as applied to AC circuits as discussed in Section 25.4 of the text. What equations are to be used? Capacitive Reactance XC = 1 / 2pfC ohms (25.11) Inductive Reactance XL = 2pfL ohms (25.9) Resistance R = R ohms; independent of f Total Reactance = XL - XC = 2pfL - 1 / 2pfC Impedance = SQR RT[R2 + (XL - XC)2] (25.19) Phase Angle; tan q = (XL - XC) / R (25.20) Zero Phase Angle occurs when XL = XC; wo = 1 / SQR RT[LC] (25.23) Q-Factor Q = woL / R (25.24) Current = Applied Voltage / Z (25.12) Solutions To solve this problem we can now just enter the correct numbers from the problem into these various equations. Rather than show all of the arithmetic, which is easily accomplished with any hand calculator, let us just collect our numerical results in a Table. See Figs. 25-2. (c) Phase angle = zero at wo = 500 rad/s; f = 79.6 Hz. (d) w = 99.9 rad/s w = 300 rad/s See Fig. (e) Q Factor = woL / R = (500)(0.240) / 100 = 1.2 w2 - w1 = wo/Q = 500/1.2 = 417 rad/s See fig. Thinking about the answers Notice that in general the curves are not symmetrical about the resonance frequency. This occurs because the impedance does not depend in a symmetric way on the frequency when the reactance changes from being primarily capacitive to primarily inductive. The curves we have drawn are characteristic of all AC series circuits. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Answers; Problems; Questions; AC Current Transformers; Voltage; RMS Current; Resistors; Anatomy And Physiology; Cardiovascular System; Resistance; LRC Circuits; AC Circuits; Electricity And Magnetism; Measurements In AC Circuits 1. The apparatus shown below is used to show the properties of the transformer. The primary and secondary windings have a common core of heavy iron. The input is from a 120 volt - AC household line. See Fig. ________a. If the voltmeter shows 6 volts, how many turns are in the secondary winding? b. If the resistor (R) in the external secondary circuit is 12 ohms, what RMS current will be measured by the ammeter? What maximum IMAX = "peak" current? (Show your calculations.) IRMS =_______ IMAX = 2. Most electrical signals generated by the body are AC in nature. One common example is the voltage detected in a heart E.C.G. measurement. ________a. What is the approximate voltage of this body generated signal? ________b. Explain briefly what electrical hazards exists for a patient while this measurement is being made. 3. The patient below is inadvertently connected in a series with a 50.0 volts of a 60.0 cycle AC line while being monitored by an ECG unit. See Fig. Assume that the body in this situation acts like a series circuit of R = 2000 OHMS and the ECG unit provides an inductance of .100 henry and a capacitance of 0 2.00mfd. ________a. At 60.0 cycles what is the equivalent impedance of this unfortunate circuit? ________b. What current will flow through the patient? ________c. Is this current dangerous? Explain your answer. ANSWER: 1. 50 turns, Irms = .5 amp, IMAX = .71 amps 2. millivolts, most electrical hazards are associated with electrical leaks in equipment. If the patient touches a ground (wet floor, faucet, metal bed post, etc.) a complete circuit could result and allow current to flow through the body. Leakage currents higher than 10-3 amps are considered dangerous. 3. 2380 Ohms, .02 amps. It is the current through the heart that is dangerous. At this level, 20 milliamps could be a problem, especially if the voltage is continuous, allowing the body's effective resistance to reduce as the moving current alters the body's resistance. Chapter Bioelectronics and Instrumentation (26): to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications: Citation: H. Q Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications.(Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors. 26 Bioelectronics and Instrumentation Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Feedback; Electronics; Diodes; Oscilloscopes; Amplifiers; Electricity And Magnetism; Stability; Noise; Signal Processing; Transistors GOALS When you have mastered the content of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms and use each term in an operational definition: feedback interference noise linearity signal-to-noise ratio amplification stability frequency response Electronic Devices Explain the basis of operation and potential use for each of the following: diode rectifier differential amplifier transistor amplifier oscilloscope operational amplifier Oscilloscopes Evaluate the specifications provided for commercially produced oscilloscopes PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 21, Electrical Properties of Matter, Chapter 22, Basic Electrical Measurements, Chapter 23, Magnetism, and Chapter 25, Alternating Currents. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Electricity And Magnetism; Electronics; Instructions The advent of transistors has greatly altered the effectiveness and the use of monitoring instrumentation. In this chapter you will learn about the basic electronic circuitry and about the important functions performed by transistors. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE The three goals of this chapter are: Definitions, Electric Devices, andOscilloscopes. First, read each of these Chapter Goals carefully. An extended discussion of each of the terms listed under the goal of Definitions can be found in the first section of this chapter. Next, read Chapter Sections 26.1-26.6. As you read, be sure to make good use of the figures provided. Figures 26.2, 26.3, and 26.6 are especially important to your understanding of the contents of this chapter. Now turn to the end of the chapter. Read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-10. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1 and 2 and complete Exercises and Problems 1-3. Check each of your answers carefully against those given in these sections. For more work with the concepts presented in the chapter, now turn to the Examples section of this Study Guide chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test provided at the end of this chapter. Complete the entire test before you check your answers. If you have difficulty with any of the concepts, check back to your text or to a section of this for further assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. -------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -------------------Definitions 26.1, 26.2 1 Electronic 26.2,26.3, 2,3,4,5, 1,2 1,2,3 Devices 26.4,26.5 6,7,8,9 Oscilloscopes 26.6 10 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Feedback; Electronics; Noise; Signal Processing; Amplifiers; Stability; Electricity And Magnetism FEEDBACK The portion of the output from a system which is returned as input into the same system. LINEARITY Refers to the condition when the output (0) has a linear relationship with the input (I). If the input signal is being amplified by a factor of 5, a linear condition will assure that each output signal is five times the input signal. AMPLIFICATION The ratio of output signal to input signal of a device. The input signal to be amplified might be current, voltage, or power. FREQUENCY RESPONSE Refers to the range of input frequencies that yield linear outputs for an instrument or device. INTERFERENCE NOISE A random signal from the environment which interferes with the reception and monitoring of a signal. A typical problem in laboratory practice is the interference noise from typical 60 Hz equipment like lights, xerox machines, motors, etc. SIGNAL-TO-NOISE-RATIO Refers to the ratio of the signal amplitude to the undesirable noise signal in a measuring system. In practice, reproducible measurements require that this ratio be approximately 10. STABILITY Refers to the ability of a system to return to a previously established stable base line when the input is zero. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Answers; ; Oscilloscopes; Anatomy And Physiology; Cardiovascular Systems; Electronics; Electricity And Magnetism; Applications SECTION 26.6 Oscilloscope Questions - 1. To observe an unusual pulse shape such as a heart beat we would probably want to set the oscilloscope to trigger on the incoming (external) signal. We probably want to see two or three complete cycles of the heart beat, let's say three. Since there are 72 beats in one minute; 3 beats will take 1/24 of a minute or 2 1/2 seconds. Typical oscilloscopes have a 10 centimeter horizontal sweep distance, so the 2 1/2 seconds should occupy 10 centimeters, or 0.25 seconds/cm. Compare this answer with the heart beat traces in Figure 22.15. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; Electronics; Electricity And Magnetism; ; Oscilloscopes OSCILLOSCOPES 1. Suppose you are using a photomultiplier tube with an output impedance of 50 ohms to study a very fast light pulse. You estimate the light pulse will have a half width of 8 nanoseconds and cause the photomultiplier to put out a current of 25 milliamps. What oscilloscope specifications should you state if you wish to observe the light pulse on the screen of an oscilloscope? What data are given? The impedance = 50 ohms. The time duration is 8 nanoseconds. The current output is 25 mA. What data are implied? The photomultiplier is connected directly into the input terminals of the oscilloscope. It can be assumed that we will want to trigger the oscilloscope on the incoming signal. What physics principles are involved? The physical characteristics of the oscilloscopes discussed in Section 26.6 of the text. Solution First we note that an oscilloscope is a kind of voltmeter so we need to determine the size of the voltage pulse we are hoping to observe. The photomultiplier is expected to put out a current of 25 mA across a 50 ohm resistor so the voltage pulse will have a peak of about 1.25 volts. So a voltage sensitivity of about 200 mV/cm would give us a voltage pulse about 6 cm high on the oscilloscope screen. A time base that would spread out the pulse would be best, so a sweep speed of 1 ns/cm would give us a pulse 8 cm wide at half maximum. That is probably too wide for photographing the pulse so 2 ns/cm would be better. We need a oscilloscope with a fast rise time, able to track this fast signal. It would be good to have a rise time much faster than the rise time we expect from the voltage pulse. A rise time of 1 ns would be good. A time period of 1 ns corresponds to a frequency of 109 Hz or 1 GHz. In addition we will probably want to trigger on the external signal which will have a voltage pulse of 1.25 V so we need a trigger sensitivity less than that. To avoid oscillations setup by the high frequency components of this voltage pulse we should terminate the input cable with a 50 ohm resistor at the oscilloscope. Thinking about the answer There are a great variety of oscilloscopes and except for the general use introductory ones they all are designed for special uses. The kind of oscilloscope you select for use needs to be matched to your needs. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Answers; Problems; Questions; Electronics; Electricity And Magnetism; Diodes; Oscilloscopes; Frequency 1. Medical monitoring devices which rely upon electric instrumentation are sometimes limited in the range of measurements which can be made. One of the limitations is called frequency response. a. Briefly describe the term frequency response and explain why it is important in making electronic measurements. b. What is the frequency response range of a typical oscilloscope? Explain what this range implies about the use of oscilloscopes for making measurements. 2. The diode circuit below is connected to a 60 cycle, AC source producing 4 volts, rms. See Fig. a. Trace the signal shown on the screen of oscilloscope A. b. Trace the signal shown on the screen of oscilloscope B. c. Name and briefly describe at least two uses of the diode in electronic instrumentation. ANSWERS: 1. a) Many signals to be measured and monitored are oscillating. The matching of this frequency to the frequency response of the measuring device assures an accurate and reliable measurement. The frequency response in the range of frequencies to which a system (electronic or mechanical) can respond without distortion. b) Typical bandwidth: (0-15 megahertz, 0-16 x 106 hertz) The oscilloscope is a very versatile instrument for making measurements. It can respond to nearly any frequency and represent that signal visually as well as accurately. 2. See Fig. c) Rectifier temperature transducer diode is used extensively. Chapter Quantum and Relativistic Physics (27): to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications: Citation: H. Q Fuller, and R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications. (Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors 27 Quantum and Relativistic Physics Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Modern Physics; Quantum Theory; Planck Theory; Planck's Constant; Planck's Quantum Hypothesis; Planck's Radiation Law; Wien's Displacement Law; Photons; Photon Theory Of Light; Photoelectric Effect; Work Functions; Photoelectric Equation; Theory Of Relativity; Mass Increase; Theory Of Special Relativity; Length Of Contraction; Time Dilation; Relativistic Mechanics; Mass And Energy; Quantum Mechanics; De Broglie's Hypothesis; Heisenberg Uncertainty Principle; Compton Effect; Wave-Particle Duality; Tunneling Effect GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter you should be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: Planck's constant length contraction Planck's radiation law time dialation Wien's law mass-energy equivalence photon Compton scattering photoelectric effect complementarity principle work function deBroglie wave relativistic mass uncertainty principle Quantum and Relativistic Problems Solve problems involving Wien's law, photoelectric effect, Compton scattering, deBroglie waves, the uncertainty principle, and relativistic physics formulations. Tunnel Effect Define and explain the physical significance of the tunnel effect. PREREQUISITE You should have mastered the goals of Chapter 4, Forces and Newton's Laws, Chapter 5, Energy, and Chapter 21, Electrical Properties of Matter, before starting this chapter. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Quantum Theory; Modern Physics; Theory Of Special Relativity; Theory Of Relativity Until the end of the nineteenth century, science viewed the basic quantities of a particle (energy and momentum) as being continuous. With new phenomena being investigated (radiation, photoelectric effect, etc.) it became necessary to alter this basic view to allow each of these quantities to change only in discrete (quantized) amounts. In this chapter, you will read about several of these phenomena and to study the hypotheses which result from the change. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE This chapter places emphasis on three Chapter Goals: Definitions, Quantum and Relativistic Problems, and Tunnel Effect. When you begin to study this chapter, read these goals carefully. Remember, a discussion of the terms listed under the goal of Definitions can be found in the first section of this chapter. Now read text sections 27.1-27.9. As you read, please note the importance of the initial work by Plank on the electromagnetic radiator, and Einstein on the Photoelectric Effect. A summary of Einstein's Theory of Relativity is found in Section 27.4. Also, be sure that you deal seriously with section 27.9 and work carefully through the examples provided. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-18. Check your answers carefully against those given on page 623. If you have difficulty, refer to the section referencing given. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1-7, and Exercises and Problems 1-4, 6-10 and 20. For more work with the important concepts of this chapter, turn to the Examples section of this chapter. Be sure to see the tunnel effect example included in this section. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test provided at the end of this chapter. Be sure to work all the test parts before you check your answers. For more assistance, refer back to the text or to this procedure. This study procedure is outlined below. ------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems ------------------Definitions 27.1,27.2 1-11 1 1-4 Quantum & 27.2,27.3,27.4, 12-17 2-7 6-10,20 Relativistic 27.5,27.6,27.7, Problems 27.8 Tunnel Effect 27.9 18 (see example in ) DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Modern Physics; Quantum Theory; Planck Theory; Planck's Constant; Planck's Quantum Hypothesis; Planck's Radiation Law; Wien's Displacement Law; Photons; Photon Theory Of Light; Photoelectric Effect; Work Functions; Photoelectric Equation; Theory Of Relativity; Mass Increase; Theory Of Special Relativity; Length Of Contraction; Time Dilation; Relativistic Mechanics; Mass And Energy; Quantum Mechanics; De Broglie's Hypothesis; Heisenberg Uncertainty Principle; Compton Effect; Wave-Particle Duality; Tunneling Effect PLANCK'S CONSTANT (h) The proportionally constant for energy quanta equal to 6.64 x 10-34 Joule/sec. According to Plank's hypothesis, radiation can only have energy given by En = nhf, where h is Plank's constant. PLANCK'S RADIATION LAW Predicts the thermal radiation intensity as a function of wavelength for a black body at temperature T (øK). WEIN'S DISPLACEMENT LAW Predicts the relationship between the absolute temperature and wavelength for maximum thermal radiation for a perfect radiator. PHOTON The quantum of electromagnetic energy given by the product of Planck's constant and the frequency of the radiation. Einstein first suggested the possibility for photons when discussing the photoelectric effect in 1905. PHOTOELECTRIC EFFECT The phenomena that results in electron emission from materials when radiated with electromagnetic radiation. As light is incident in various metal surfaces, electrons are ejected from the metal surface. Study of the cause and effect relationships found in this experiment led to the photon theory for light. WORK FUNCTION The energy required to free an electron from the surface of a metal. RELATIVISTIC MASS The special theory of relativity predicts that the mass of an object increases as its speed, v, approaches the speed of light, c. LENGTH CONTRACTION Another consequence of the special theory of relativity. It predicts that the apparent length of an object (measured along the direction of motion) becomes shorter as the objects speed approaches the speed of light (c). TIME DILATION The special theory of relativity predicts that moving clocks run slow. MASS-ENERGY RELATION Einstein's special theory of relativity predicts the famous mass-energy equivalence given by E = mc2. Another consequence of the special theory of relativity requires that we consider mass and energy as two forms of the same physical quantity. These forms are related through the famous energy-mass equation which involves the speed of light. COMPTON EFFECT The phenomena that results in scattered electrons when photons of incident radiation interact with weakly bound electrons in metals. The loss of energy of the scattered photons (or increase in length) occurs in descrete quantum amounts depending upon the angle of scattering. COMPLEMENTARITY PRINCIPLE This principle defined by N. Bohr uses both the wave and particle nature of matter and radiation. Is light a particle or a wave? The model we choose depends on the nature of the experiment. This dual description is not a conflict, but these models complement one another. DE BROGLIE WAVES The matter waves that were postulated by de Broglie to have a wave length equal to Planck's constant divided by the momentum of the particle. These wave characteristics have been detected for small particles such as electrons. Electron diffraction and electron interference experiments have shown that the dual particle-wave model can be extended to include even larger particles. UNCERTAINTY PRINCIPLE Heisenberg's formulation of the limits of simultaneous knowledge of position and momentum and energy and time in modern quantum theory. The two forms of this principle (Equations 27.16 and 27.17) express the upper limits of preciseness which we may know the position, velocity and/or energy of an observed particle. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Wave-Particle Duality; Modern Physics; Quantum Theory; Quantum Mechanics; De Broglie's Hypothesis SECTION 27.6 Complementary Principle In the political-economic areas the Marxist-Leninist political- economic model with its emphasis on the collective structure of a society is in sharp contrast to the classical theory of capitalism with its strong political and economic emphasis on individual rights and enterprise. Today it seems likely that most countries have "mixed" economies that combine features of both models. The strict adherents of each model claim the other model as the deadly enemy of themselves and the future of humankind. Can we think of these two models as two aspects of a complementarity principle? SECTION 27.7 The deBroglie Wave The thermal neutrons are useful for studying crystals structures since their deBroglie wavelength and range are such as to produce good diffraction patterns from crystal lattices. X-rays of the proper wavelength for diffraction from crystals are of greater penetration in solids and do not readily diffract from the lower mass atoms found in organic crystals. Electrons of proper wavelength for diffraction from crystals are of such low energy and penetration that they produce diffraction patterns from surface layers or thin films of matter. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Modern Physics; Quantum Theory; Quantum Mechanics; Planck's Quantum Hypothesis; Photon Theory Of Light; Photelectric Effect; Photons; Electrons; Compton Effect; Conservative Laws; Conservation Of Energy; Conservation Of Momentum; Wavelength; De Broglie's Hypothesis; Algebra; Heisenberg Uncertainty Principle; Time Dilation; Wien's Displacement Law; Theory Of Special Relativity; Distance; Time; Velocity QUANTUM AND RELATIVISTIC PROBLEMS 1. Photoelectric Effect. When a copper surface is irradiated with 254 nm light from a mercury arc it is found that the photocurrent can be stopped by a potential of 0.24 volts. (a) What is the energy of the incident photons? (b) What is the energy of the photo electrons? (c) What is the work function in eV of copper? (d) What is the threshold wavelength for copper? What data are given? The incident light has l = 254 nm. The photoelectrons are stopped by a potential of 0.24 volts. What data are implied? A typical experimental set-up as shown in Figure 27.2 in the textbook is assumed. What physics principles are involved? Einstein's theory of the photoelectric effect, as discussed in Section 27.3 of the text, will be needed. What equations are to be used? E = hf = hc / l = KE + W (27.6) KE = qV (21.16) Solutions (a) Incident Photon Energy = hf = hc / l = ((6.63 x 10-34 J ¥ s)(3 X 1017 nm/sec)) / 254 nm = 7.83 x 10-19 J = 4.89 eV (b) The energy of the photoelectrons is given by the stopping potential, so KE of photoelectrons = 0.24eV = 3.8 x 10-20J. (c) Work function in eV = 4.89eV - 0.24eV = 4.65eV. It is the difference between the incident photon energy and the kinetic energy of the photoelectrons. (d) Threshold wavelength = hc / E = hc / 4.65eV = [(6.63 x 10-34 J ¥ s) x (1eV/(1.6 x 10-19 J)) x 3.00 x (1017 nm/s)] / 4.65eV = 267 nm. Thinking about the answer The two wavelengths of light that are mentioned in this problem are in the ultraviolet part of the spectra. Neither of them is visible to humans. Copper is not a photoelectron emitter in visible light. 2. Compton Scattering. A 0.0104 nm photon is scattered through 60ø by a collision with an electron. (a) What happens? (b) What is the final wavelength of the photon? (c) What is the final velocity of the electron. What data are given? The initial energy of the photon is given as 0.0104 nm and the scattered angle is given as 60ø. What data are implied? It is assumed that the electron is essentially at rest when struck by the photon. What physics principles are to be used? The conservation of momentum and energy for particles of light was done by Compton, see Section 27.5 in the book. What equations are to be used? Wavelength shift l' - l = (h / (moC)) ¥ (1 - cos f) (27.14) Momentum conservation hf/c - hf'/c cos f = Pe cos q (1) hf'/c sin f = Pe sin q (2) Algebraic solutions Part (b) is found by using equation 27.14. To find an expression for the velocity of the electron we can combine Equations (1) and (2). To find the angle of electron departure, divide Equation (2) by Equation (1) where l = c / f, tan q = (h/l' sin f) / (h/l - ((h cos f/l')) tan q = (l sin f) / (l' - l cos f) (3) Similarly to find the magnitude of the electron velocity, square Equations (1) and (2) and add them together, remember sin2q + cos 2q = 1 Pe2sin2q + Pe2cos2q = (h2/l'2) sin2f + (h/l - h/l' cos f)2 If the electron does not travel at relativistic speeds, then (me)2(ve)2 ÷ Pe2 = h2/l'2 + h2/l2 - (2h2)/ll' cos f (ve)2 ÷ h2/(me)2 ¥ (1/l2 + 1/l'2 - ((2cosf) / ll') ve ÷ h/me ¥ (SQR RT) (1/l2 + 1/l'2 - ((2cosf) / ll') (4) Numerical solutions (a) When the photon is treated as a particle then this phenomena can be discussed as if it were a typical classical collision problem. The incident object (a photon) collides with a massive, stationary object (an electron) and both go off after the collision in different directions. Both energy and momentum are conserved for the collision process so if the initial energy of the incident particle and its scattered angle are known all the other results of the collision can be calculated. (b) The calculation of the final wavelength of the scattering photon is straight forward using equation 27.14: l' = 0.0104nm + (2.43 x 10-12 (1 - cos 60ø)) = 10.4 x 10-12 + 1.2 x 10-12 lø = 1.16 x 10-11 m. (c) The calculation of the angle and magnitude of the electron velocity after the collision is done using Equations (3) and (4). tan q = (1.04 x 10-11 sin 60ø) / (1.16 x 10-11 - 1.04 x 10-11 cos 60ø) tanq = 1.41 q = 54.6ø ve = (6.63 x 10-34J ¥ S)/(9.1 x 10-31kg) ¥ (SQR RT)[1/(1.04 x 10-11)2 + 1/(1.16 x 10-11)2 ((2 cos 60ø)/(1.04 x 10-11)(1.16 x 10 -11))] = 7.29 x 10-4 ¥ (SQR RT)(9.25 x 1021 + 7.43 x 1021 + 8.29 x 1021) ve = 7.29 x 10-4 ¥ (SQR RT)(2.50 x 1022) ve = 1.15 x 108 m/s Thinking about the answers You can see that the scattered photon has a longer wavelength, hence a lower energy than the incident photon. During the scattering process the photon loses energy and the electron gains energy. In the above problem the incident photon lost about 10% of its energy in the collision. Can you verify this value for the photon energy loss. Since the value obtained for ve is near the speed of light, the classical approximation used to derive Equation (4) is not valid. The momentum equation 27.9 should have been used. 3. deBROGLIE WAVES. Derive an expression for the wavelength associated with the molecules of a gas whose absolute temperature is TøK. Then calculate the wavelength associated with oxygen molecules at room temperature (300øK). What data are given? The absolute temperature of the gas is TøK. For the specific case of the oxygen molecules T = 300øK. What data are implied? The gas can be assumed to obey the kinetic theory of ideal gases. The mass of the gas molecules must be known, call it m. We can calculate the mass of the oxygen molecule from the periodic chart (p. 754) and Avogadro's number. 1 gram molecular wt. of 02 = 32.0 gm and contains 6.02 x 1023 molecules. mo2 = 32.0 gm / 6.02 x 1023 = 3.20 x 10-2 kg / 6.02 x 1023 = 5.32 x 10-26 kg. What physics principles are involved? The properties of an ideal gas, Section 14.3, must be combined with the deBroglie hypothesis, Section 27.7. What equations are to be used? The kinetic energy of a gas molecule 1/2mv2 = 3/2kT (14.15) deBroglie wavelength l = h/p = h/mv if v << c (27.15) Algebraic solution The rms velocity of a gas molecule is found from Equation 14.15 1/2 mv2 = 3/2 kT (5) v = (SQR RT)((3kT)/m) So the deBroglie wavelength for a gas molecule is given by l = h/[m ¥ (SQR RT)((3kT)/m)] = h/(SQR RT)(3mkT) Numerical solution For room temperature oxygen T = 300ø m = 5.32 x 10-26kg lo2 = 6.63 x 10-34J¥s/(SQR RT)[3(5.32 x 10-26kg)(1.38 x 10-23 J/moleøK)(300øK)] lo2 = 2.58 x 10-11 meters Thinking about the answer This wavelength is much smaller than any usual laboratory diffraction grating spacing and will not be easily detected by any usual means. 4. UNCERTAINTY PRINCIPLE. Consider a proton trapped in a nucleus of 6.0 x 10-15m in diameter. Suppose the potential barrier holding the proton in the nucleus is 24 MeV. (a) What is the uncertainty in the momentum of the proton? (b) What is the uncertainty in the energy of the proton. (c) What is the minimum energy the proton needs to escape from the nucleus? (d) What is the lifetime of the proton in this nucleus? What data are given? The uncertainty in the position of the proton is 6.0 x 10-15m. The height of the potential barrier is 24 MeV. What data are implied? The classical, nonrelativistic relationships between momentum and energy are good approximations in this problem. The mass of the proton is 1.7 x 10-27 kg. What physics principles are involved? This problem uses the Heisenberg Uncertainty Principle. What equations are to be used? DP Dx ò h (27.16) DE Dt ò h (27.17) Solutions (a) Uncertainty in momentum ÷ h/Dx = (6.63 x 10-34 J ¥ s)/(6.0 x 10-15m) DP ÷ 1.1 x 10-19N ¥ s (b) Uncertainty in energy = (DP)2/2m = (1.1 x 10-19)2 / (2(1.7 x 10-27)) = 3.6 x 10-12 J = 22.4 MeV. (c) Minimum Energy to Escape = 24 MeV - 22.4 MeV = 1.6 MeV (d) Lifetime ÷ h / DE ÷ (6.63x 10-34J ¥ s) / (3.6 x 10-12J) ÷ 1.8 x 10-22 seconds. 5. A Space Ship traveling at 0.6 c passes a "stationary" observer. Both the observer and the spaceship are provided with identical timers, which they start the instant they pass. Each timer is wired to a light, which flashes after ten seconds has elapsed. (a) Which light does the stationary observer believe flashes first? (b) Which light does the spaceship crew believe flashes first? (c) How much time does the stationary observer believe has elapsed on the observers own timer when the one on the spaceship flashes? (d) How much times does the spaceship crew believe has elapsed on the stationary timer when their own spaceship light flashes? (e) How far apart are the two timers when the one on the spaceship flashes according to the stationary observer? (f) How far apart are the two timers when the one on the spaceship flashes according to the spaceship crew? (g) How long does it take the light from the first spaceship light flash to reach the stationary observer, according to the observers timer? (h) How long does it take the light from the first spaceship light flash to reach the stationary observer, according to the spaceship crew? (i) What time does the spaceship crew believe is shown on the stationary timer for the time of flight? (j) From your above results fill out the table below: See Fig. (k) What do the two reporters agree upon? disagree upon? What data are given? The spaceship travels at 0.6c (2.4 x 108m/s) past the observer. Lights are flashed every 10 seconds according to a clock connected to the light flasher. What data are implied? The conditions of special relativity are satisfied. What physics principles are involved? The concept of time dilation is used in conjunction with the classical concepts of distance, time, and velocity. What equations are to be used? Time dilation Dt = Dto / (SQR RT)(1 - (v2/c2)) (27.8) Distance = vt (3.2) Solution (a) The stationary observer knows that moving clocks run slow. So the observer can calculate how long 10 seconds will seem to be in the spaceship, according to the observers clock. (SQR RT)(1 - (v2/c2)) = (SQR RT)(1 - (0.6c/c)2) = (SQR RT)(1 - .36) = (SQR RT)(.64) = 0.8 So a spaceship 10.0 seconds would appear to be 10/0.8 or 12.5 seconds on the observers clock. The observer believes the spaceship light flashes after the observers light has already flashed. (b) The spaceship crew believes that moving clocks run slow, but according to them the observer is the one who is moving. Consequently when 10 seconds has passed on their clock the observers clock will show a number smaller than 10 seconds, in fact they compute a time of (0.8) (10 sec) = 8 seconds will show on the observers clock when their light flashes. Which, according to them, occurs a full two seconds on the observers clock before the observers light flashes. So both parties believe the other light flashes after their own light has already flashed. (c) We answered above, 12.5 seconds. (d) We answered above, 8.0 seconds. (e) According to the observer the spaceship has been traveling at 0.6c for 12.5 seconds when the spaceship light flashes, so d = (0.6c) (12.5), d = 7.5c. (f) According to the spaceship crew they have been traveling for 10 seconds when their light flashes so they are d = (0.6c) (10 sec) or 6c from the observer when their light flashes. (g) Since, according to the observer, the light was 7.5c away and light travels at a speed c it will take 7.5 seconds to reach the observer. (h) The spaceship crew has a tough problem to solve. They are 6c away from an object which is going away from them at a speed of 0.6c. So they send a message to that moving object at a speed of c, how long will it take to catch up? Let t' be the time to catch up; then 0.6c t' is the distance the moving object travels in t' seconds, that distance plus 6c will be equal to the distance the message travels which is ct' 0.6ct' + 6c = ct' 6 = 0.4t' t' = 15 seconds. So according to the spaceship crew it will take 15 seconds for their light flash to reach the observer. (i) However, the spaceship crew knows that the observers clock runs slow, so the 15 seconds on their clock will appear as (15sec)(0.8) or 12 seconds on the observers clock. (j) We can now fill in the table: See Fig. (k) The reporters agree on the time of arrival of the flash at the observers clock. They disagree about intermediate computed quantities. 6. Wien's Law - (a) If the absolute temperature of an object is doubled what happens to its emitted radiations? (b) What is a low temperature limit for the emission of visible light? What data are given? (a) The absolute temperature of the emitted body is doubled. What data are implied? (b) Let us take the low energy limit for visible light to be 700 nm. What physics principles are involved? This problem makes use of Planck's Law for black body radiation as expressed in Wien's Law. What equation is to be used? Wien's Law: lmax T = 2.88 x 10-3møK (27.5) Solutions (a) If the absolute temperature is doubled, then the peak wavelength of the light is halved. If the original wavelength is red, the final wavelength would be in the violet, the total spectrum would become whiter. This explains the fact that white hot objects are hotter than red hot objects. (b) lmax ÷ 700 nm = 7 x 10-7 m T = (2.88 x 10-3øK) / (7x10-7) = 4.1 x 103øK = ÷ 3800øC This is a relatively low temperature for a hot object, about 1600ø cooler than the sun's surface. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Answers; Questions; Problems; Modern Physics; Theory Of Special Relativity; Length Contraction; Mass Increase; Time Dilation; Relativistic Mechanics; Postulates Of Special Relativity; Photon Theory Of Light; Photons ; Photoelectric Effect; Quantum Theory; Tunneling Effect; Kinetic Energy 1. Einstein's theory of Relativity was a milestone in the development of scientific thought in the 20th century. a. State the two postulates upon which Einstein based his special theory of relativity. Postulate 1: Postulate 2: b. Briefly describe the consequences of observers in one frame of reference measuring time, distance, and mass in a frame which is moving at speeds approaching the velocity of light. 2. Light of wavelength 200 nm falls on an aluminum surface where 4.20 eV's are required to remove electrons. a. What is the kinetic energy of the fastest emitted photoelectrons? b. What is the stopping potential for these photoelectrons? c. What is the cutoff wavelength for aluminum? 3. An alpha particle in a nucleus can be thought of as being trapped in a "potential well" that has a barrier, height of 8.0 MeV (8.0 x 106 eV) and a barrier width and well width of 1.0 x 10-14 m as shown. a. Calculate the uncertainty in the energy of the alpha particle. (m = 6.7 x 10-27 kg) See Fig. b. What minimum energy must the alpha particle have to tunnel through this potential barrier? ANSWERS: 1. Postulate 1: The laws of physics are the same in all inertial reference frames. Postulate 2: The speed of light (c) in a vacuum is measured as a constant by all observers regardless of their relative motion. consequences: length contraction, time dialation, effective mass increase 2. K.E.MAX = 2.00 ev (3.20 x 10-19J), 2.00 volt, 295 nm 3. 3.3 x 10-13J (2.0 Mev, 6.0 Mev) Chapter Atomic Physics (28): STUDY GUIDE Citation: H. Q Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications.(Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors. 28 Atomic Physics Keywords: Learning Objectives; ; Modern Physics; Atomic Physics; Quantum Theory; Atomic Number; Bohr Model; Bohr Radius; Models Of The Atom; Quantum Numbers; Atomic Energy Levels; Atomic Spectra; Lasers; Pauli Exclusion Principle; Lambert's Law; Spectroscopy; Atomic Structure And Properties GOALS After you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms and use it in an operational definition: atomic number energy level Bohr radius spectra quantum number laser Bohr Model State the assumptions and predictions of the Bohr model of the hydrogen atom. Deduce the concept of ionization potential. Pauli Exclusion Principle Use the Pauli exclusion principle and the four quantum numbers; n, l, ml, andms in the periodic chart of the elements Bohr Model Problems Solve problems using the Bohr equations for hydrogen. Energy Level Diagrams Use energy level diagrams to explain the emission and absorption of radiation by atomic systems. Spectrometry and Lambert's Law Sketch a simple spectrometer, and discuss how it can be used in measuring the concentration of an element in a solution. Laser Explain the principle of laser action. PREREQUISITES Before you begin this chapter you should have achieved the goals in Chapter 4, Forces and Newton's Laws, Chapter 5, Energy, Chapter 21, Electrical Properties of Matters, and Chapter 27, Quantum and Relativistic Physics. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Modern Physics; Quantum Theory; Atomic Physics The introduction of Bohr's model for the atom was a significant advancement for science. Although this model does not explain much of the fine detail of more complicated atoms, this model was successful in representing the hydrogen atom and explaining how electrons behave in and around the nucleus. In this chapter you will find the derivation of the Bohr model and will study the atomic effects which are examples of its success. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Before you begin to study this chapter, be familiar with the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Bohr Model, Bohr Model Problems, Energy Level Diagrams, and Spectronomy and Lambert's Law. More complete discussion of the terms listed under Definitions can be found in the first section of this Chapter. Next, read text sections 28.1-28.8 and 28.10. As you read the derivation of the Bohr model in section 28.3, be sure to note the major hypotheses (Postulate 1 and 2) and follow carefully through the derivation on page 632. The Example on page 633 will help you see how the model can be used in a problem situation. At the end of the chapter, read the Chapter Summary and completeSummary Exercises 1-3 and 5-12. Now do Algorithmic Problems 1-4 and complete Exercises and Problems 3, 5, 8, 9, and 10. For more practice with the concepts introduced in this chapter, see the Examples section of this . Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test provided at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulties with a part of the test, refer back to the appropriate text section or to this study procedure. This study procedure is outlined below. -------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -------------------Definitions 28.1,28.2,28.4, 28.10 Bohr Model 28.3 1,2,3 Bohr Model 28.3 5,6,7 1,2 3 Problems Energy Level 28.5 5,6,8,9 5 Diagrams Spectrometry 28.6,28.7,28.8 10,11,12 3,4 8-10 & Lambert's Law ---------------------------------------------------Pauli Exclusion 28.4 4 7,11 Principle Laser 28.10 DEFINITIONS Keywords: ; Glossary; Modern Physics; Quantum Theory; Atomic Physics; Models Of The Atom; Bohr Model; Atomic Number; Bohr Radius; Quantum Numbers; Atomic Energy Levels; Atomic Spectra; Lasers; Atomic Structure And Properties ATOMIC NUMBER The number of protons (or electrons) in an atom. The symbol Z represents the atomic number. The total electric charge of the nucleus of an atom is equal to +Z. BOHR RADIUS The radius of the first Bohr orbit for the hydrogen atom 0.53 x 10-10m. This represents the distance from the nucleus (proton) to the electron when the electron has a minimum energy (ground state). QUANTUM NUMBER The discrete nature of quantum theory is characterized by four quantum numbers (n, l, ml, ms) that determine the energy structure and quantum state of atoms. Notice that quantum numbers can have only certain discrete values, n, l, and ml are always integers; ms is either +1/2 or -1/2. ENERGY LEVEL The allowed energy values predicted for an atom by quantum theory. In the original work of Bohr the condition of an atom in which, at least for an instant, it had a definite value for its energy was called a stationary state. Since each stationary state has a characteristic energy we also call them energy levels. SPECTRA Each atom has a unique set of emission lines, these spectra are the "fingerprints" of atoms. The discovery by Sir Isaac Newton that white light consisted of a continuous mixture of all the colors lead to a study of the light emitted by many light sources. The study of spectra was highly developed before the formulation of the modern quantum theory of matter. LASER An acronym for light amplifier by stimulated emission of radiation. A highly monochromatic coherent light source. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Lasers; Atomic Excitation; Models Of The Atom; Bohr Model; Bohr Electron Energy; Atomic Physics; Quantum Theory; Modern Physics SECTION 28.1 Introduction Perhaps a laser is the most common, visible device that illustrates quantum properties of matter. However, since the quantum model is the best model we have there is a sense in which every phenomenon is an example of the quantum model. The excitation of atoms in the gases in a fluorescent light results in the emission of electromagnetic radiation. SECTION 28.3 Bohr's Model for the Hydrogen Atom The negative values for the energy of the hydrogen atom indicate that the electron states are bound, or finite, states for the electrons. The energy difference between the n=3 and n=1 states of hydrogen is given by E3 - E1 = -13.6 (1/32 - 1/12) eV = -13.6 (-8/9) eV = 12.1 eV The transition from n=5 to n=2 permits the emission of energy given by E2 - E5 = -13.6 (1/22 - 1/52) = -2.86 eV EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Modern Physics; Quantum Theory; Models Of The Atom; Bohr model; Quantum Numbers; Bohr Electron Energy; Paschen Series; Hydrogen; Lambert's Law; Beer's Law; Hydrogen Spectra; Spectroscopy; Atomic Physics BOHR MODEL PROBLEMS 1. Calculate the wavelengths of the three lines of the Paschen (n=3) series of spectra for hydrogen. What data are given? Principle quantum number = 3. What data are implied? The usual Bohr model postulates are adequate for this system. What physics principles are involved? The basic concepts of the Bohr model for the hydrogen atom. What equations are to be used? Em - En = -13.6 (1/m2 - 1/n2) eV (28.5) E = hc / l (27.1) note: l E = 1240 eV/mn (30.2) Solutions The Paschen series is formed by electron transitions from higher n values to n=3. The first three Paschen lines will thus be for transitions from the n=4, 5, and 6 levels down to n=3. E4 - E3 = -13.6 (1/42 - 1/32) eV = 0.661eV E5 - E3 = -13.6 (1/52 - 1/32) eV = 0.967eV E6 - E3 = -13.6 (1/62 - 1/32) eV = 1.13eV Thinking about the answers None of the Paschen lines are visible but they lie in the infrared portion of the electromagnetic spectra. 2. What is the approximate quantum number n for a hydrogen orbit large enough to be observed under a microscope? What data are given? A hydrogen atom is being inspected under a microscope. What data are implied? Typical quality microscope can resolve objects about 0.0005 millimeters or 5 x10-7 meters in size. What physics principles are involved? The Bohr model for the hydrogen atom. What equations are to be used? rn = (0.53 x 10-10) n2 (28.3) Solution Let us take the diameter of the orbit to be 5 x10-7m then r = 2.5 x10-7m 2.5 x 10-7m = (0.53 x 10-10) n2 4.7 x 103 = n2 69 ÷ n Thinking about the answer The energy of an electron in the n=69 state is about 3 x 10-3eV. The energy of a visible photon that you would need to reflect off of the electron in order to see it has an energy ~ 3eV. What other reasons can you give to explain why no one has seen an electron? SPECTROMETRY AND LAMBERT'S LAW 3. A technician is mixing silver into molten glass to make partially reflecting mirrors. She knows that an 8% silver glass only transmits 88% of the incident light for a given thickness of glass. For twice the thickness of glass she wishes to have a glass transmit only 50% of the light. What percentage silver glass does she need for this glass? What data are given? For a thickness of glass x the transmission is 88% when the silver concentration is 8%. What data are implied? It is assumed the conditions for Beer's Law to be valid are met. What physics principles are involved? The basic concept of absorption of energy as it passes through matter, as expressed in Lambert's Law. What equations are to be used? Lambert's Law I = Ioe-mx (28.9) Beer's Law m = aC (1) Algebraic solution Let xo be the initial thickness, To the initial percent transmission, x1 the second thickness, and T1 the final transmission, Co the initial concentration and C1 the final concentration. To/100 = I/Io = e -a Cx = e -a Coxo (2) T1 / 100 = e -a C1x1 (3) Take the logarithms to the base e of both sides of Equations (2) and (3). ln (To/100) = -aCoxo (4) ln (T1/100) = -aC1x1 (5) Then (ln(To/100)) / (ln (T1/100)) = (Coxo) / (C1x1) (6) So by knowing To, T1, Co, xo, and x1 you can calculate C1. Numerical solution To = 88%; T1 = 50%; xo = xo; x1 = 2xo; Co = 8% (ln (0.88)) / (ln (0.50)) = (8% xo) / (2C1xo) 0.184 = 8% / 2C1 C1 = 8 / (2(.184)) = 21.7% silver glass Thinking about the answer Notice the logarithmic dependence on concentration makes it difficult to estimate correct answers by linear extrapolation. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Answers; Questions; Problems; Bohr Model; Hydrogen; Hydrogen Spectra; Modern Physics Quantum Theory; Atomic Physics; Models Of The Atom; Spectral Absorption; Medical Diagnosis 1. The remarkable Bohr model was designed to explain the structure and stability of the atom, and to explain the characteristic line spectra produced when the atom was excited. a. Briefly state the two postulates of the Bohr model for the atom. b. Does the Bohr model successfully predict the observed spectra of most atoms? Explain your answer. 2. The first four energy levels for the Hydrogen Atom are: -13.6 ev (ground state), -3.40 ev, -1.51 ev, and -.85 ev. a. Predict the wavelength of the radiation produced when an excited atom in the n = 4 state returns to the ground state. b. What wavelength of incident radiation will be absorbed by the hydrogen atom and produce an atom from the ground state to jump into the n = 3 state? c. Predict the energy of the n = 7 state. 3. A lab technician uses a colorimeter to conduct blood sugar studies. She uses the following calibration data: Solution Readout Current (mA) Distilled Water 300. 20.0 ppm sugar in water 30 a. When a patient's morning sample is placed in the colorimeter a readout current of 20.0 mA is obtained. What is the blood sugar concentration in this patient's morning sample? b. When the same patient's evening sample is placed in the colorimeter, the scale reading is 150 mA. What is his evening concentration of blood sugar? ANSWERS: 1. a) *Electrons are contained in stationary states whose energy level is predicted by quantum conditions. *Radiation is emitted or absorbed when an electron makes a transition from one stationary state to another b) For the relatively uncomplicated hydrogen atom, the theory is remarkably accurate. With more complex atoms containing many orbiting electrons, the theory does not predict the nature of the fine structure found in spectral analysis. Therefore the use of the theory is limited. 2. 98 nm, 100 nm, -.28 ev's 3. 23.4 ppm, 6.0 ppm Chapter Molecular and Solid-State Physics (29): to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications: Citation: H. Q Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications.(Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors. 29 Molecular and Solid-State Physics Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Modern Physics; Solid State Physics; Molecules; Bonding In Molecules; Ionic Bonds; Covalent Bonds; Molecular Spectra; Fluorescence; Phosphorescence; Bioluminescence; Semiconductors; Superconductivity; Molecular Spectra; Nuclear Magnetic Resonance; Solids; Band Theory Of Solids GOALS When you have mastered the content of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use each term in an operational definition: ionic bonding extrinsic semiconductor covalent bonding semiconductor fluorescence superconductivity phosphorescence nuclear magnetic resonance bioluminescence Band Theory of Solids State the band theory of solids, and use it to explain the optical and electrical properties of different solids. Molecular Absorption Spectra Explain the basis of vibrational and rotational absorption spectra of molecules. Solid-State Problems Solve problems involving vibrational and rotational energy states of molecules and the band theory of solids. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 21, Electrical Properties of Matter, Chapter 27, Quantum and Relativistic Physics, and Chapter 28, Atomic Physics. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Modern Physics; Solid State Physics; Molecules Investigation has shown that there are basically four types of bonding which hold atoms together in solids; ionic, covalent, Van der Walls, and metallic bonding. These bonding models are primarily electrical in nature and predetermine many of the macroscopic properties observed in solids. These properties include hardness, chemical activity, electrical activity, thermal activity, and boiling point. In this chapter you will be introduced to several general properties of solids and to applications which utilize these unique characteristics. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Start your study of this chapter by reading these Chapter Goals: Definitions, Band Theory of Solids, and Molecular Absorption Spectra. An extended discussion of many of the terms listed under the Definitions goal are provided in the first section of this chapter. Next, read text sections 29.1-29.18. As you read sections 29.4 and 29.3, please note the simplistic nature of the "dumbbell" model and the influence of the quantum nature found in the expressions for Eviband Erot. Questions which you encounter in reading are answered in the second section of this chapter. Now turn to the end of the chapter and read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-9. Next, do Algorithmic Problems 1 and 2 and Exercises and Problems 1 and 2. For more work with the concepts introduced in this chapter, work through the problems given in the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test located at the end of this chapter. If you have difficulty with any part of the test, refer back to a specific text section or to this for further assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. -------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -------------------Definitions 29.1,29.2,29.3, 1-6 1,2 29.6,29.7,29.14 29.15, 29.16, 29.17 Band Theory of 29.8,29.9,29.10, 7 Solids 29.11,29.12, 29.13 Molecular 29.4,29.5,29.18 8,9 1,2 Absorption Spectra --------------------------------------------Solid State 29.4,29.5 10,11 3,4 4,5,8 Problems DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Modern Physics; Solid State Physics; Molecules; Bonding In Molecules; Ionic Bonds; Covalent Bonds; Molecular Spectra; Fluorescence; Phosphorescence; Bioluminescence; Semiconductors; Superconductivity; Molecular Spectra; Nuclear Magnetic Resonance; Solids; Band Theory Of Solids IONIC BONDING Attractive force between positive and negative ions makes a strong bond for ionic materials like Na+ Cl-. To gain some appreciation for the size of the electric forces in ionic materials remember that the largest electric fields in your usual environment are on the order 104V/m near high voltage transmission lines. The electric fields in ionic materials are a million times larger than those, i.e. 1010V/m. COVALENT BONDING The bond produced by shared electrons between atoms making up covalent systems, e.g., H2. Compounds studied in organic chemistry are primarily covalent materials in which the carbon-hydrogen covalent bonding is most prevalent. FLUORESCENCE The light emitted by a substance while it is irradiated. Fluorescent light has longer wavelength than incident light and ceases when incident light is removed. The common fluorescent light fixture makes use of this phenomena for producing visible light. PHOSPHORESCENCE Characterized by light emitted after incident radiation is removed from the source material. The various glow-in-the-dark objects are examples of phosphorescent materials. Bioluminescence Certain biological systems produce light as a consequence of their biochemical processes. The cool light emitted by insects such as fireflies is a common example of bioluminescence. EXTRINSIC SEMICONDUCTOR A semiconductor that has been doped with a donor material (n type) or an acceptor material (p type). A donor is thought of as an element with one more electrons in its outer most electron shell than the host semiconductor. An acceptor is an element which one less electron in its outer most electron shell than the host semiconductor. Look at a periodic table (p. 754-755 in the text) and list the elements that will act as acceptors in germanium or silicon, as donors. SEMICONDUCTOR A material whose room temperature electrical conductivity (s ÷ 1 ohm-1 m-1) is much greater than the conductivity of insulators (s ÷ 10-17 ohm-1 m-1) and much less than the conductivity of the good metallic conductors (s ÷ 10 4 ohm-1 m-1). SUPERCONDUCTIVITY The phenomena characterized by materials that show resistivity going to zero at a critical temperature between absolute zero (OøK) and 30øK. It is possible to construct a model of superconductivity which predicts the existence of room temperature superconductors, but no one has found one yet. NUCLEAR MAGNETIC RESONANCE The phenomena characterized by energy level resonance associated with the proton magnetic dipole in materials. The extreme sensitivity of detection systems making use of resonance have made such systems common in the basic research laboratories around the world. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Modern Physics; Solid State Physics; Solids; Bonding In Solids; Ionic bonds; Conductors; Semiconductors; Band Theory Of Solids SECTION 29.1 Introduction In Chapter 28 we developed a nuclear model to explain the properties of atoms. If we put many atoms close together to form a solid object what aspects of our atomic model will we need to change? How will photons of light interact with atoms closely packed together in solids? Presumably the transition by electrons from one energy level to another will result in the emission or absorption of photons. SECTION 29.8 Solids Ionic bonding would seem to lead to the formation of light, brittle solids. The weaker bonding mechanisms should allow for softer, more pliable solids. Stainless steel is an alloy especially developed for use where a strong metal which would not rust is required. SECTION 29.10 Conductors Question - 1. In a conductor there are always electrons free to move in the conduction band. These electrons can move in response to any energy gradient, either electrical or thermal. Hence, materials which are excellent electrical conductors would also be good thermal conductors. The best specific example is silver. SECTION 29.12 Intrinsic Semiconductors Question - 2. Intrinsic semiconductors have a band gap of the order of 1eV. Visible light has an energy of the order of 2eV. The photons of visible light can be absorbed by electrons in the valence band of semiconductors and lifted into the conduction band. Hence we predict that intrinsic semiconductors will be opaque to visible light and will conduct electricity readily while exposed to bright visible light. EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Solid State Physics; Modern Physics; Molecules; Molecular Spectra; Molecular Vibration; Molecular Rotation; Spectral Absorption; Quantum Numbers; Moment Of Inertia MOLECULAR ABSORPTION SPECTRA 1. The vibrational and rotational lines of the molecule H Cl are found at about l = 3.3 x 10-4 cm. (a) What is the force constant for the vibrational motion of H Cl? (b) What is the moment of inertia of H Cl? (c) What are the splittings we could expect between the various quantum levels for vibrational and rotational spectra in eV? (d) What are the splittings (in eV) we could expect between the H Cl35 lines and the H Cl37 lines? What data are given? The H Cl molecule has ground state vibrational and rotational energy levels at l = 3.3 x10-4 cm = 3.3 x10-6 m = 3,300 nm. What data are implied? Natural occuring chlorine occurs with two different masses, one Cl35 has a gram molecular mass of 35 gm and the other Cl37 has a gram molecular mass of 37 gm. The natural abundances gives chlorine an average gram molecular mass of 35.5 gm. What physics principles are involved? The properties of rotating and vibrating quantum mechanical systems as discussed in Sections 29.4 and 29.5 of the textbook. What equations are to be used? Evib (n + 1/2)(h/2p)(k/m)1/2, where m = (M1M2) / (M1 + M2) (29.2) Erot = J(J + 1)(h/2p)2 (1/2I) (29.3) Solutions (a) Use an average mass for chlorine; M2 = 35.5, then mHCL ÷ ((1)(35.5) / (1 + 35.5)) x 1.66 x 10-27 kg = 1.61 x 10 -27kg Eo ÷ hc / lo = (1/2)(h/2p) x (SQR RT)(k / 1.61 x 10-27) (3 x 108 m/s) / (3.3 x 10-6m) = 1/(4p) x (SQR RT)(k / 1.61 x 10-27) 11.4 x 1014/s = (SQR RT)(k / 1.61 x 10-27) 1.30 x 1030 = (SQR RT)(k / 1.61 x 10-27) 2.1 x 103 N/m = k, the force constant for H Cl. (b) Erot ÷ hc / lo ÷ 1(h/2p)2 x (1/2I) C / lo = h / (8p2I) (3.0 x 108m/s) / (3.0 x 10-6m) = (6.63 x 10-34J ¥ S) / (8p2I) I = 9.2 x10-50 kg m2 (c) Ground State Energy = hc / lo = ((6.63 x 10-34)(3.0 x 108)) / 3.3 x 10-6 Eo = 6.03 x10-20 J = 0.377eV For vibrational levels the levels are evenly split, so Eo = Evib ÷ 1/2hf; DEo = hf = 2Eo energy splittings for vibration states ÷ 2Eo ÷ 0.75eV For rotational states the splittings change Say J = 0 to J = 1 transition is Eo Then J = 1 to J = 2 transition is 2Eo and J = 2 to J = 3 transition is 6Eo and so on. (d) The effective mass of the molecule changes slightly m35/m37 = [((1)(35))/(1+35)) / ((1)(37)/(1+37))] m35/m37 = 0.9722 / 0.9737 = 99.85% Thus the Evib would change by less than 15 parts in 10,000. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Answers; Questions; Problems; Modern Physics; Solid State Physics; Molecules; Molecular Spectra; Fluorescence; Phosphorescence; Solids; Band Theory Of Solids; Semiconductors; Molecular Vibrations; Molecular Rotations 1. Distinguish between the following terms: a) Florescence b) Phosphorescence c) Illuminescence 2. Use the band theory of solids to explain how a pure, intrinsic semiconductor (like germanium) can become a p-type semiconductor. Your explanation should utilize a diagram showing the details of the band theory. 3. The energy levels predicted for a molecule are as follows: Evib = (n + 1/2) (h/2p)(K/m)1/2 (vibrational) Erot = J (J + 1) h2/2I (rotational) a) Describe the mechanical model used to formulate each of these mathematical models. b) Identify the important parts of each of the mathematical models. ANSWERS: 1. a) Excited molecule gives up some of its energy through vibrational contact with other molecules. In a lower energy state, the molecules then emit a photon (longer l) to return to a ground state. b) Molecules involved are excited and return to the ground state through an intermediate state with a long lifetime. These molecules then emit photons at various times to return to the ground state. This slow nature gives a characteristic "afterglow." c) The emission of light due to the excitation of electrons. Lasers and light-emitting diodes used in calculators are examples of illuminescence. 2. See Fig. A pure semiconductor when doped with a substance that has one less electron than the semiconductor gains acceptor states or holes in the forbidden gap region near the valence band. Electrons from the valence band can then move into the acceptor states (by tunneling or by increased thermal energy) where they are trapped. 3. See Fig. The molecule is like a dumbbell with a spring connecting each atom. b) h - planck's constant k - effective spring constant m - effective mass of the system where n = h/2p n - quantum no. for vibration J - quantum no. for rotation I - moment of inertia Chapter X-Rays: 30 X-Rays GOALS Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Modern Physics; Radioactivity; X-Rays; Absorption Coefficients; Bremsstrahlung Radiation; X-Ray Spectra; Types Of Radioactivity; Radiation Interactions; Radiation Absorption When you have mastered the material in this chapter, you will be able to: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use it in an operational definition: hard and soft x rays Bremsstrahlung characteristic x rays absorption coefficient X-ray Problems Solve problems involving the generation, absorption, and detection of x rays. X-ray Interactions List and discuss the interactions of x rays with matter- particularly those with humans. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 21, Electrical Properties of Matter, Chapter 27, Quantum and Relativistic Physics, and Chapter 28, Atomic Physics. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Modern Physics; Radioactivity; Types Of Radioactivity; XRays When high speed electrons (greater than 10,000 eV) strike a solid target (e.g., copper) high energy, short wavelength photons are produced. These photons are called "x rays." Because of their high energy, x rays have remarkable penetrating power. In this chapter you will read about the production, absorption, and detection of x rays. Also, because x rays can produce damage to biological tissue, the biological effects of x rays will be discussed. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE Before you begin your study of this chapter, be familiar with the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, X-Ray Problems, and X-Ray Interactions. An extended discussion of each of the terms listed under the Definitions goal are included in the first section of this chapter. Next, read chapter sections 30.1-30.9. As you read please keep in mind that X rays are not electrons, but high-energy photons. Thus, from the photon theory, x rays have both particle and wave characteristics. Also, be cautious of equation 30.3. If you do not recognize the exponential nature of the equation, look at Appendix, Section A9. Now turn to the end of the chapter and read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-9. Now, do Algorithmic Problems 1-3 and Exercises and Problems 1-3, 5, 6, 11-14, and 16. Be sure that you compare your answers to each of these problems to those given. If you need assistance with any part, turn back to a portion of the text or to this chapter. This study procedure is outlined below. --------------------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -------------------------------Definitions 30.1,30.2,30.6 1,2,3, 14, 16 30.7,30.8 4,5,6 X-Ray 30.2,30.8 7,8 1,2,3, 1,2,3, Problems 5, 6 X-Ray 30.3,30.4,30.5 9 11,12,13 Interactions ---------------------DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; Modern Physics; Radioactivity; X-Rays; Absorption Coefficients; Bremsstrahlung Radiation; X-Ray Spectra; Types Of Radioactivity; Radiation Interactions; Radiation Absorption; HARD X RAYS The higher energy and greater penetrating x rays. SOFT X RAYS The lower energy and lesser penetrating x rays. BREMSSTRAHLUNG "Break radiation" is the name given to the continuous x-ray spectrum from an x-ray source. In most medical uses of x rays a metal plate such as an aluminum disc is used to absorb the low energy Bremsstrahlung radiation as it leaves the x- ray tube. CHARACTERISTIC X-RAYS The x-ray production due to inner electron energy state transitions that result in x-ray photons. The inner electron energy shells are often labeled by the letters K, L, M, N, ... instead of the value of the principle quantum number n = 1, 2, 3, 4, ... respectively. Thus the various characteristic x-rays are sometimes labeled by the final state of the electron after x-ray production, such as Ka where the K means the final state of the electron is the K or n=1 state and alpha means the electron originated at the first level above K, i.e. the L or n=2 state. Hence, when an electron goes down from an n = 2 state to an n = 1 state of an atom a Ka characteristic x ray is emitted. ABSORPTION COEFFICIENT The physical parameter that characterizes the absorption of electromagnetic radiation (x rays) per unit length of absorber. Typical values of absorption coefficients for x rays from ~10 -3 cm-1 for air to 1 cm-1 for water to ~103 cm- 1 for gold, platinum and lead. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Modern Physics; Radioactivity; Types Of Radioactivity; X-Rays SECTION 30.1 Introduction The fact that x rays penetrate body tissue while being absorbed by bone and that x rays will expose photographic emulsions enable us to use x rays to photograph the interior portions of human beings. Since x rays are photons of a few thousand electron volts and since the electrons in color television sets are accelerated through electric potentials of several thousands of volts, x rays will be produced whenever the high energy electrons strike suitable targets. The detection of x rays first occurred because they expose photographic emulsions. Now more quantitative measurements of x-ray intensities are made using ionization chambers and scintillation counters. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Modern Physics; X-Rays; Radioactive Sources; Conservation Of Energy; Wavelength X- RAY PROBLEMS 1. An x- ray tube is operated at a peak voltage of 250 kV and a current of 1.0mA. Then the exposure rate is 2.5 R/hr at a distance of 1.5 m from the target. (a) What is the minimum wavelength of x-ray radiation emitted from this tube? (b) If the current is increased to 20. mA what is the exposure rate at 1.5 m from the target. (c) At what distance for the increased current can the exposure be reduced back to 2.5 R/hr. What data are given? Accelerating voltage = 250 kV = 2.5 x 105 V Current = 1.0 mA = 1.0 x 10-3 A Exposure = 2.5 R/hr at a distance of 1.5 m. What data are implied? We will assume an inverse square law relationship between exposure and distance. What physics principles are involved? The conservation of energy as expressed in Equation 30.1 can be used. The definitions of radiation units (Section 30.6) and the inverse square law will also be used. What equations are to be used? lV = 1240 eV.nm (30.2) I ° (1/d2) (16.12) Solutions (a) lmin = 1240eV-nm / 2.5 x 105 V lmin = 4.96 x 10-3 nm ÷ 5.0 x 10-12 m. (b) If the current is increased to 20 mA then the power of the tube is increased by a factor of 20, so the intensity of x-ray radiation from the tube is increased by a factor of 20, so the exposure rate is increased by a factor of 20 to a value of 50 R/hr. (c) In order to reduce the exposure rate back to 2.5 R/hr the distance from the target must be increased (Dose) (distance)2 = constant (50 R/hr) (1.5m)2 = 2.5 R/hr (X2) ((SQR RT)(20)) (1.5 m) = x 6.7 meters = x Thinking about the answers Remember dose rates increase linearly with the tube current. High current, high voltage x-ray sources ought to be avoided. If you can keep a large distance away from sources of radiation you can reduce your exposure. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Answers; Questions; Problems; X-Rays; X-Ray Spectra; Atomic Spectra; Modern Physics; Bremsstrahlung Radiation; Radioactivity; Applications; Of Radioactivity; Radiation Therapy; Energy; Radiation Damage; Radiation Effects; Medicine And Health; Radiation Interactions; Radiation Absorption 1. A target of copper will produce X-rays when bombarded with high speed electrons. A typical graph showing the X-ray spectrum produced is shown below. See Fig. a) What approximate electron energy (in eV's) is required to produce X-rays from a target like copper? b) What produces the Bremsstrahlung? What is the origin of the two "peaks" called the characteristic X-ray spectral lines? 2. A technician operates an X-ray machine at 200 kV peak for therapeutic purposes. a) Find the energy and wavelength of the most energetic X-rays emitted. b) This machine operates at an exposure rate of 1.0 R/min at a distance of 1.0 meter from the machine. The recommended dosage for the technician (for a 40 hour week) is 1.0 x 10-4 R/min. How thick should the lead shield be for protecting the technician? (Given: The density of lead (r) = 11.4 gram/cm3. The ratio (m/p) for lead at 200 KeV = 0.80 cm2/gm.) 3. The interactions of radiation with living matter depends upon many factors and are therefore complex. In general, absorbed radiation produces changes in cells. a) Rate the following as most sensitive (MS), sensitive (S) or less sensitive (LS) to the effects of radiation. ____ bone marrow cells ____ lymphoid cells ____ bone cells ____ blood vessel cells ____ muscle cells b) What properties of cells and their response to radiation allows the radiation treatment of cancer to be effective? ANSWERS: 1. 20- 50 KeV (The accelerating voltage must be approximately 20,000 to 50,000 volts.) The Bremsstrahlung is white noise or background radiation produced by the deceleration of the electrons upon impact with the target. The "peaks" are produced by the excited target atoms. This energy allows target electrons to return to a ground state after excitement and produce similar radiation frequencies. 2. 6.2 x 10-12 m, 200 KeV, 1.0 cm 3. MS, LS, LS, MS, LS. Radiation treatment has shown that cells which reproduce rapidly are the most sensitive to obstruction. Thus rapid growing cancerous cells can be selected for destruction with proper levels of radiation which can allow healthy cells to survive. Chapter Nuclear Physics (31): STUDY GUIDE Citation: H. Q Fuller, R. M. Fuller and R. G. Fuller, to Accompany Physics Including Human Applications.(Harper and Row, New York, 1978). Permission granted by the authors. 31 Nuclear Physics Keywords: ; Learning Objectives; Modern Physics; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Atomic Mass Number; Isotopes; Isobars; Isofones; Nuclear Binding Energy; Radioactivity; Nuclear Characteristics; Nuclear Emission; Alpha Particles; Beta Particles; Gamma Rays; Radioactive Decay; Decay Law; Half-Life; Nuclear Fission; Nuclear Fusion; Applications Of Radioactivity; Radioactive Dating GOALS When you have mastered the contents of this chapter, you should be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use each term in an operational definition: atomic mass number alpha, beta, and gamma isotope radiation isobar half-life isotone nuclear fission nuclear binding energy nuclear fusion radioactivity Carbon-14 Dating Describe and explain the physical basis of carbon-14 dating. Radioactivity Problems Solve problems involving radioactivity. Binding-Energy Problems Solve nuclear binding-energy problems. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 5, Energy, and Chapter 28, Atomic Physics. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Modern Physics; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry Almost all of the mass of the atom is located in the nucleus. Investigations into the nature of nuclear matter has led to several models which help us understand many observable nuclear properties. These observations include nuclear binding energies, natural radioactivity, fission, and fusion. In this chapter you will be introduced to the basis of nuclear physics and several phenomenalogical applications which result. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE When you begin your study of this chapter, you should be familiar with the following Chapter Goals: Definitions, Carbon-14 Dating, Radioactivity Problems, and Binding Energy Problems. A further discussion of each term listed under the Goal of Definitions section of this chapter. Next, read text sections 31.1-31.6 and 31.9-31.11. As you read, take special note of Table 31.1 which outlines the relative strength of the four interactional forces. Be sure to look carefully at the Example on page 692 and 693 and on page 698. Answers to questions you encounter during your reading will be discussed in the second section of this chapter. Now turn to the end of the chapter and read the Chapter Summary and do Summary Exercises 1-6. Then do Algorithmic Problems 1-4 and Exercises and Problems 1-3, 13, 20, 22, and 23. After you complete each of these exercises, check your answer against those that are given. For more work with the concepts introduced in this chapter, turn to the Examples section of this chapter and work through the problems discussed. Now you should be prepared to attempt the Practice Test given at the end of this chapter. Work completely through the test before checking your answers. For assistance with any part, see specific text sections or refer again to this chapter. This study procedure is outlined below. -------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -------------------Definitions 31.1,31.2,31.3, 1 1,2 1 31.5,31.9-31.10 Carbon-14 31.6 2 23 Dating Radioactivity 31.6 3,4 3,4 20,22 Problems Binding-Energy 31.4 5,6 2,3,13 Problems DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Modern Physics; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Atomic Mass Number; Isotopes; Isobars; Isofones; Nuclear Binding Energy; Radioactivity; Nuclear Characteristics; Nuclear Emission; Alpha Particles; Beta Particles; Gamma Rays; Radioactive Decay; Decay Law; Half-Life; Nuclear Fission; Nuclear Fusion ATOMIC MASS NUMBER (A) The number of nucleons (protons and neutrons) in an atomic nucleus. The atomic mass number of elements ranges from 1 for hydrogen to 260 for hahnium. ISOTOPE Refers to atoms that have the same atomic number but different numbers of neutrons. Since the chemical properties of materials are determined by their electronic structure, hence their atomic number, isotopes have the same chemical properties. ISOBAR Nuclei that have the same atomic mass number, A, are called isobars. Since the atomic number, rather than the atomic mass number, determines the chemical properties of a material isobars will have quite different chemical properties, e.g. neon, sodium, and magnesium. ISOTONE Nuclei with equal numbers of neutrons are called isotones. The chemical properties of isotones is quite different, consider boron, carbon and nitrogen. NUCLEAR BINDING ENERGY The energy that binds neutrons and protons in a nucleus is equal to the mass-energy difference between separate nucleons and the particular nucleus. The Einstein equation that relates mass to energy is used to relate the mass difference between the separate masses to the combined mass to the binding energy, see Eq. 31.4. RADIOACTIVITY The name given to the process occurring when unstable decay with characteristic radiation. This was discovered in 1896, barely one generation ago. Modern human life has probably changed more since the discovery of radioactivity than all previous changes combined. Has radioactivity been the cause of this tremendous change? ALPHA RADIATION The radiation that consists of helium nuclei emitted by heavy radioactive nuclei. The alpha particle was used in the scattering experiments conducted by Rutherford, et. al. which lead to the nuclear model for matter. BETA RADIATION The radiation that results in electron or positron emission from a radioactive nucleus. The beta emission process which did not seem to conserve energy lead Fermi to propose a new particle, not experimentally verified for nearly 20 years! Such confidence in conservation laws! GAMMA RADIATION Radiation of high energy electromagnetic waves. Gamma radiation has a high penetration ability. It is difficult to shield persons from gamma emission processes. RADIOACTIVE HALF-LIFE The time required for one-half the radioactive nuclei in a sample to decay. The half- lives of materials vary widely from a small fraction of a second for very unstable nuclei to millions of years for the more stable radioactive nuclei. NUCLEAR FISSION The process occurring when a heavy unstable nucleus splits to form two lighter nuclei with the release of considerable energy and a few neutrons. The process is exploited in nuclear reactors. This was the first man made nuclear process. It seems to not occur anywhere without human intention. NUCLEAR FUSION The process that occurs when two light nuclei get close enough together that the nuclear force causes them to fuse to form a heavier nucleus with a release of energy. The basic source of energy in stars. This is the basic natural nuclear process and has so far not been duplicated in a scientific laboratory for any extended period of time. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: ; Answers; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Nucleus; Nuclear Binding Energy; Nuclear Stability; Nuclear Fusion; Mass And Energy SECTION 31.1 Introduction The basic physics of this chapter is contained in the explanation of two facts. If a heavy nucleus is divided into two smaller nuclei by a fission process, the final mass of the nuclei is less than the initial mass of the heavy nucleus. If two light nuclei are fused together to form a larger nucleus the mass of the final large nucleus is less than the total mass of the two initial light nuclei. That is, in both processes, splitting heavy nuclei and joining light nuclei, mass is lost. That mass loss appears as its equivalence in energy according to Einstein's E=mc2 equation. SECTION 31.2 The Nucleus The six carbon isotopes contain six protons and four, five, six, seven, eight, and nine neutrons respectively. SECTION 31.3 Properties of the Nucleus The great density of nuclear matter seems much greater than we could predict from the forces of interaction. The forces of interaction for atoms and bulk materials are primarily electromagnetic. The nuclear force of interaction is about 100 times the electromagnetic force yet the nuclear matter is a thousand billion times as dense as an atom. SECTION 31.4 Nuclear Binding Energy The binding energy per nucleon is seven times greater for helium than it is for deuterium. It seems safe to predict that helium is a much more stable nucleus than deuterium. SECTION 31.6 Stable and Unstable Nuclei The neutrino prediction of Fermi ranks as a great triumph for the conservation of energy principle. Today in studying the increasing maze of "elementary" particles basic conservation principles are used to guide experimental studies. SECTION 31.10 Fusion The binding energy per nucleon graph (Figure 31.1) gives us a way of predicting which nucleons would be appropriate for fission or for fusion. The most stable nuclei are near an atomic mass number of 55. Clearly only nuclei with mass numbers much larger than 55 are suitable candidates for fission. In a similar way only nuclei with atomic mass numbers much less than 55 are suitable candidates for fusion. 6 Look at the location of 3Li. What do you predict about that nucleus? EXAMPLES Keywords: ; Worked Examples; Modern Physics; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Mass And Energy; Conservation Of Energy; Nuclear Interactions; Nuclear Emission; Atomic Mass Number; Nuclear Binding Energy; Conservative Laws; Radioactivity; Radioactive Decay; Decay Law; Half-Life; Exponential Decay; Conservation Of Mass NUCLEAR REACTION PROBLEMS 1. The energy released in the radioactive decay 238 4 234 92U ç 2He + 90Th is 4.27MeV. Calculate the mass of 234Th. What data are given? 238U mass = 238.0498 amu 4He mass = 4.00260 amu Energy Released = 4.27MeV What data are implied? This is an isolated system with no external energy input. What physics principles are involved? Conservation of energy using the Einstein relation. What equation is to be used? E = mc2 (31.4) Solution Initial Energy = 238.0498 amu Final Energy = 4.0026 amu + 4.27 MeV + mass of Th Since 1 amu = 931 MeV; 4.27 MeV = .0046 amu. Final Energy = 4.0072 amu + mass of the Th mass of Th = 238.0498 - 4.0072 234Th = 234.0428 amu. 2. In the slow neutron reaction 1 10 7 0n + 5B ç 3Li + ? + Q (a) Determine the unknown component of the reaction and its energy released. What data are given? The basic nuclear equation is given. What data are implied? There is one component missing from the equation. What physics principles are involved? Conservation of atomic number and atomic mass number can be used to determine the unknown component. Then conservation of energy using the Einstein equation can be used to find the energy released. What equations are to be used? E = mc2 (31.4) Solution There are 11 amu's shown on the left hand side of the equation and 5 units of atomic number. There are 7 and 3 respectively on the right hand side of the equation. That leaves 4 amu and 2 units of atomic number not counted. 4 Thus the particle must be 2X, where X must be helium. 4 So the missing component is an alpha particle 2He. 1 mass of 0n = 1.00867 amu 10 mass of 5B = 10.01295 --------------total = 11.02162 amu 7 mass of 3Li = -7.01601 -------------4.00561 4 mass of 2He = -4.00260 amu Q = .00301 amu = 2.80 MeV RADIOACTIVITY PROBLEMS 3. The half life of Rn222 is 3.82 days. (a) What is the decay constant of this isotope in sec1? (b) If a sample of Rn222 contains 1016 atoms at time t=0, how many Rn222 atoms will be left after 25 days? What data are given? t1/2 = 3.82 days = 3.30 x 105 seconds No = 1016 atoms What physics principles are involved? The exponential decay of radioactive nuclear is basic to this problem. What equations are to be used? N = Noe-lt (31.12) t1/2 = 0.693 / l (31.13) Solutions (a) The decay constant can be found from the half-life using Equation 31.13. l = 0.693 / t1/2 = 0.693 / (3.30 x 105 sec) lRn222 = 2.10 x 10-6 sec-1 (b) The number of atoms at time t is given by Equation 31.12 N = (1016)e - (25 days = 24 hr/d x 60 min/hr = 60 sec/min)l N = 1016e - (2.16 x 106)(2.10 x 10-6) n = 1016 e-4.54 = 1.07 x1014 atoms BINDING-ENERGY PROBLEMS 7 4. What is the binding energy of 3Li whose atomic mass is 7.01822 amu.? What data are given? Atomic number = 3 (number of protons) Atomic mass number = 7 (number of nucleons) Atomic mass = 7.01822 amu (includes 3 electrons) What data are implied? 7 The 3Li nucleus consists of 3 protons and 4 neutrons. What physics principles are involved? The Einstein equation is combined with conservation of mass equations to compute nuclear binding energies. What equations are to be used? BE = (Zmp + Nmn)c2 - Mc2 (31.7) Solution 71 The 3Li atom is equivalent to 3 1H atoms and 4 neutrons. Their separate masses are 1 3 1H = 3(1.007825) = 3.023475 amu 4 n = 4(1.008665) = 4.034660 amu -----------------7.058135 amu 7 3Li -7.01822 ----------------------------BE = .03992 amu BE = 37.19 MeV 7 There are 7 nucleons in 3Li so the binding energy per nucleon is 5.312 MeV/nucleon. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Answers; Problems; Questions; Modern Physics; Radioactivity; Radioactive Decay; Half-Life; Decay Law; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Nuclear Binding Energy; Nuclear Interactions 1. a) The half-life of C-14 is 5730 years. The activity of C-14 from a living sample is 16.0 counts per minute. If the activity of carbon from an ancient wood sample is found to be 1.88 counts/min, what is the age of the sample? b) Comment on the "accuracy" of this dating method. 2. Given the following nuclear reaction: 174 1H + 3Li ç ? 2He + ? a) Complete the reaction by filling in the blanks with proper numbers and/or symbols. b) Calculate the amount of energy released in this reaction. 1 1H = 1.00813 amu, 7 3Li = 7.01613 amu, 4 2He = 4.00386 amu, and 1 amu = 931 MeV. ANSWERS: 1. 17,800 yr. In actual practice, the 1.88 counts/min may be less than the normal "background count" due to natural occurring disintegration. Since normal variations in background occur, it becomes difficult to distinguish between background and radiation attributed to the sample itself. Thus the possibility of error is great. 4 2. 2 2He + Q, Q = 15.4 MeV Chapter Applied Nucleonics (32): 32 Applied Nucleonics Keywords: Learning Objectives; ; Modern Physics; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Nuclear Fission; Moderators; Chain Reactions; Fission; Reactors; Nuclear Fusion; Plasmas; Magnetic Confinement; Half-Life; Detection Of Radiation; Nuclear Medicine; Medical Diagnosis GOALS When you have mastered the content of this chapter, you will be able to achieve the following goals: Definitions Define each of the following terms, and use each term in an operational definition: fission thermonuclear reaction chain reaction plasma critical mass "magnetic bottle" moderator tracer breeder reactor biological half-life neutron activation effective half-life fusion Fission Reactors Explain the operation of a nuclear fission reactor. Radiation Detectors Compare different nuclear radiation detectors in their uses. Radiation Problems Solve problems involving radiation application using biological half-life and dosage data. Tracer Applications Outline the use of radioactive tracers in medical applications. PREREQUISITES Before beginning this chapter you should have achieved the goals of Chapter 21, Electrical Properties of Matter, Chapter 27, Quantum and Relativistic Physics, Chapter 30. X Rays, and Chapter 31, Nuclear Physics. OVERVIEW Keywords: ; Instructions; Modern Physics; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry Our modern society places an ever-increasing demand on energy acquisition. During the 1980's, nuclear energy from the processes of both fission and fusion will surely provide additional energy for your use. The uses of nuclear energy will no doubt continue to be important; i.e., medical and tracer applications. In this chapter you will read about the conversion of nuclear energy into electrical energy and some of the problems which complicate the process. In addition, the problem of containing new and used nuclear materials will be presented. SUGGESTED STUDY PROCEDURE When you begin to study this final chapter, you should be familiar with the following chapter Goals: Definitions, Fission Reactors, Radiation Problems and Tracer Application. A further discussion of the terms listed under Definitions can be found in the Definitions section of this chapter. Next, read chapter sections 32.1-32.5 and 32.11. In addition to the important energy issue, be sure to note the contribution nuclear energy has made in other areas like medicine. Tables 32.1 and 32.2 will highlight some specific uses of radioactive materials. Now, turn to the end of the chapter and read the Chapter Summary and complete Summary Exercises 1-7 and 10. Next, do Algorithmic Problem 1 and Exercises and Problems 1, 2, 7, and 8. For more work with the concepts of this chapter, now turn to the Examples section of this chapter. Now you should be prepared to attempt the final Practice Test provided in this . If you have difficulties with any part of the test, you should refer to the appropriate text or section for assistance. This study procedure is outlined below. -------------------Chapter Goals Suggested Summary Algorithmic Exercises Text Readings Exercises Problems & Problems -------------------Definitions 32.1,32.3,32.4 1,2,3,4, 5,6 Fission 32.2 7 1 Reactors Radiation 32.11 1 2,7,8 Problems Tracer 32.5 10 Applications ---------------------------------------------------Radiation 32.6,32.7,32.8 8 5 Detectors 32.9,32.10 DEFINITIONS Keywords: Glossary; ; Modern Physics; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Nuclear Fission; Moderators; Chain Reactions; Fission; Reactors; Nuclear Fusion; Plasmas; Magnetic Confinement; Half-Life; Detection Of Radiation; Nuclear Medicine; Medical Diagnosis FISSION The dividing up of heavy nuclei to obtain energy. This process, which creates heavy radioactive waste products, is the basic process in all nuclear power generation. CHAIN REACTION The fission reaction sustained by neutrons from preceding nuclear fission reactions. The basis of nuclear fission reactions and bombs. In some fission processes excess neutrons are emitted which can be used to trigger the fission of nearby nuclei, if there are enough nearby nuclei. CRITICAL MASS The necessary mass of fissionable material to sustain a chain reaction. Enough nearby nuclei to continue a fission process is called a critical mass. MODERATOR The material used in fission reactors to slow down fast neutrons so that a controlled chain reaction can be maintained. BREEDER REACTOR A nuclear fission reactor that produces additional fissionable fuel material in addition to usable nuclear energy. At this time breeder reactors are still not widely used in the generation of electrical energy. NEUTRON ACTIVATION The process resulting in induced radioactivity of samples subjected to neutron bombardment. Neutron activation analysis has lead to the solution of some spectacular crimes, such as in the sale of fraudulent paintings. FUSION Combining light nuclei to obtain energy. This appears to be the fundamental natural source of all the energy from the sun and stars. THERMONUCLEAR REACTION The name given to all fusion reactions and the energy source of stars. The fusion process is one of intense heat, more than 100,000,000 degrees celsius. PLASMA The state of matter consisting of completely ionized atoms and electrons as characterized by fusion reactions. Plasma physics is now a widely recognized research specialty. Plasma physicists have made use of very high power pulsed lasers beams as energy sources. MAGNETIC BOTTLE The magnetic field confinement system used to contain plasma in fusion reactors. Have you ever thought of having a container for particles with no "walls"? This is a spectacular example of interaction-at-a-distance. TRACERS Radioactive tracers are samples that contain radioactive isotopes of biochemically active materials. Their activity can be traced in a biological system. (See Table 32.1) BIOLOGICAL HALF-LIFE The time required for one-half the biochemically active sample to be eliminated by natural processes. Since about 20% of the air in your lungs is expelled in each breath the biological half-life of the stale air in you lungs is about the time required for you to take three breaths, (4/5)3 ÷ 1/2. EFFECTIVE HALF-LIFE The resultant of radioactive and biological half-life. The magnitude of the effective half-life of a tracer is always less than the smaller of its biological or its radioactive half-life. ANSWERS TO QUESTIONS FOUND IN THE TEXT Keywords: Answers; ; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Modern Physics; Nuclear Fission; Half-Life; Plutonium; Ecology; Nuclear Energy; Fossil Fuels SECTION 32.1 Introduction As the fossil fuel supply continues to be used at an ever increasing rate the use of nuclear fuels becomes more and more common. What are the fundamental processes of nuclear fuels? What are the benefits? the risks? These are questions that all of us consider. We will have to decide on the energy sources of the future. SECTION 32.2 Nuclear Fission Since plutonium-239 only has a half-life of 24,000 years and the older rocks on the surface of the earth date back at least a million years, that's almost 42 half-lives of plutonium-239, or one part in 3 1/2 trillion parts of any original plutonium-239 would still be around. It seems rather unlikely we would find any natural occurring plutonium-239. EXAMPLES Keywords: Worked Examples; ; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Half-Life; Biology; Alpha Particles; Radiation Absorption; Radioactivity; Radioactive Decay; Radium RADIATION PROBLEMS 32 1. The isotope 15P passes through the liver with a half-life of 18 days. 32 The effective half-life of 15P in the liver is 8.0 days. 32 What is the radioactive half-life of 15P? What data are given? Tb = 18 days; T = 8.0 days What physics principles are involved? The biological and radioactive half-lifes of an isotope may be combined to yield an effective half-life. What equation is to be used? 1/T = 1/Tb + 1/Tr (32.1) Solution We need to solve Equation 32.1 for Tr 1/8.0 days = 1/18 days + 1/Tr Tr = 14.4 days Thinking about the answer Notice that the effective half life is always less than even the biological or the radioactive half-life. 2. Assume that a man has incorporated within the bones of his body 10mCi of the alpha emitter, 276Ra which has a radioactive half-life of 1622 years. The energy of the primary alpha particle is 4.79 MeV. Assume a uniform distribution of the radium in 7.0 kg of bone. What is the total dose per day from the alpha particles of 226 Ra? What data are given? Activity = 10mCi = 10 x 3.70 x 104 dis/sec. = 3.7 x105 dis/sec Energy = 4.79 MeV / alpha = 4.79 MeV/dis. Mass = 7.0 kg = 7000 gm. What data are implied? The dose unit is the rad which is equivalent to the absorption of 10-5 J/gm or 6.25 x 1013 eV/gm = 6.25 x 107 MeV/gm. What physics principles are involved? All of the energy of the alpha particles will be absorbed by the bone. We only need to compute the total alpha particle kinetic energy and divide by the bone mass. What equations are to be used? Dose = Energy Absorbed / Unit Mass in rad Solution Dose = (4.79 MeV / alpha) x (3.70 x 105 alphas/sec.) = 1.77 x 106 MeV/sec Daily Dose = 1.77 x 106 MeV/sec x 60 sec/min x 60 min/hr x 24 hr/day = 1.53x1011 MeV/day To convert the daily dose of 1.53 x 1011 MeV/day radiation unit of rads, we need to divide it by the mass of the absorber Daily Dose / Mass = (1.53 x 1011 MeV) / 7000 = 2.19 x 107 MeV/gm But 1 rad = 6.24 x 107 MeV/gm Daily Dose in rads = (2.19 x 107 MeV/gm) x (1rad / (6.25 x 107 MeV/gm)) Daily Dose = 0.350 rads Thinking about the answer Such a person will receive an annual dose of about 125 rads. Recall that the relative biological effectiveness (RBE) of 5 MeV alpha particles is 20; then this person will get a radiation dose of 2500 rem per year. Look at Table 30.1 and you will see that this is much larger than typical background radiation levels. PRACTICE TEST Keywords: ; Evaluations; Questions; Answers; Problems; Nuclear Physics And Chemistry; Modern Physics; Nuclear Fission; Nuclear Energy; Fission Reactors; Radioactivity; Radioactive Decay; Half-Life; Nuclear Medicine; Medical Diagnosis 1. A nuclear fission reactor produces electrical energy from release nuclear energy. a) Make a block diagram showing the three main parts of the fission reactor generating station needed to convert the nuclear energy into electrical energy. b) Inside the reactor, uranium fuel divides (fissions) and forms a chain reaction with other atoms. How does this reaction remain "self-sustaining? How is the reaction controlled? 2. The effective half-life of K42 used for radioactive muscle tracing is .5 days. The radioactive half-life is also .5 days. Find the biological half-life of K42. 3. A doctor wishes to study a defective thyroid by using a radioactive tracer. Please name the isotope which would be used and outline the procedure explaining the important steps in making this analysis. ANSWERS: 1. See Fig. Each fission produces two slow neutrons. If the fuel density is large enough to make it highly probable that these two neutrons will hit and "split" two additional atoms, each of these will in turn produce 2 slow neutrons, etc. 2. Infinite 3. 131I After an injection of 131I, the thyroid gland is monitored with a giger counter. The rate of increased activity is related to the activity of the gland.